Mercurial > audlegacy
changeset 3046:3be0cfac03cd
branch merge
author | Tomasz Mon <desowin@gmail.com> |
---|---|
date | Thu, 12 Jul 2007 13:41:34 +0200 |
parents | 464ae313343c (current diff) 994d8a688d99 (diff) |
children | 757d5d9741af |
files | src/audacious/intl/ui_skinned_textbox.c src/intl/ChangeLog src/intl/Makefile src/intl/VERSION src/intl/bindtextdom.c src/intl/config.charset src/intl/dcgettext.c src/intl/dcigettext.c src/intl/dcngettext.c src/intl/dgettext.c src/intl/dngettext.c src/intl/eval-plural.h src/intl/explodename.c src/intl/finddomain.c src/intl/gettext.c src/intl/gettextP.h src/intl/gmo.h src/intl/hash-string.h src/intl/intl-compat.c src/intl/l10nflist.c src/intl/libgnuintl.h src/intl/loadinfo.h src/intl/loadmsgcat.c src/intl/localcharset.c src/intl/localcharset.h src/intl/locale.alias src/intl/localealias.c src/intl/localename.c src/intl/log.c src/intl/ngettext.c src/intl/os2compat.c src/intl/os2compat.h src/intl/osdep.c src/intl/plural-exp.c src/intl/plural-exp.h src/intl/plural.c src/intl/plural.y src/intl/ref-add.sin src/intl/ref-del.sin src/intl/relocatable.c src/intl/relocatable.h src/intl/textdomain.c |
diffstat | 85 files changed, 11635 insertions(+), 10723 deletions(-) [+] |
line wrap: on
line diff
--- a/src/Makefile Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ b/src/Makefile Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ include ../mk/rules.mk include ../mk/init.mk -SUBDIRS = $(INTL_OBJECTIVE) $(SUBDIR_GUESS) +SUBDIRS = $(SUBDIR_GUESS) ifdef USE_DBUS SUBDIRS += libaudclient audtool
--- a/src/audacious/Makefile Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ b/src/audacious/Makefile Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -2,14 +2,14 @@ include ../../mk/init.mk include ../../mk/objective.mk -SUBDIRS = widgets glade images ui +SUBDIRS = $(INTL_OBJECTIVE) widgets glade images ui OBJECTIVE_BINS = audacious LDFLAGS += $(AUDLDFLAGS) LDADD = \ - -L.. $(LIBINTL) \ + $(LIBINTL) \ $(samplerate_LIBS) \ $(CHARDET_LIBS) \ $(GTK_LIBS) \ @@ -32,7 +32,7 @@ $(LIBMCS_CFLAGS) \ -D_AUDACIOUS_CORE \ -I.. -I../.. \ - -I../intl + -I./intl HEADERS = \ auddrct.h \
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/ChangeLog Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,4 @@ +2003-05-22 GNU <bug-gnu-gettext@gnu.org> + + * Version 0.12.1 released. +
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/Makefile Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +include ../../../mk/rules.mk +include ../../../mk/init.mk + +localedir = $(datadir)/locale +gettextsrcdir = $(datadir)/gettext/intl +aliaspath = $(localedir) + +OBJECTIVE_LIBS_NOINST = libintl.a + +DEFS += -DLOCALEDIR=\"$(localedir)\" -DLOCALE_ALIAS_PATH=\"$(aliaspath)\" \ +-DLIBDIR=\"$(libdir)\" -DIN_LIBINTL \ +-DENABLE_RELOCATABLE=1 -DIN_LIBRARY -DINSTALLDIR=\"$(libdir)\" -DINSTALLPREFIX=\"$(libdir)\" -DNO_XMALLOC \ +-Dset_relocation_prefix=libintl_set_relocation_prefix \ +-Drelocate=libintl_relocate \ +-DDEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV=1 + +CFLAGS += $(PICFLAGS) -I../.. -I. $(DEFS) + +SOURCES = \ + bindtextdom.c \ + dcgettext.c \ + dgettext.c \ + gettext.c \ + finddomain.c \ + loadmsgcat.c \ + localealias.c \ + textdomain.c \ + l10nflist.c \ + explodename.c \ + dcigettext.c \ + dcngettext.c \ + dngettext.c \ + ngettext.c \ + plural.c \ + plural-exp.c \ + localcharset.c \ + relocatable.c \ + localename.c \ + log.c \ + osdep.c \ + os2compat.c \ + intl-compat.c + +OBJECTS = ${SOURCES:.c=.o} + +include ../../../mk/objective.mk
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/VERSION Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,1 @@ +GNU gettext library from gettext-0.12.1
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/bindtextdom.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,374 @@ +/* Implementation of the bindtextdomain(3) function + Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stddef.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif +#include "gettextP.h" + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications. */ +# include <bits/libc-lock.h> +#else +/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */ +# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME) +# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME) +# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME) +#endif + +/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different + names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs + using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */ +#if !defined _LIBC +# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname +# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings +#endif + +/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>. */ +#ifndef offsetof +# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident)) +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs. */ +extern const char _nl_default_dirname[]; +#ifdef _LIBC +extern const char _nl_default_dirname_internal[] attribute_hidden; +#else +# define INTUSE(name) name +#endif + +/* List with bindings of specific domains. */ +extern struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings; + +/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */ +__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden) + + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN __bindtextdomain +# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET __bind_textdomain_codeset +# ifndef strdup +# define strdup(str) __strdup (str) +# endif +#else +# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN libintl_bindtextdomain +# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset +#endif + +/* Prototypes for local functions. */ +static void set_binding_values PARAMS ((const char *domainname, + const char **dirnamep, + const char **codesetp)); + +/* Specifies the directory name *DIRNAMEP and the output codeset *CODESETP + to be used for the DOMAINNAME message catalog. + If *DIRNAMEP or *CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is not + modified, only the current value is returned. + If DIRNAMEP or CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is neither + modified nor returned. */ +static void +set_binding_values (domainname, dirnamep, codesetp) + const char *domainname; + const char **dirnamep; + const char **codesetp; +{ + struct binding *binding; + int modified; + + /* Some sanity checks. */ + if (domainname == NULL || domainname[0] == '\0') + { + if (dirnamep) + *dirnamep = NULL; + if (codesetp) + *codesetp = NULL; + return; + } + + __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock); + + modified = 0; + + for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next) + { + int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname); + if (compare == 0) + /* We found it! */ + break; + if (compare < 0) + { + /* It is not in the list. */ + binding = NULL; + break; + } + } + + if (binding != NULL) + { + if (dirnamep) + { + const char *dirname = *dirnamep; + + if (dirname == NULL) + /* The current binding has be to returned. */ + *dirnamep = binding->dirname; + else + { + /* The domain is already bound. If the new value and the old + one are equal we simply do nothing. Otherwise replace the + old binding. */ + char *result = binding->dirname; + if (strcmp (dirname, result) != 0) + { + if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0) + result = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); + else + { +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP + result = strdup (dirname); +#else + size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1; + result = (char *) malloc (len); + if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) + memcpy (result, dirname, len); +#endif + } + + if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) + { + if (binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) + free (binding->dirname); + + binding->dirname = result; + modified = 1; + } + } + *dirnamep = result; + } + } + + if (codesetp) + { + const char *codeset = *codesetp; + + if (codeset == NULL) + /* The current binding has be to returned. */ + *codesetp = binding->codeset; + else + { + /* The domain is already bound. If the new value and the old + one are equal we simply do nothing. Otherwise replace the + old binding. */ + char *result = binding->codeset; + if (result == NULL || strcmp (codeset, result) != 0) + { +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP + result = strdup (codeset); +#else + size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1; + result = (char *) malloc (len); + if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) + memcpy (result, codeset, len); +#endif + + if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) + { + if (binding->codeset != NULL) + free (binding->codeset); + + binding->codeset = result; + binding->codeset_cntr++; + modified = 1; + } + } + *codesetp = result; + } + } + } + else if ((dirnamep == NULL || *dirnamep == NULL) + && (codesetp == NULL || *codesetp == NULL)) + { + /* Simply return the default values. */ + if (dirnamep) + *dirnamep = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); + if (codesetp) + *codesetp = NULL; + } + else + { + /* We have to create a new binding. */ + size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1; + struct binding *new_binding = + (struct binding *) malloc (offsetof (struct binding, domainname) + len); + + if (__builtin_expect (new_binding == NULL, 0)) + goto failed; + + memcpy (new_binding->domainname, domainname, len); + + if (dirnamep) + { + const char *dirname = *dirnamep; + + if (dirname == NULL) + /* The default value. */ + dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); + else + { + if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0) + dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); + else + { + char *result; +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP + result = strdup (dirname); + if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) + goto failed_dirname; +#else + size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1; + result = (char *) malloc (len); + if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) + goto failed_dirname; + memcpy (result, dirname, len); +#endif + dirname = result; + } + } + *dirnamep = dirname; + new_binding->dirname = (char *) dirname; + } + else + /* The default value. */ + new_binding->dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); + + new_binding->codeset_cntr = 0; + + if (codesetp) + { + const char *codeset = *codesetp; + + if (codeset != NULL) + { + char *result; + +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP + result = strdup (codeset); + if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) + goto failed_codeset; +#else + size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1; + result = (char *) malloc (len); + if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) + goto failed_codeset; + memcpy (result, codeset, len); +#endif + codeset = result; + new_binding->codeset_cntr++; + } + *codesetp = codeset; + new_binding->codeset = (char *) codeset; + } + else + new_binding->codeset = NULL; + + /* Now enqueue it. */ + if (_nl_domain_bindings == NULL + || strcmp (domainname, _nl_domain_bindings->domainname) < 0) + { + new_binding->next = _nl_domain_bindings; + _nl_domain_bindings = new_binding; + } + else + { + binding = _nl_domain_bindings; + while (binding->next != NULL + && strcmp (domainname, binding->next->domainname) > 0) + binding = binding->next; + + new_binding->next = binding->next; + binding->next = new_binding; + } + + modified = 1; + + /* Here we deal with memory allocation failures. */ + if (0) + { + failed_codeset: + if (new_binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) + free (new_binding->dirname); + failed_dirname: + free (new_binding); + failed: + if (dirnamep) + *dirnamep = NULL; + if (codesetp) + *codesetp = NULL; + } + } + + /* If we modified any binding, we flush the caches. */ + if (modified) + ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr; + + __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); +} + +/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found + in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base. */ +char * +BINDTEXTDOMAIN (domainname, dirname) + const char *domainname; + const char *dirname; +{ + set_binding_values (domainname, &dirname, NULL); + return (char *) dirname; +} + +/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the + DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned. */ +char * +BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET (domainname, codeset) + const char *domainname; + const char *codeset; +{ + set_binding_values (domainname, NULL, &codeset); + return (char *) codeset; +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Aliases for function names in GNU C Library. */ +weak_alias (__bindtextdomain, bindtextdomain); +weak_alias (__bind_textdomain_codeset, bind_textdomain_codeset); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/config.charset Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,467 @@ +#! /bin/sh +# Output a system dependent table of character encoding aliases. +# +# Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +# +# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it +# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published +# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) +# any later version. +# +# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, +# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of +# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU +# Library General Public License for more details. +# +# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public +# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software +# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, +# USA. +# +# The table consists of lines of the form +# ALIAS CANONICAL +# +# ALIAS is the (system dependent) result of "nl_langinfo (CODESET)". +# ALIAS is compared in a case sensitive way. +# +# CANONICAL is the GNU canonical name for this character encoding. +# It must be an encoding supported by libiconv. Support by GNU libc is +# also desirable. CANONICAL is case insensitive. Usually an upper case +# MIME charset name is preferred. +# The current list of GNU canonical charset names is as follows. +# +# name used by which systems a MIME name? +# ASCII, ANSI_X3.4-1968 glibc solaris freebsd +# ISO-8859-1 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes +# ISO-8859-2 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes +# ISO-8859-3 glibc solaris yes +# ISO-8859-4 osf solaris freebsd yes +# ISO-8859-5 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes +# ISO-8859-6 glibc aix hpux solaris yes +# ISO-8859-7 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris yes +# ISO-8859-8 glibc aix hpux osf solaris yes +# ISO-8859-9 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris yes +# ISO-8859-13 glibc +# ISO-8859-14 glibc +# ISO-8859-15 glibc aix osf solaris freebsd +# KOI8-R glibc solaris freebsd yes +# KOI8-U glibc freebsd yes +# KOI8-T glibc +# CP437 dos +# CP775 dos +# CP850 aix osf dos +# CP852 dos +# CP855 dos +# CP856 aix +# CP857 dos +# CP861 dos +# CP862 dos +# CP864 dos +# CP865 dos +# CP866 freebsd dos +# CP869 dos +# CP874 woe32 dos +# CP922 aix +# CP932 aix woe32 dos +# CP943 aix +# CP949 osf woe32 dos +# CP950 woe32 dos +# CP1046 aix +# CP1124 aix +# CP1125 dos +# CP1129 aix +# CP1250 woe32 +# CP1251 glibc solaris woe32 +# CP1252 aix woe32 +# CP1253 woe32 +# CP1254 woe32 +# CP1255 glibc woe32 +# CP1256 woe32 +# CP1257 woe32 +# GB2312 glibc aix hpux irix solaris freebsd yes +# EUC-JP glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes +# EUC-KR glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes +# EUC-TW glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris +# BIG5 glibc aix hpux osf solaris freebsd yes +# BIG5-HKSCS glibc solaris +# GBK glibc aix osf solaris woe32 dos +# GB18030 glibc solaris +# SHIFT_JIS hpux osf solaris freebsd yes +# JOHAB glibc solaris woe32 +# TIS-620 glibc aix hpux osf solaris +# VISCII glibc yes +# TCVN5712-1 glibc +# GEORGIAN-PS glibc +# HP-ROMAN8 hpux +# HP-ARABIC8 hpux +# HP-GREEK8 hpux +# HP-HEBREW8 hpux +# HP-TURKISH8 hpux +# HP-KANA8 hpux +# DEC-KANJI osf +# DEC-HANYU osf +# UTF-8 glibc aix hpux osf solaris yes +# +# Note: Names which are not marked as being a MIME name should not be used in +# Internet protocols for information interchange (mail, news, etc.). +# +# Note: ASCII and ANSI_X3.4-1968 are synonymous canonical names. Applications +# must understand both names and treat them as equivalent. +# +# The first argument passed to this file is the canonical host specification, +# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM +# or +# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM + +host="$1" +os=`echo "$host" | sed -e 's/^[^-]*-[^-]*-\(.*\)$/\1/'` +echo "# This file contains a table of character encoding aliases," +echo "# suitable for operating system '${os}'." +echo "# It was automatically generated from config.charset." +# List of references, updated during installation: +echo "# Packages using this file: " +case "$os" in + linux* | *-gnu*) + # With glibc-2.1 or newer, we don't need any canonicalization, + # because glibc has iconv and both glibc and libiconv support all + # GNU canonical names directly. Therefore, the Makefile does not + # need to install the alias file at all. + # The following applies only to glibc-2.0.x and older libcs. + echo "ISO_646.IRV:1983 ASCII" + ;; + aix*) + echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" + echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" + echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" + echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6" + echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" + echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8" + echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" + echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" + echo "IBM-850 CP850" + echo "IBM-856 CP856" + echo "IBM-921 ISO-8859-13" + echo "IBM-922 CP922" + echo "IBM-932 CP932" + echo "IBM-943 CP943" + echo "IBM-1046 CP1046" + echo "IBM-1124 CP1124" + echo "IBM-1129 CP1129" + echo "IBM-1252 CP1252" + echo "IBM-eucCN GB2312" + echo "IBM-eucJP EUC-JP" + echo "IBM-eucKR EUC-KR" + echo "IBM-eucTW EUC-TW" + echo "big5 BIG5" + echo "GBK GBK" + echo "TIS-620 TIS-620" + echo "UTF-8 UTF-8" + ;; + hpux*) + echo "iso88591 ISO-8859-1" + echo "iso88592 ISO-8859-2" + echo "iso88595 ISO-8859-5" + echo "iso88596 ISO-8859-6" + echo "iso88597 ISO-8859-7" + echo "iso88598 ISO-8859-8" + echo "iso88599 ISO-8859-9" + echo "iso885915 ISO-8859-15" + echo "roman8 HP-ROMAN8" + echo "arabic8 HP-ARABIC8" + echo "greek8 HP-GREEK8" + echo "hebrew8 HP-HEBREW8" + echo "turkish8 HP-TURKISH8" + echo "kana8 HP-KANA8" + echo "tis620 TIS-620" + echo "big5 BIG5" + echo "eucJP EUC-JP" + echo "eucKR EUC-KR" + echo "eucTW EUC-TW" + echo "hp15CN GB2312" + #echo "ccdc ?" # what is this? + echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS" + echo "utf8 UTF-8" + ;; + irix*) + echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" + echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" + echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" + echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" + echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" + echo "eucCN GB2312" + echo "eucJP EUC-JP" + echo "eucKR EUC-KR" + echo "eucTW EUC-TW" + ;; + osf*) + echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" + echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" + echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4" + echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" + echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" + echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8" + echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" + echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" + echo "cp850 CP850" + echo "big5 BIG5" + echo "dechanyu DEC-HANYU" + echo "dechanzi GB2312" + echo "deckanji DEC-KANJI" + echo "deckorean EUC-KR" + echo "eucJP EUC-JP" + echo "eucKR EUC-KR" + echo "eucTW EUC-TW" + echo "GBK GBK" + echo "KSC5601 CP949" + echo "sdeckanji EUC-JP" + echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS" + echo "TACTIS TIS-620" + echo "UTF-8 UTF-8" + ;; + solaris*) + echo "646 ASCII" + echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" + echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" + echo "ISO8859-3 ISO-8859-3" + echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4" + echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" + echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6" + echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" + echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8" + echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" + echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" + echo "koi8-r KOI8-R" + echo "ansi-1251 CP1251" + echo "BIG5 BIG5" + echo "Big5-HKSCS BIG5-HKSCS" + echo "gb2312 GB2312" + echo "GBK GBK" + echo "GB18030 GB18030" + echo "cns11643 EUC-TW" + echo "5601 EUC-KR" + echo "ko_KR.johap92 JOHAB" + echo "eucJP EUC-JP" + echo "PCK SHIFT_JIS" + echo "TIS620.2533 TIS-620" + #echo "sun_eu_greek ?" # what is this? + echo "UTF-8 UTF-8" + ;; + freebsd* | os2*) + # FreeBSD 4.2 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore + # localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name + # from the environment variables. + # Likewise for OS/2. OS/2 has XFree86 just like FreeBSD. Just + # reuse FreeBSD's locale data for OS/2. + echo "C ASCII" + echo "US-ASCII ASCII" + for l in la_LN lt_LN; do + echo "$l.ASCII ASCII" + done + for l in da_DK de_AT de_CH de_DE en_AU en_CA en_GB en_US es_ES \ + fi_FI fr_BE fr_CA fr_CH fr_FR is_IS it_CH it_IT la_LN \ + lt_LN nl_BE nl_NL no_NO pt_PT sv_SE; do + echo "$l.ISO_8859-1 ISO-8859-1" + echo "$l.DIS_8859-15 ISO-8859-15" + done + for l in cs_CZ hr_HR hu_HU la_LN lt_LN pl_PL sl_SI; do + echo "$l.ISO_8859-2 ISO-8859-2" + done + for l in la_LN lt_LT; do + echo "$l.ISO_8859-4 ISO-8859-4" + done + for l in ru_RU ru_SU; do + echo "$l.KOI8-R KOI8-R" + echo "$l.ISO_8859-5 ISO-8859-5" + echo "$l.CP866 CP866" + done + echo "uk_UA.KOI8-U KOI8-U" + echo "zh_TW.BIG5 BIG5" + echo "zh_TW.Big5 BIG5" + echo "zh_CN.EUC GB2312" + echo "ja_JP.EUC EUC-JP" + echo "ja_JP.SJIS SHIFT_JIS" + echo "ja_JP.Shift_JIS SHIFT_JIS" + echo "ko_KR.EUC EUC-KR" + ;; + netbsd*) + echo "646 ASCII" + echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" + echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" + echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4" + echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" + echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" + echo "eucCN GB2312" + echo "eucJP EUC-JP" + echo "eucKR EUC-KR" + echo "eucTW EUC-TW" + echo "BIG5 BIG5" + echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS" + ;; + beos*) + # BeOS has a single locale, and it has UTF-8 encoding. + echo "* UTF-8" + ;; + msdosdjgpp*) + # DJGPP 2.03 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore + # localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name + # from the environment variables. + echo "#" + echo "# The encodings given here may not all be correct." + echo "# If you find that the encoding given for your language and" + echo "# country is not the one your DOS machine actually uses, just" + echo "# correct it in this file, and send a mail to" + echo "# Juan Manuel Guerrero <st001906@hrz1.hrz.tu-darmstadt.de>" + echo "# and Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>." + echo "#" + echo "C ASCII" + # ISO-8859-1 languages + echo "ca CP850" + echo "ca_ES CP850" + echo "da CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "da_DK CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "de CP850" + echo "de_AT CP850" + echo "de_CH CP850" + echo "de_DE CP850" + echo "en CP850" + echo "en_AU CP850" # not CP437 ?? + echo "en_CA CP850" + echo "en_GB CP850" + echo "en_NZ CP437" + echo "en_US CP437" + echo "en_ZA CP850" # not CP437 ?? + echo "es CP850" + echo "es_AR CP850" + echo "es_BO CP850" + echo "es_CL CP850" + echo "es_CO CP850" + echo "es_CR CP850" + echo "es_CU CP850" + echo "es_DO CP850" + echo "es_EC CP850" + echo "es_ES CP850" + echo "es_GT CP850" + echo "es_HN CP850" + echo "es_MX CP850" + echo "es_NI CP850" + echo "es_PA CP850" + echo "es_PY CP850" + echo "es_PE CP850" + echo "es_SV CP850" + echo "es_UY CP850" + echo "es_VE CP850" + echo "et CP850" + echo "et_EE CP850" + echo "eu CP850" + echo "eu_ES CP850" + echo "fi CP850" + echo "fi_FI CP850" + echo "fr CP850" + echo "fr_BE CP850" + echo "fr_CA CP850" + echo "fr_CH CP850" + echo "fr_FR CP850" + echo "ga CP850" + echo "ga_IE CP850" + echo "gd CP850" + echo "gd_GB CP850" + echo "gl CP850" + echo "gl_ES CP850" + echo "id CP850" # not CP437 ?? + echo "id_ID CP850" # not CP437 ?? + echo "is CP861" # not CP850 ?? + echo "is_IS CP861" # not CP850 ?? + echo "it CP850" + echo "it_CH CP850" + echo "it_IT CP850" + echo "lt CP775" + echo "lt_LT CP775" + echo "lv CP775" + echo "lv_LV CP775" + echo "nb CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "nb_NO CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "nl CP850" + echo "nl_BE CP850" + echo "nl_NL CP850" + echo "nn CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "nn_NO CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "no CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "no_NO CP865" # not CP850 ?? + echo "pt CP850" + echo "pt_BR CP850" + echo "pt_PT CP850" + echo "sv CP850" + echo "sv_SE CP850" + # ISO-8859-2 languages + echo "cs CP852" + echo "cs_CZ CP852" + echo "hr CP852" + echo "hr_HR CP852" + echo "hu CP852" + echo "hu_HU CP852" + echo "pl CP852" + echo "pl_PL CP852" + echo "ro CP852" + echo "ro_RO CP852" + echo "sk CP852" + echo "sk_SK CP852" + echo "sl CP852" + echo "sl_SI CP852" + echo "sq CP852" + echo "sq_AL CP852" + echo "sr CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ?? + echo "sr_YU CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ?? + # ISO-8859-3 languages + echo "mt CP850" + echo "mt_MT CP850" + # ISO-8859-5 languages + echo "be CP866" + echo "be_BE CP866" + echo "bg CP866" # not CP855 ?? + echo "bg_BG CP866" # not CP855 ?? + echo "mk CP866" # not CP855 ?? + echo "mk_MK CP866" # not CP855 ?? + echo "ru CP866" + echo "ru_RU CP866" + echo "uk CP1125" + echo "uk_UA CP1125" + # ISO-8859-6 languages + echo "ar CP864" + echo "ar_AE CP864" + echo "ar_DZ CP864" + echo "ar_EG CP864" + echo "ar_IQ CP864" + echo "ar_IR CP864" + echo "ar_JO CP864" + echo "ar_KW CP864" + echo "ar_MA CP864" + echo "ar_OM CP864" + echo "ar_QA CP864" + echo "ar_SA CP864" + echo "ar_SY CP864" + # ISO-8859-7 languages + echo "el CP869" + echo "el_GR CP869" + # ISO-8859-8 languages + echo "he CP862" + echo "he_IL CP862" + # ISO-8859-9 languages + echo "tr CP857" + echo "tr_TR CP857" + # Japanese + echo "ja CP932" + echo "ja_JP CP932" + # Chinese + echo "zh_CN GBK" + echo "zh_TW CP950" # not CP938 ?? + # Korean + echo "kr CP949" # not CP934 ?? + echo "kr_KR CP949" # not CP934 ?? + # Thai + echo "th CP874" + echo "th_TH CP874" + # Other + echo "eo CP850" + echo "eo_EO CP850" + ;; +esac
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/dcgettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +/* Implementation of the dcgettext(3) function. + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include "gettextP.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define DCGETTEXT __dcgettext +# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext +#else +# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext +# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY + locale. */ +char * +DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, category) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid; + int category; +{ + return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, NULL, 0, 0, category); +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ +INTDEF(__dcgettext) +weak_alias (__dcgettext, dcgettext); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/dcigettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,1238 @@ +/* Implementation of the internal dcigettext function. + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy(). + This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include + <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ +#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE +# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <sys/types.h> + +#ifdef __GNUC__ +# define alloca __builtin_alloca +# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1 +#else +# ifdef _MSC_VER +# include <malloc.h> +# define alloca _alloca +# else +# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC +# include <alloca.h> +# else +# ifdef _AIX + #pragma alloca +# else +# ifndef alloca +char *alloca (); +# endif +# endif +# endif +# endif +#endif + +#include <errno.h> +#ifndef errno +extern int errno; +#endif +#ifndef __set_errno +# define __set_errno(val) errno = (val) +#endif + +#include <stddef.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC +# include <unistd.h> +#endif + +#include <locale.h> + +#ifdef _LIBC + /* Guess whether integer division by zero raises signal SIGFPE. + Set to 1 only if you know for sure. In case of doubt, set to 0. */ +# if defined __alpha__ || defined __arm__ || defined __i386__ \ + || defined __m68k__ || defined __s390__ +# define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 1 +# else +# define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 0 +# endif +#endif +#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE +# include <signal.h> +#endif + +#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H || defined _LIBC +# include <sys/param.h> +#endif + +#include "gettextP.h" +#include "plural-exp.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif +#include "hash-string.h" + +/* Thread safetyness. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <bits/libc-lock.h> +#else +/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */ +# define __libc_lock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME) +# define __libc_lock_lock(NAME) +# define __libc_lock_unlock(NAME) +# define __libc_rwlock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME) +# define __libc_rwlock_rdlock(NAME) +# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME) +#endif + +/* Alignment of types. */ +#if defined __GNUC__ && __GNUC__ >= 2 +# define alignof(TYPE) __alignof__ (TYPE) +#else +# define alignof(TYPE) \ + ((int) &((struct { char dummy1; TYPE dummy2; } *) 0)->dummy2) +#endif + +/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different + names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs + using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */ +#if !defined _LIBC +# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain +# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain +# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname +# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings +#endif + +/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>. */ +#ifndef offsetof +# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident)) +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard + because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object + file and the name space must not be polluted. */ +# define getcwd __getcwd +# ifndef stpcpy +# define stpcpy __stpcpy +# endif +# define tfind __tfind +#else +# if !defined HAVE_GETCWD +char *getwd (); +# define getcwd(buf, max) getwd (buf) +# else +char *getcwd (); +# endif +# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY +static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src)); +# endif +# ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY +static void *mempcpy PARAMS ((void *dest, const void *src, size_t n)); +# endif +#endif + +/* Amount to increase buffer size by in each try. */ +#define PATH_INCR 32 + +/* The following is from pathmax.h. */ +/* Non-POSIX BSD systems might have gcc's limits.h, which doesn't define + PATH_MAX but might cause redefinition warnings when sys/param.h is + later included (as on MORE/BSD 4.3). */ +#if defined _POSIX_VERSION || (defined HAVE_LIMITS_H && !defined __GNUC__) +# include <limits.h> +#endif + +#ifndef _POSIX_PATH_MAX +# define _POSIX_PATH_MAX 255 +#endif + +#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined _PC_PATH_MAX +# define PATH_MAX (pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX) < 1 ? 1024 : pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX)) +#endif + +/* Don't include sys/param.h if it already has been. */ +#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H && !defined PATH_MAX && !defined MAXPATHLEN +# include <sys/param.h> +#endif + +#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined MAXPATHLEN +# define PATH_MAX MAXPATHLEN +#endif + +#ifndef PATH_MAX +# define PATH_MAX _POSIX_PATH_MAX +#endif + +/* Pathname support. + ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character. + IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) tests whether P is an absolute path. If it is not, + it may be concatenated to a directory pathname. + IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) tests whether P contains a directory specification. + */ +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ + /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') +# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \ + ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \ + && (P)[1] == ':') +# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P)) +# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \ + (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P)) +#else + /* Unix */ +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/') +# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0]) +# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL) +#endif + +/* This is the type used for the search tree where known translations + are stored. */ +struct known_translation_t +{ + /* Domain in which to search. */ + char *domainname; + + /* The category. */ + int category; + + /* State of the catalog counter at the point the string was found. */ + int counter; + + /* Catalog where the string was found. */ + struct loaded_l10nfile *domain; + + /* And finally the translation. */ + const char *translation; + size_t translation_length; + + /* Pointer to the string in question. */ + char msgid[ZERO]; +}; + +/* Root of the search tree with known translations. We can use this + only if the system provides the `tsearch' function family. */ +#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC +# include <search.h> + +static void *root; + +# ifdef _LIBC +# define tsearch __tsearch +# endif + +/* Function to compare two entries in the table of known translations. */ +static int transcmp PARAMS ((const void *p1, const void *p2)); +static int +transcmp (p1, p2) + const void *p1; + const void *p2; +{ + const struct known_translation_t *s1; + const struct known_translation_t *s2; + int result; + + s1 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p1; + s2 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p2; + + result = strcmp (s1->msgid, s2->msgid); + if (result == 0) + { + result = strcmp (s1->domainname, s2->domainname); + if (result == 0) + /* We compare the category last (though this is the cheapest + operation) since it is hopefully always the same (namely + LC_MESSAGES). */ + result = s1->category - s2->category; + } + + return result; +} +#endif + +#ifndef INTVARDEF +# define INTVARDEF(name) +#endif +#ifndef INTUSE +# define INTUSE(name) name +#endif + +/* Name of the default domain used for gettext(3) prior any call to + textdomain(3). The default value for this is "messages". */ +const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden = "messages"; + +/* Value used as the default domain for gettext(3). */ +const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden + = _nl_default_default_domain; + +/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs. */ +#if defined __EMX__ +extern const char _nl_default_dirname[]; +#else +const char _nl_default_dirname[] = LOCALEDIR; +INTVARDEF (_nl_default_dirname) +#endif + +/* List with bindings of specific domains created by bindtextdomain() + calls. */ +struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings; + +/* Prototypes for local functions. */ +static char *plural_lookup PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *domain, + unsigned long int n, + const char *translation, + size_t translation_len)) + internal_function; +static const char *guess_category_value PARAMS ((int category, + const char *categoryname)) + internal_function; +#ifdef _LIBC +# include "../locale/localeinfo.h" +# define category_to_name(category) _nl_category_names[category] +#else +static const char *category_to_name PARAMS ((int category)) internal_function; +#endif + + +/* For those loosing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add + some additional code emulating it. */ +#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA +/* Nothing has to be done. */ +# define freea(p) /* nothing */ +# define ADD_BLOCK(list, address) /* nothing */ +# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) /* nothing */ +#else +struct block_list +{ + void *address; + struct block_list *next; +}; +# define ADD_BLOCK(list, addr) \ + do { \ + struct block_list *newp = (struct block_list *) malloc (sizeof (*newp)); \ + /* If we cannot get a free block we cannot add the new element to \ + the list. */ \ + if (newp != NULL) { \ + newp->address = (addr); \ + newp->next = (list); \ + (list) = newp; \ + } \ + } while (0) +# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) \ + do { \ + while (list != NULL) { \ + struct block_list *old = list; \ + list = list->next; \ + free (old->address); \ + free (old); \ + } \ + } while (0) +# undef alloca +# define alloca(size) (malloc (size)) +# define freea(p) free (p) +#endif /* have alloca */ + + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* List of blocks allocated for translations. */ +typedef struct transmem_list +{ + struct transmem_list *next; + char data[ZERO]; +} transmem_block_t; +static struct transmem_list *transmem_list; +#else +typedef unsigned char transmem_block_t; +#endif + + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext +#else +# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext +#endif + +/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +__libc_rwlock_define_initialized (, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden) +#endif + +/* Checking whether the binaries runs SUID must be done and glibc provides + easier methods therefore we make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define ENABLE_SECURE __libc_enable_secure +# define DETERMINE_SECURE +#else +# ifndef HAVE_GETUID +# define getuid() 0 +# endif +# ifndef HAVE_GETGID +# define getgid() 0 +# endif +# ifndef HAVE_GETEUID +# define geteuid() getuid() +# endif +# ifndef HAVE_GETEGID +# define getegid() getgid() +# endif +static int enable_secure; +# define ENABLE_SECURE (enable_secure == 1) +# define DETERMINE_SECURE \ + if (enable_secure == 0) \ + { \ + if (getuid () != geteuid () || getgid () != getegid ()) \ + enable_secure = 1; \ + else \ + enable_secure = -1; \ + } +#endif + +/* Get the function to evaluate the plural expression. */ +#include "eval-plural.h" + +/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current + CATEGORY locale and, if PLURAL is nonzero, search over string + depending on the plural form determined by N. */ +char * +DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural, n, category) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + int plural; + unsigned long int n; + int category; +{ +#ifndef HAVE_ALLOCA + struct block_list *block_list = NULL; +#endif + struct loaded_l10nfile *domain; + struct binding *binding; + const char *categoryname; + const char *categoryvalue; + char *dirname, *xdomainname; + char *single_locale; + char *retval; + size_t retlen; + int saved_errno; +#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC + struct known_translation_t *search; + struct known_translation_t **foundp = NULL; + size_t msgid_len; +#endif + size_t domainname_len; + + /* If no real MSGID is given return NULL. */ + if (msgid1 == NULL) + return NULL; + +#ifdef _LIBC + if (category < 0 || category >= __LC_LAST || category == LC_ALL) + /* Bogus. */ + return (plural == 0 + ? (char *) msgid1 + /* Use the Germanic plural rule. */ + : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2); +#endif + + __libc_rwlock_rdlock (_nl_state_lock); + + /* If DOMAINNAME is NULL, we are interested in the default domain. If + CATEGORY is not LC_MESSAGES this might not make much sense but the + definition left this undefined. */ + if (domainname == NULL) + domainname = _nl_current_default_domain; + + /* OS/2 specific: backward compatibility with older libintl versions */ +#ifdef LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT + if (category == LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT) + category = LC_MESSAGES; +#endif + +#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC + msgid_len = strlen (msgid1) + 1; + + /* Try to find the translation among those which we found at + some time. */ + search = (struct known_translation_t *) + alloca (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid) + msgid_len); + memcpy (search->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len); + search->domainname = (char *) domainname; + search->category = category; + + foundp = (struct known_translation_t **) tfind (search, &root, transcmp); + freea (search); + if (foundp != NULL && (*foundp)->counter == _nl_msg_cat_cntr) + { + /* Now deal with plural. */ + if (plural) + retval = plural_lookup ((*foundp)->domain, n, (*foundp)->translation, + (*foundp)->translation_length); + else + retval = (char *) (*foundp)->translation; + + __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); + return retval; + } +#endif + + /* Preserve the `errno' value. */ + saved_errno = errno; + + /* See whether this is a SUID binary or not. */ + DETERMINE_SECURE; + + /* First find matching binding. */ + for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next) + { + int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname); + if (compare == 0) + /* We found it! */ + break; + if (compare < 0) + { + /* It is not in the list. */ + binding = NULL; + break; + } + } + + if (binding == NULL) + dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); + else if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (binding->dirname)) + dirname = binding->dirname; + else + { + /* We have a relative path. Make it absolute now. */ + size_t dirname_len = strlen (binding->dirname) + 1; + size_t path_max; + char *ret; + + path_max = (unsigned int) PATH_MAX; + path_max += 2; /* The getcwd docs say to do this. */ + + for (;;) + { + dirname = (char *) alloca (path_max + dirname_len); + ADD_BLOCK (block_list, dirname); + + __set_errno (0); + ret = getcwd (dirname, path_max); + if (ret != NULL || errno != ERANGE) + break; + + path_max += path_max / 2; + path_max += PATH_INCR; + } + + if (ret == NULL) + /* We cannot get the current working directory. Don't signal an + error but simply return the default string. */ + goto return_untranslated; + + stpcpy (stpcpy (strchr (dirname, '\0'), "/"), binding->dirname); + } + + /* Now determine the symbolic name of CATEGORY and its value. */ + categoryname = category_to_name (category); + categoryvalue = guess_category_value (category, categoryname); + + domainname_len = strlen (domainname); + xdomainname = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryname) + + domainname_len + 5); + ADD_BLOCK (block_list, xdomainname); + + stpcpy (mempcpy (stpcpy (stpcpy (xdomainname, categoryname), "/"), + domainname, domainname_len), + ".mo"); + + /* Creating working area. */ + single_locale = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryvalue) + 1); + ADD_BLOCK (block_list, single_locale); + + + /* Search for the given string. This is a loop because we perhaps + got an ordered list of languages to consider for the translation. */ + while (1) + { + /* Make CATEGORYVALUE point to the next element of the list. */ + while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] == ':') + ++categoryvalue; + if (categoryvalue[0] == '\0') + { + /* The whole contents of CATEGORYVALUE has been searched but + no valid entry has been found. We solve this situation + by implicitly appending a "C" entry, i.e. no translation + will take place. */ + single_locale[0] = 'C'; + single_locale[1] = '\0'; + } + else + { + char *cp = single_locale; + while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] != ':') + *cp++ = *categoryvalue++; + *cp = '\0'; + + /* When this is a SUID binary we must not allow accessing files + outside the dedicated directories. */ + if (ENABLE_SECURE && IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (single_locale)) + /* Ingore this entry. */ + continue; + } + + /* If the current locale value is C (or POSIX) we don't load a + domain. Return the MSGID. */ + if (strcmp (single_locale, "C") == 0 + || strcmp (single_locale, "POSIX") == 0) + break; + + /* Find structure describing the message catalog matching the + DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY. */ + domain = _nl_find_domain (dirname, single_locale, xdomainname, binding); + + if (domain != NULL) + { + retval = _nl_find_msg (domain, binding, msgid1, &retlen); + + if (retval == NULL) + { + int cnt; + + for (cnt = 0; domain->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt) + { + retval = _nl_find_msg (domain->successor[cnt], binding, + msgid1, &retlen); + + if (retval != NULL) + { + domain = domain->successor[cnt]; + break; + } + } + } + + if (retval != NULL) + { + /* Found the translation of MSGID1 in domain DOMAIN: + starting at RETVAL, RETLEN bytes. */ + FREE_BLOCKS (block_list); +#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC + if (foundp == NULL) + { + /* Create a new entry and add it to the search tree. */ + struct known_translation_t *newp; + + newp = (struct known_translation_t *) + malloc (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid) + + msgid_len + domainname_len + 1); + if (newp != NULL) + { + newp->domainname = + mempcpy (newp->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len); + memcpy (newp->domainname, domainname, domainname_len + 1); + newp->category = category; + newp->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr; + newp->domain = domain; + newp->translation = retval; + newp->translation_length = retlen; + + /* Insert the entry in the search tree. */ + foundp = (struct known_translation_t **) + tsearch (newp, &root, transcmp); + if (foundp == NULL + || __builtin_expect (*foundp != newp, 0)) + /* The insert failed. */ + free (newp); + } + } + else + { + /* We can update the existing entry. */ + (*foundp)->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr; + (*foundp)->domain = domain; + (*foundp)->translation = retval; + (*foundp)->translation_length = retlen; + } +#endif + __set_errno (saved_errno); + + /* Now deal with plural. */ + if (plural) + retval = plural_lookup (domain, n, retval, retlen); + + __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); + return retval; + } + } + } + + return_untranslated: + /* Return the untranslated MSGID. */ + FREE_BLOCKS (block_list); + __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); +#ifndef _LIBC + if (!ENABLE_SECURE) + { + extern void _nl_log_untranslated PARAMS ((const char *logfilename, + const char *domainname, + const char *msgid1, + const char *msgid2, + int plural)); + const char *logfilename = getenv ("GETTEXT_LOG_UNTRANSLATED"); + + if (logfilename != NULL && logfilename[0] != '\0') + _nl_log_untranslated (logfilename, domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural); + } +#endif + __set_errno (saved_errno); + return (plural == 0 + ? (char *) msgid1 + /* Use the Germanic plural rule. */ + : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2); +} + + +char * +internal_function +_nl_find_msg (domain_file, domainbinding, msgid, lengthp) + struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file; + struct binding *domainbinding; + const char *msgid; + size_t *lengthp; +{ + struct loaded_domain *domain; + nls_uint32 nstrings; + size_t act; + char *result; + size_t resultlen; + + if (domain_file->decided == 0) + _nl_load_domain (domain_file, domainbinding); + + if (domain_file->data == NULL) + return NULL; + + domain = (struct loaded_domain *) domain_file->data; + + nstrings = domain->nstrings; + + /* Locate the MSGID and its translation. */ + if (domain->hash_tab != NULL) + { + /* Use the hashing table. */ + nls_uint32 len = strlen (msgid); + nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid); + nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size; + nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2)); + + while (1) + { + nls_uint32 nstr = + W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[idx]); + + if (nstr == 0) + /* Hash table entry is empty. */ + return NULL; + + nstr--; + + /* Compare msgid with the original string at index nstr. + We compare the lengths with >=, not ==, because plural entries + are represented by strings with an embedded NUL. */ + if (nstr < nstrings + ? W (domain->must_swap, domain->orig_tab[nstr].length) >= len + && (strcmp (msgid, + domain->data + W (domain->must_swap, + domain->orig_tab[nstr].offset)) + == 0) + : domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].length > len + && (strcmp (msgid, + domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].pointer) + == 0)) + { + act = nstr; + goto found; + } + + if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr) + idx -= domain->hash_size - incr; + else + idx += incr; + } + /* NOTREACHED */ + } + else + { + /* Try the default method: binary search in the sorted array of + messages. */ + size_t top, bottom; + + bottom = 0; + top = nstrings; + while (bottom < top) + { + int cmp_val; + + act = (bottom + top) / 2; + cmp_val = strcmp (msgid, (domain->data + + W (domain->must_swap, + domain->orig_tab[act].offset))); + if (cmp_val < 0) + top = act; + else if (cmp_val > 0) + bottom = act + 1; + else + goto found; + } + /* No translation was found. */ + return NULL; + } + + found: + /* The translation was found at index ACT. If we have to convert the + string to use a different character set, this is the time. */ + if (act < nstrings) + { + result = (char *) + (domain->data + W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].offset)); + resultlen = W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].length) + 1; + } + else + { + result = (char *) domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].pointer; + resultlen = domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].length; + } + +#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV + if (domain->codeset_cntr + != (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0)) + { + /* The domain's codeset has changed through bind_textdomain_codeset() + since the message catalog was initialized or last accessed. We + have to reinitialize the converter. */ + _nl_free_domain_conv (domain); + _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding); + } + + if ( +# ifdef _LIBC + domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1 +# else +# if HAVE_ICONV + domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1 +# endif +# endif + ) + { + /* We are supposed to do a conversion. First allocate an + appropriate table with the same structure as the table + of translations in the file, where we can put the pointers + to the converted strings in. + There is a slight complication with plural entries. They + are represented by consecutive NUL terminated strings. We + handle this case by converting RESULTLEN bytes, including + NULs. */ + + if (domain->conv_tab == NULL + && ((domain->conv_tab = + (char **) calloc (nstrings + domain->n_sysdep_strings, + sizeof (char *))) + == NULL)) + /* Mark that we didn't succeed allocating a table. */ + domain->conv_tab = (char **) -1; + + if (__builtin_expect (domain->conv_tab == (char **) -1, 0)) + /* Nothing we can do, no more memory. */ + goto converted; + + if (domain->conv_tab[act] == NULL) + { + /* We haven't used this string so far, so it is not + translated yet. Do this now. */ + /* We use a bit more efficient memory handling. + We allocate always larger blocks which get used over + time. This is faster than many small allocations. */ + __libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock) +# define INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE 4080 + static unsigned char *freemem; + static size_t freemem_size; + + const unsigned char *inbuf; + unsigned char *outbuf; + int malloc_count; +# ifndef _LIBC + transmem_block_t *transmem_list = NULL; +# endif + + __libc_lock_lock (lock); + + inbuf = (const unsigned char *) result; + outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t); + + malloc_count = 0; + while (1) + { + transmem_block_t *newmem; +# ifdef _LIBC + size_t non_reversible; + int res; + + if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t)) + goto resize_freemem; + + res = __gconv (domain->conv, + &inbuf, inbuf + resultlen, + &outbuf, + outbuf + freemem_size - sizeof (size_t), + &non_reversible); + + if (res == __GCONV_OK || res == __GCONV_EMPTY_INPUT) + break; + + if (res != __GCONV_FULL_OUTPUT) + { + __libc_lock_unlock (lock); + goto converted; + } + + inbuf = result; +# else +# if HAVE_ICONV + const char *inptr = (const char *) inbuf; + size_t inleft = resultlen; + char *outptr = (char *) outbuf; + size_t outleft; + + if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t)) + goto resize_freemem; + + outleft = freemem_size - sizeof (size_t); + if (iconv (domain->conv, + (ICONV_CONST char **) &inptr, &inleft, + &outptr, &outleft) + != (size_t) (-1)) + { + outbuf = (unsigned char *) outptr; + break; + } + if (errno != E2BIG) + { + __libc_lock_unlock (lock); + goto converted; + } +# endif +# endif + + resize_freemem: + /* We must allocate a new buffer or resize the old one. */ + if (malloc_count > 0) + { + ++malloc_count; + freemem_size = malloc_count * INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE; + newmem = (transmem_block_t *) realloc (transmem_list, + freemem_size); +# ifdef _LIBC + if (newmem != NULL) + transmem_list = transmem_list->next; + else + { + struct transmem_list *old = transmem_list; + + transmem_list = transmem_list->next; + free (old); + } +# endif + } + else + { + malloc_count = 1; + freemem_size = INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE; + newmem = (transmem_block_t *) malloc (freemem_size); + } + if (__builtin_expect (newmem == NULL, 0)) + { + freemem = NULL; + freemem_size = 0; + __libc_lock_unlock (lock); + goto converted; + } + +# ifdef _LIBC + /* Add the block to the list of blocks we have to free + at some point. */ + newmem->next = transmem_list; + transmem_list = newmem; + + freemem = newmem->data; + freemem_size -= offsetof (struct transmem_list, data); +# else + transmem_list = newmem; + freemem = newmem; +# endif + + outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t); + } + + /* We have now in our buffer a converted string. Put this + into the table of conversions. */ + *(size_t *) freemem = outbuf - freemem - sizeof (size_t); + domain->conv_tab[act] = (char *) freemem; + /* Shrink freemem, but keep it aligned. */ + freemem_size -= outbuf - freemem; + freemem = outbuf; + freemem += freemem_size & (alignof (size_t) - 1); + freemem_size = freemem_size & ~ (alignof (size_t) - 1); + + __libc_lock_unlock (lock); + } + + /* Now domain->conv_tab[act] contains the translation of all + the plural variants. */ + result = domain->conv_tab[act] + sizeof (size_t); + resultlen = *(size_t *) domain->conv_tab[act]; + } + + converted: + /* The result string is converted. */ + +#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */ + + *lengthp = resultlen; + return result; +} + + +/* Look up a plural variant. */ +static char * +internal_function +plural_lookup (domain, n, translation, translation_len) + struct loaded_l10nfile *domain; + unsigned long int n; + const char *translation; + size_t translation_len; +{ + struct loaded_domain *domaindata = (struct loaded_domain *) domain->data; + unsigned long int index; + const char *p; + + index = plural_eval (domaindata->plural, n); + if (index >= domaindata->nplurals) + /* This should never happen. It means the plural expression and the + given maximum value do not match. */ + index = 0; + + /* Skip INDEX strings at TRANSLATION. */ + p = translation; + while (index-- > 0) + { +#ifdef _LIBC + p = __rawmemchr (p, '\0'); +#else + p = strchr (p, '\0'); +#endif + /* And skip over the NUL byte. */ + p++; + + if (p >= translation + translation_len) + /* This should never happen. It means the plural expression + evaluated to a value larger than the number of variants + available for MSGID1. */ + return (char *) translation; + } + return (char *) p; +} + +#ifndef _LIBC +/* Return string representation of locale CATEGORY. */ +static const char * +internal_function +category_to_name (category) + int category; +{ + const char *retval; + + switch (category) + { +#ifdef LC_COLLATE + case LC_COLLATE: + retval = "LC_COLLATE"; + break; +#endif +#ifdef LC_CTYPE + case LC_CTYPE: + retval = "LC_CTYPE"; + break; +#endif +#ifdef LC_MONETARY + case LC_MONETARY: + retval = "LC_MONETARY"; + break; +#endif +#ifdef LC_NUMERIC + case LC_NUMERIC: + retval = "LC_NUMERIC"; + break; +#endif +#ifdef LC_TIME + case LC_TIME: + retval = "LC_TIME"; + break; +#endif +#ifdef LC_MESSAGES + case LC_MESSAGES: + retval = "LC_MESSAGES"; + break; +#endif +#ifdef LC_RESPONSE + case LC_RESPONSE: + retval = "LC_RESPONSE"; + break; +#endif +#ifdef LC_ALL + case LC_ALL: + /* This might not make sense but is perhaps better than any other + value. */ + retval = "LC_ALL"; + break; +#endif + default: + /* If you have a better idea for a default value let me know. */ + retval = "LC_XXX"; + } + + return retval; +} +#endif + +/* Guess value of current locale from value of the environment variables. */ +static const char * +internal_function +guess_category_value (category, categoryname) + int category; + const char *categoryname; +{ + const char *language; + const char *retval; + + /* The highest priority value is the `LANGUAGE' environment + variable. But we don't use the value if the currently selected + locale is the C locale. This is a GNU extension. */ + language = getenv ("LANGUAGE"); + if (language != NULL && language[0] == '\0') + language = NULL; + + /* We have to proceed with the POSIX methods of looking to `LC_ALL', + `LC_xxx', and `LANG'. On some systems this can be done by the + `setlocale' function itself. */ +#ifdef _LIBC + retval = __current_locale_name (category); +#else + retval = _nl_locale_name (category, categoryname); +#endif + + /* Ignore LANGUAGE if the locale is set to "C" because + 1. "C" locale usually uses the ASCII encoding, and most international + messages use non-ASCII characters. These characters get displayed + as question marks (if using glibc's iconv()) or as invalid 8-bit + characters (because other iconv()s refuse to convert most non-ASCII + characters to ASCII). In any case, the output is ugly. + 2. The precise output of some programs in the "C" locale is specified + by POSIX and should not depend on environment variables like + "LANGUAGE". We allow such programs to use gettext(). */ + return language != NULL && strcmp (retval, "C") != 0 ? language : retval; +} + +/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ + +/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library. So we + avoid the non-standard function stpcpy. In GNU C Library this + function is available, though. Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY + to be defined. */ +#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY +static char * +stpcpy (dest, src) + char *dest; + const char *src; +{ + while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0') + /* Do nothing. */ ; + return dest - 1; +} +#endif + +#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_MEMPCPY +static void * +mempcpy (dest, src, n) + void *dest; + const void *src; + size_t n; +{ + return (void *) ((char *) memcpy (dest, src, n) + n); +} +#endif + + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* If we want to free all resources we have to do some work at + program's end. */ +libc_freeres_fn (free_mem) +{ + void *old; + + while (_nl_domain_bindings != NULL) + { + struct binding *oldp = _nl_domain_bindings; + _nl_domain_bindings = _nl_domain_bindings->next; + if (oldp->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) + /* Yes, this is a pointer comparison. */ + free (oldp->dirname); + free (oldp->codeset); + free (oldp); + } + + if (_nl_current_default_domain != _nl_default_default_domain) + /* Yes, again a pointer comparison. */ + free ((char *) _nl_current_default_domain); + + /* Remove the search tree with the known translations. */ + __tdestroy (root, free); + root = NULL; + + while (transmem_list != NULL) + { + old = transmem_list; + transmem_list = transmem_list->next; + free (old); + } +} +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/dcngettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,60 @@ +/* Implementation of the dcngettext(3) function. + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include "gettextP.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext +# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext +#else +# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext +# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY + locale. */ +char * +DCNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + unsigned long int n; + int category; +{ + return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, 1, n, category); +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ +weak_alias (__dcngettext, dcngettext); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/dgettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +/* Implementation of the dgettext(3) function. + Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <locale.h> + +#include "gettextP.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define DGETTEXT __dgettext +# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext) +#else +# define DGETTEXT libintl_dgettext +# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current + LC_MESSAGES locale. */ +char * +DGETTEXT (domainname, msgid) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid; +{ + return DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, LC_MESSAGES); +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ +weak_alias (__dgettext, dgettext); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/dngettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ +/* Implementation of the dngettext(3) function. + Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <locale.h> + +#include "gettextP.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define DNGETTEXT __dngettext +# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext +#else +# define DNGETTEXT libintl_dngettext +# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current + LC_MESSAGES locale and skip message according to the plural form. */ +char * +DNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + unsigned long int n; +{ + return DCNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES); +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ +weak_alias (__dngettext, dngettext); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/eval-plural.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,114 @@ +/* Plural expression evaluation. + Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef STATIC +#define STATIC static +#endif + +/* Evaluate the plural expression and return an index value. */ +STATIC unsigned long int plural_eval PARAMS ((struct expression *pexp, + unsigned long int n)) + internal_function; + +STATIC +unsigned long int +internal_function +plural_eval (pexp, n) + struct expression *pexp; + unsigned long int n; +{ + switch (pexp->nargs) + { + case 0: + switch (pexp->operation) + { + case var: + return n; + case num: + return pexp->val.num; + default: + break; + } + /* NOTREACHED */ + break; + case 1: + { + /* pexp->operation must be lnot. */ + unsigned long int arg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n); + return ! arg; + } + case 2: + { + unsigned long int leftarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n); + if (pexp->operation == lor) + return leftarg || plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n); + else if (pexp->operation == land) + return leftarg && plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n); + else + { + unsigned long int rightarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n); + + switch (pexp->operation) + { + case mult: + return leftarg * rightarg; + case divide: +#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE + if (rightarg == 0) + raise (SIGFPE); +#endif + return leftarg / rightarg; + case module: +#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE + if (rightarg == 0) + raise (SIGFPE); +#endif + return leftarg % rightarg; + case plus: + return leftarg + rightarg; + case minus: + return leftarg - rightarg; + case less_than: + return leftarg < rightarg; + case greater_than: + return leftarg > rightarg; + case less_or_equal: + return leftarg <= rightarg; + case greater_or_equal: + return leftarg >= rightarg; + case equal: + return leftarg == rightarg; + case not_equal: + return leftarg != rightarg; + default: + break; + } + } + /* NOTREACHED */ + break; + } + case 3: + { + /* pexp->operation must be qmop. */ + unsigned long int boolarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n); + return plural_eval (pexp->val.args[boolarg ? 1 : 2], n); + } + } + /* NOTREACHED */ + return 0; +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/explodename.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,192 @@ +/* Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> +#include <sys/types.h> + +#include "loadinfo.h" + +/* On some strange systems still no definition of NULL is found. Sigh! */ +#ifndef NULL +# if defined __STDC__ && __STDC__ +# define NULL ((void *) 0) +# else +# define NULL 0 +# endif +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +char * +_nl_find_language (name) + const char *name; +{ + while (name[0] != '\0' && name[0] != '_' && name[0] != '@' + && name[0] != '+' && name[0] != ',') + ++name; + + return (char *) name; +} + + +int +_nl_explode_name (name, language, modifier, territory, codeset, + normalized_codeset, special, sponsor, revision) + char *name; + const char **language; + const char **modifier; + const char **territory; + const char **codeset; + const char **normalized_codeset; + const char **special; + const char **sponsor; + const char **revision; +{ + enum { undecided, xpg, cen } syntax; + char *cp; + int mask; + + *modifier = NULL; + *territory = NULL; + *codeset = NULL; + *normalized_codeset = NULL; + *special = NULL; + *sponsor = NULL; + *revision = NULL; + + /* Now we determine the single parts of the locale name. First + look for the language. Termination symbols are `_' and `@' if + we use XPG4 style, and `_', `+', and `,' if we use CEN syntax. */ + mask = 0; + syntax = undecided; + *language = cp = name; + cp = _nl_find_language (*language); + + if (*language == cp) + /* This does not make sense: language has to be specified. Use + this entry as it is without exploding. Perhaps it is an alias. */ + cp = strchr (*language, '\0'); + else if (cp[0] == '_') + { + /* Next is the territory. */ + cp[0] = '\0'; + *territory = ++cp; + + while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '.' && cp[0] != '@' + && cp[0] != '+' && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_') + ++cp; + + mask |= TERRITORY; + + if (cp[0] == '.') + { + /* Next is the codeset. */ + syntax = xpg; + cp[0] = '\0'; + *codeset = ++cp; + + while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '@') + ++cp; + + mask |= XPG_CODESET; + + if (*codeset != cp && (*codeset)[0] != '\0') + { + *normalized_codeset = _nl_normalize_codeset (*codeset, + cp - *codeset); + if (strcmp (*codeset, *normalized_codeset) == 0) + free ((char *) *normalized_codeset); + else + mask |= XPG_NORM_CODESET; + } + } + } + + if (cp[0] == '@' || (syntax != xpg && cp[0] == '+')) + { + /* Next is the modifier. */ + syntax = cp[0] == '@' ? xpg : cen; + cp[0] = '\0'; + *modifier = ++cp; + + while (syntax == cen && cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '+' + && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_') + ++cp; + + mask |= XPG_MODIFIER | CEN_AUDIENCE; + } + + if (syntax != xpg && (cp[0] == '+' || cp[0] == ',' || cp[0] == '_')) + { + syntax = cen; + + if (cp[0] == '+') + { + /* Next is special application (CEN syntax). */ + cp[0] = '\0'; + *special = ++cp; + + while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_') + ++cp; + + mask |= CEN_SPECIAL; + } + + if (cp[0] == ',') + { + /* Next is sponsor (CEN syntax). */ + cp[0] = '\0'; + *sponsor = ++cp; + + while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '_') + ++cp; + + mask |= CEN_SPONSOR; + } + + if (cp[0] == '_') + { + /* Next is revision (CEN syntax). */ + cp[0] = '\0'; + *revision = ++cp; + + mask |= CEN_REVISION; + } + } + + /* For CEN syntax values it might be important to have the + separator character in the file name, not for XPG syntax. */ + if (syntax == xpg) + { + if (*territory != NULL && (*territory)[0] == '\0') + mask &= ~TERRITORY; + + if (*codeset != NULL && (*codeset)[0] == '\0') + mask &= ~XPG_CODESET; + + if (*modifier != NULL && (*modifier)[0] == '\0') + mask &= ~XPG_MODIFIER; + } + + return mask; +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/finddomain.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,195 @@ +/* Handle list of needed message catalogs + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stdio.h> +#include <sys/types.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC +# include <unistd.h> +#endif + +#include "gettextP.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ +/* List of already loaded domains. */ +static struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_loaded_domains; + + +/* Return a data structure describing the message catalog described by + the DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY parameters with respect to the currently + established bindings. */ +struct loaded_l10nfile * +internal_function +_nl_find_domain (dirname, locale, domainname, domainbinding) + const char *dirname; + char *locale; + const char *domainname; + struct binding *domainbinding; +{ + struct loaded_l10nfile *retval; + const char *language; + const char *modifier; + const char *territory; + const char *codeset; + const char *normalized_codeset; + const char *special; + const char *sponsor; + const char *revision; + const char *alias_value; + int mask; + + /* LOCALE can consist of up to four recognized parts for the XPG syntax: + + language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier] + + and six parts for the CEN syntax: + + language[_territory][+audience][+special][,[sponsor][_revision]] + + Beside the first part all of them are allowed to be missing. If + the full specified locale is not found, the less specific one are + looked for. The various parts will be stripped off according to + the following order: + (1) revision + (2) sponsor + (3) special + (4) codeset + (5) normalized codeset + (6) territory + (7) audience/modifier + */ + + /* If we have already tested for this locale entry there has to + be one data set in the list of loaded domains. */ + retval = _nl_make_l10nflist (&_nl_loaded_domains, dirname, + strlen (dirname) + 1, 0, locale, NULL, NULL, + NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, domainname, 0); + if (retval != NULL) + { + /* We know something about this locale. */ + int cnt; + + if (retval->decided == 0) + _nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding); + + if (retval->data != NULL) + return retval; + + for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt) + { + if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0) + _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding); + + if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL) + break; + } + return cnt >= 0 ? retval : NULL; + /* NOTREACHED */ + } + + /* See whether the locale value is an alias. If yes its value + *overwrites* the alias name. No test for the original value is + done. */ + alias_value = _nl_expand_alias (locale); + if (alias_value != NULL) + { +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP + locale = strdup (alias_value); + if (locale == NULL) + return NULL; +#else + size_t len = strlen (alias_value) + 1; + locale = (char *) malloc (len); + if (locale == NULL) + return NULL; + + memcpy (locale, alias_value, len); +#endif + } + + /* Now we determine the single parts of the locale name. First + look for the language. Termination symbols are `_' and `@' if + we use XPG4 style, and `_', `+', and `,' if we use CEN syntax. */ + mask = _nl_explode_name (locale, &language, &modifier, &territory, + &codeset, &normalized_codeset, &special, + &sponsor, &revision); + + /* Create all possible locale entries which might be interested in + generalization. */ + retval = _nl_make_l10nflist (&_nl_loaded_domains, dirname, + strlen (dirname) + 1, mask, language, territory, + codeset, normalized_codeset, modifier, special, + sponsor, revision, domainname, 1); + if (retval == NULL) + /* This means we are out of core. */ + return NULL; + + if (retval->decided == 0) + _nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding); + if (retval->data == NULL) + { + int cnt; + for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt) + { + if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0) + _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding); + if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL) + break; + } + } + + /* The room for an alias was dynamically allocated. Free it now. */ + if (alias_value != NULL) + free (locale); + + /* The space for normalized_codeset is dynamically allocated. Free it. */ + if (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) + free ((void *) normalized_codeset); + + return retval; +} + + +#ifdef _LIBC +libc_freeres_fn (free_mem) +{ + struct loaded_l10nfile *runp = _nl_loaded_domains; + + while (runp != NULL) + { + struct loaded_l10nfile *here = runp; + if (runp->data != NULL) + _nl_unload_domain ((struct loaded_domain *) runp->data); + runp = runp->next; + free ((char *) here->filename); + free (here); + } +} +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/gettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/* Implementation of gettext(3) function. + Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#ifdef _LIBC +# define __need_NULL +# include <stddef.h> +#else +# include <stdlib.h> /* Just for NULL. */ +#endif + +#include "gettextP.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define GETTEXT __gettext +# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext) +#else +# define GETTEXT libintl_gettext +# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current + LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default + text). */ +char * +GETTEXT (msgid) + const char *msgid; +{ + return DCGETTEXT (NULL, msgid, LC_MESSAGES); +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ +weak_alias (__gettext, gettext); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/gettextP.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,224 @@ +/* Header describing internals of libintl library. + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef _GETTEXTP_H +#define _GETTEXTP_H + +#include <stddef.h> /* Get size_t. */ + +#ifdef _LIBC +# include "../iconv/gconv_int.h" +#else +# if HAVE_ICONV +# include <iconv.h> +# endif +#endif + +#include "loadinfo.h" + +#include "gmo.h" /* Get nls_uint32. */ + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +#ifndef PARAMS +# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES +# define PARAMS(args) args +# else +# define PARAMS(args) () +# endif +#endif + +#ifndef internal_function +# define internal_function +#endif + +#ifndef attribute_hidden +# define attribute_hidden +#endif + +/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is + almost always true or almost always false. */ +#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT +# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr) +#endif + +#ifndef W +# define W(flag, data) ((flag) ? SWAP (data) : (data)) +#endif + + +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <byteswap.h> +# define SWAP(i) bswap_32 (i) +#else +static inline nls_uint32 +SWAP (i) + nls_uint32 i; +{ + return (i << 24) | ((i & 0xff00) << 8) | ((i >> 8) & 0xff00) | (i >> 24); +} +#endif + + +/* In-memory representation of system dependent string. */ +struct sysdep_string_desc +{ + /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL. */ + size_t length; + /* Pointer to addressed string. */ + const char *pointer; +}; + +/* The representation of an opened message catalog. */ +struct loaded_domain +{ + /* Pointer to memory containing the .mo file. */ + const char *data; + /* 1 if the memory is mmap()ed, 0 if the memory is malloc()ed. */ + int use_mmap; + /* Size of mmap()ed memory. */ + size_t mmap_size; + /* 1 if the .mo file uses a different endianness than this machine. */ + int must_swap; + /* Pointer to additional malloc()ed memory. */ + void *malloced; + + /* Number of static strings pairs. */ + nls_uint32 nstrings; + /* Pointer to descriptors of original strings in the file. */ + const struct string_desc *orig_tab; + /* Pointer to descriptors of translated strings in the file. */ + const struct string_desc *trans_tab; + + /* Number of system dependent strings pairs. */ + nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings; + /* Pointer to descriptors of original sysdep strings. */ + const struct sysdep_string_desc *orig_sysdep_tab; + /* Pointer to descriptors of translated sysdep strings. */ + const struct sysdep_string_desc *trans_sysdep_tab; + + /* Size of hash table. */ + nls_uint32 hash_size; + /* Pointer to hash table. */ + const nls_uint32 *hash_tab; + /* 1 if the hash table uses a different endianness than this machine. */ + int must_swap_hash_tab; + + int codeset_cntr; +#ifdef _LIBC + __gconv_t conv; +#else +# if HAVE_ICONV + iconv_t conv; +# endif +#endif + char **conv_tab; + + struct expression *plural; + unsigned long int nplurals; +}; + +/* We want to allocate a string at the end of the struct. But ISO C + doesn't allow zero sized arrays. */ +#ifdef __GNUC__ +# define ZERO 0 +#else +# define ZERO 1 +#endif + +/* A set of settings bound to a message domain. Used to store settings + from bindtextdomain() and bind_textdomain_codeset(). */ +struct binding +{ + struct binding *next; + char *dirname; + int codeset_cntr; /* Incremented each time codeset changes. */ + char *codeset; + char domainname[ZERO]; +}; + +/* A counter which is incremented each time some previous translations + become invalid. + This variable is part of the external ABI of the GNU libintl. */ +extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr; + +#ifndef _LIBC +const char *_nl_locale_name PARAMS ((int category, const char *categoryname)); +#endif + +struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_find_domain PARAMS ((const char *__dirname, + char *__locale, + const char *__domainname, + struct binding *__domainbinding)) + internal_function; +void _nl_load_domain PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain, + struct binding *__domainbinding)) + internal_function; +void _nl_unload_domain PARAMS ((struct loaded_domain *__domain)) + internal_function; +const char *_nl_init_domain_conv PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain_file, + struct loaded_domain *__domain, + struct binding *__domainbinding)) + internal_function; +void _nl_free_domain_conv PARAMS ((struct loaded_domain *__domain)) + internal_function; + +char *_nl_find_msg PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file, + struct binding *domainbinding, + const char *msgid, size_t *lengthp)) + internal_function; + +#ifdef _LIBC +extern char *__gettext PARAMS ((const char *__msgid)); +extern char *__dgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid)); +extern char *__dcgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid, int __category)); +extern char *__ngettext PARAMS ((const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n)); +extern char *__dngettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int n)); +extern char *__dcngettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n, int __category)); +extern char *__dcigettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + int __plural, unsigned long int __n, + int __category)); +extern char *__textdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname)); +extern char *__bindtextdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__dirname)); +extern char *__bind_textdomain_codeset PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__codeset)); +#else +/* Declare the exported libintl_* functions, in a way that allows us to + call them under their real name. */ +# define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# include "libgnuintl.h" +extern char *libintl_dcigettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, + const char *__msgid2, + int __plural, unsigned long int __n, + int __category)); +#endif + +/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ + +#endif /* gettextP.h */
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/gmo.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,148 @@ +/* Description of GNU message catalog format: general file layout. + Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef _GETTEXT_H +#define _GETTEXT_H 1 + +#include <limits.h> + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* The magic number of the GNU message catalog format. */ +#define _MAGIC 0x950412de +#define _MAGIC_SWAPPED 0xde120495 + +/* Revision number of the currently used .mo (binary) file format. */ +#define MO_REVISION_NUMBER 0 + +/* The following contortions are an attempt to use the C preprocessor + to determine an unsigned integral type that is 32 bits wide. An + alternative approach is to use autoconf's AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro, but + as of version autoconf-2.13, the AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro doesn't work + when cross-compiling. */ + +#if __STDC__ +# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 4294967295U +#else +# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 0xFFFFFFFF +#endif + +/* If UINT_MAX isn't defined, assume it's a 32-bit type. + This should be valid for all systems GNU cares about because + that doesn't include 16-bit systems, and only modern systems + (that certainly have <limits.h>) have 64+-bit integral types. */ + +#ifndef UINT_MAX +# define UINT_MAX UINT_MAX_32_BITS +#endif + +#if UINT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS +typedef unsigned nls_uint32; +#else +# if USHRT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS +typedef unsigned short nls_uint32; +# else +# if ULONG_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS +typedef unsigned long nls_uint32; +# else + /* The following line is intended to throw an error. Using #error is + not portable enough. */ + "Cannot determine unsigned 32-bit data type." +# endif +# endif +#endif + + +/* Header for binary .mo file format. */ +struct mo_file_header +{ + /* The magic number. */ + nls_uint32 magic; + /* The revision number of the file format. */ + nls_uint32 revision; + + /* The following are only used in .mo files with major revision 0. */ + + /* The number of strings pairs. */ + nls_uint32 nstrings; + /* Offset of table with start offsets of original strings. */ + nls_uint32 orig_tab_offset; + /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated strings. */ + nls_uint32 trans_tab_offset; + /* Size of hash table. */ + nls_uint32 hash_tab_size; + /* Offset of first hash table entry. */ + nls_uint32 hash_tab_offset; + + /* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1. */ + + /* The number of system dependent segments. */ + nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments; + /* Offset of table describing system dependent segments. */ + nls_uint32 sysdep_segments_offset; + /* The number of system dependent strings pairs. */ + nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings; + /* Offset of table with start offsets of original sysdep strings. */ + nls_uint32 orig_sysdep_tab_offset; + /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated sysdep strings. */ + nls_uint32 trans_sysdep_tab_offset; +}; + +/* Descriptor for static string contained in the binary .mo file. */ +struct string_desc +{ + /* Length of addressed string, not including the trailing NUL. */ + nls_uint32 length; + /* Offset of string in file. */ + nls_uint32 offset; +}; + +/* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1. */ + +/* Descriptor for system dependent string segment. */ +struct sysdep_segment +{ + /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL. */ + nls_uint32 length; + /* Offset of string in file. */ + nls_uint32 offset; +}; + +/* Descriptor for system dependent string. */ +struct sysdep_string +{ + /* Offset of static string segments in file. */ + nls_uint32 offset; + /* Alternating sequence of static and system dependent segments. + The last segment is a static segment, including the trailing NUL. */ + struct segment_pair + { + /* Size of static segment. */ + nls_uint32 segsize; + /* Reference to system dependent string segment, or ~0 at the end. */ + nls_uint32 sysdepref; + } segments[1]; +}; + +/* Marker for the end of the segments[] array. This has the value 0xFFFFFFFF, + regardless whether 'int' is 16 bit, 32 bit, or 64 bit. */ +#define SEGMENTS_END ((nls_uint32) ~0) + +/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ + +#endif /* gettext.h */
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/hash-string.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,59 @@ +/* Description of GNU message catalog format: string hashing function. + Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 1998, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +#ifndef PARAMS +# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES +# define PARAMS(Args) Args +# else +# define PARAMS(Args) () +# endif +#endif + +/* We assume to have `unsigned long int' value with at least 32 bits. */ +#define HASHWORDBITS 32 + + +/* Defines the so called `hashpjw' function by P.J. Weinberger + [see Aho/Sethi/Ullman, COMPILERS: Principles, Techniques and Tools, + 1986, 1987 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Inc.] */ +static unsigned long int hash_string PARAMS ((const char *__str_param)); + +static inline unsigned long int +hash_string (str_param) + const char *str_param; +{ + unsigned long int hval, g; + const char *str = str_param; + + /* Compute the hash value for the given string. */ + hval = 0; + while (*str != '\0') + { + hval <<= 4; + hval += (unsigned long int) *str++; + g = hval & ((unsigned long int) 0xf << (HASHWORDBITS - 4)); + if (g != 0) + { + hval ^= g >> (HASHWORDBITS - 8); + hval ^= g; + } + } + return hval; +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/intl-compat.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,151 @@ +/* intl-compat.c - Stub functions to call gettext functions from GNU gettext + Library. + Copyright (C) 1995, 2000-2003 Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include "gettextP.h" + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* This file redirects the gettext functions (without prefix) to those + defined in the included GNU libintl library (with "libintl_" prefix). + It is compiled into libintl in order to make the AM_GNU_GETTEXT test + of gettext <= 0.11.2 work with the libintl library >= 0.11.3 which + has the redirections primarily in the <libintl.h> include file. + It is also compiled into libgnuintl so that libgnuintl.so can be used + as LD_PRELOADable library on glibc systems, to provide the extra + features that the functions in the libc don't have (namely, logging). */ + + +#undef gettext +#undef dgettext +#undef dcgettext +#undef ngettext +#undef dngettext +#undef dcngettext +#undef textdomain +#undef bindtextdomain +#undef bind_textdomain_codeset + + +/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions. Note that because + the functions are only defined for binary backward compatibility, we + don't need to use __declspec(dllimport) in any case. */ +#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL +# define DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport) +#else +# define DLL_EXPORTED +#endif + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +gettext (msgid) + const char *msgid; +{ + return libintl_gettext (msgid); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +dgettext (domainname, msgid) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid; +{ + return libintl_dgettext (domainname, msgid); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid; + int category; +{ + return libintl_dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +ngettext (msgid1, msgid2, n) + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + unsigned long int n; +{ + return libintl_ngettext (msgid1, msgid2, n); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +dngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + unsigned long int n; +{ + return libintl_dngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +dcngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category) + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + unsigned long int n; + int category; +{ + return libintl_dcngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +textdomain (domainname) + const char *domainname; +{ + return libintl_textdomain (domainname); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname) + const char *domainname; + const char *dirname; +{ + return libintl_bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname); +} + + +DLL_EXPORTED +char * +bind_textdomain_codeset (domainname, codeset) + const char *domainname; + const char *codeset; +{ + return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (domainname, codeset); +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/l10nflist.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,453 @@ +/* Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for stpcpy(). + This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include + <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ +#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE +# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <string.h> + +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_ARGZ_H +# include <argz.h> +#endif +#include <ctype.h> +#include <sys/types.h> +#include <stdlib.h> + +#include "loadinfo.h" + +/* On some strange systems still no definition of NULL is found. Sigh! */ +#ifndef NULL +# if defined __STDC__ && __STDC__ +# define NULL ((void *) 0) +# else +# define NULL 0 +# endif +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard + because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object + file and the name space must not be polluted. */ +# ifndef stpcpy +# define stpcpy(dest, src) __stpcpy(dest, src) +# endif +#else +# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY +static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src)); +# endif +#endif + +/* Pathname support. + ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character. + IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) tests whether P is an absolute path. If it is not, + it may be concatenated to a directory pathname. + */ +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ + /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') +# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \ + ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \ + && (P)[1] == ':') +# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P)) +#else + /* Unix */ +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/') +# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0]) +#endif + +/* Define function which are usually not available. */ + +#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT +/* Returns the number of strings in ARGZ. */ +static size_t argz_count__ PARAMS ((const char *argz, size_t len)); + +static size_t +argz_count__ (argz, len) + const char *argz; + size_t len; +{ + size_t count = 0; + while (len > 0) + { + size_t part_len = strlen (argz); + argz += part_len + 1; + len -= part_len + 1; + count++; + } + return count; +} +# undef __argz_count +# define __argz_count(argz, len) argz_count__ (argz, len) +#else +# ifdef _LIBC +# define __argz_count(argz, len) INTUSE(__argz_count) (argz, len) +# endif +#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT */ + +#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY +/* Make '\0' separated arg vector ARGZ printable by converting all the '\0's + except the last into the character SEP. */ +static void argz_stringify__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t len, int sep)); + +static void +argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep) + char *argz; + size_t len; + int sep; +{ + while (len > 0) + { + size_t part_len = strlen (argz); + argz += part_len; + len -= part_len + 1; + if (len > 0) + *argz++ = sep; + } +} +# undef __argz_stringify +# define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep) +#else +# ifdef _LIBC +# define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) \ + INTUSE(__argz_stringify) (argz, len, sep) +# endif +#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY */ + +#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_NEXT +static char *argz_next__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t argz_len, + const char *entry)); + +static char * +argz_next__ (argz, argz_len, entry) + char *argz; + size_t argz_len; + const char *entry; +{ + if (entry) + { + if (entry < argz + argz_len) + entry = strchr (entry, '\0') + 1; + + return entry >= argz + argz_len ? NULL : (char *) entry; + } + else + if (argz_len > 0) + return argz; + else + return 0; +} +# undef __argz_next +# define __argz_next(argz, len, entry) argz_next__ (argz, len, entry) +#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_NEXT */ + + +/* Return number of bits set in X. */ +static int pop PARAMS ((int x)); + +static inline int +pop (x) + int x; +{ + /* We assume that no more than 16 bits are used. */ + x = ((x & ~0x5555) >> 1) + (x & 0x5555); + x = ((x & ~0x3333) >> 2) + (x & 0x3333); + x = ((x >> 4) + x) & 0x0f0f; + x = ((x >> 8) + x) & 0xff; + + return x; +} + + +struct loaded_l10nfile * +_nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len, mask, language, + territory, codeset, normalized_codeset, modifier, special, + sponsor, revision, filename, do_allocate) + struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list; + const char *dirlist; + size_t dirlist_len; + int mask; + const char *language; + const char *territory; + const char *codeset; + const char *normalized_codeset; + const char *modifier; + const char *special; + const char *sponsor; + const char *revision; + const char *filename; + int do_allocate; +{ + char *abs_filename; + struct loaded_l10nfile **lastp; + struct loaded_l10nfile *retval; + char *cp; + size_t dirlist_count; + size_t entries; + int cnt; + + /* If LANGUAGE contains an absolute directory specification, we ignore + DIRLIST. */ + if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (language)) + dirlist_len = 0; + + /* Allocate room for the full file name. */ + abs_filename = (char *) malloc (dirlist_len + + strlen (language) + + ((mask & TERRITORY) != 0 + ? strlen (territory) + 1 : 0) + + ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0 + ? strlen (codeset) + 1 : 0) + + ((mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0 + ? strlen (normalized_codeset) + 1 : 0) + + (((mask & XPG_MODIFIER) != 0 + || (mask & CEN_AUDIENCE) != 0) + ? strlen (modifier) + 1 : 0) + + ((mask & CEN_SPECIAL) != 0 + ? strlen (special) + 1 : 0) + + (((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0 + || (mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0) + ? (1 + ((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0 + ? strlen (sponsor) : 0) + + ((mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0 + ? strlen (revision) + 1 : 0)) : 0) + + 1 + strlen (filename) + 1); + + if (abs_filename == NULL) + return NULL; + + /* Construct file name. */ + cp = abs_filename; + if (dirlist_len > 0) + { + memcpy (cp, dirlist, dirlist_len); + __argz_stringify (cp, dirlist_len, PATH_SEPARATOR); + cp += dirlist_len; + cp[-1] = '/'; + } + + cp = stpcpy (cp, language); + + if ((mask & TERRITORY) != 0) + { + *cp++ = '_'; + cp = stpcpy (cp, territory); + } + if ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0) + { + *cp++ = '.'; + cp = stpcpy (cp, codeset); + } + if ((mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0) + { + *cp++ = '.'; + cp = stpcpy (cp, normalized_codeset); + } + if ((mask & (XPG_MODIFIER | CEN_AUDIENCE)) != 0) + { + /* This component can be part of both syntaces but has different + leading characters. For CEN we use `+', else `@'. */ + *cp++ = (mask & CEN_AUDIENCE) != 0 ? '+' : '@'; + cp = stpcpy (cp, modifier); + } + if ((mask & CEN_SPECIAL) != 0) + { + *cp++ = '+'; + cp = stpcpy (cp, special); + } + if ((mask & (CEN_SPONSOR | CEN_REVISION)) != 0) + { + *cp++ = ','; + if ((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0) + cp = stpcpy (cp, sponsor); + if ((mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0) + { + *cp++ = '_'; + cp = stpcpy (cp, revision); + } + } + + *cp++ = '/'; + stpcpy (cp, filename); + + /* Look in list of already loaded domains whether it is already + available. */ + lastp = l10nfile_list; + for (retval = *l10nfile_list; retval != NULL; retval = retval->next) + if (retval->filename != NULL) + { + int compare = strcmp (retval->filename, abs_filename); + if (compare == 0) + /* We found it! */ + break; + if (compare < 0) + { + /* It's not in the list. */ + retval = NULL; + break; + } + + lastp = &retval->next; + } + + if (retval != NULL || do_allocate == 0) + { + free (abs_filename); + return retval; + } + + dirlist_count = (dirlist_len > 0 ? __argz_count (dirlist, dirlist_len) : 1); + + /* Allocate a new loaded_l10nfile. */ + retval = + (struct loaded_l10nfile *) + malloc (sizeof (*retval) + + (((dirlist_count << pop (mask)) + (dirlist_count > 1 ? 1 : 0)) + * sizeof (struct loaded_l10nfile *))); + if (retval == NULL) + return NULL; + + retval->filename = abs_filename; + + /* We set retval->data to NULL here; it is filled in later. + Setting retval->decided to 1 here means that retval does not + correspond to a real file (dirlist_count > 1) or is not worth + looking up (if an unnormalized codeset was specified). */ + retval->decided = (dirlist_count > 1 + || ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0 + && (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0)); + retval->data = NULL; + + retval->next = *lastp; + *lastp = retval; + + entries = 0; + /* Recurse to fill the inheritance list of RETVAL. + If the DIRLIST is a real list (i.e. DIRLIST_COUNT > 1), the RETVAL + entry does not correspond to a real file; retval->filename contains + colons. In this case we loop across all elements of DIRLIST and + across all bit patterns dominated by MASK. + If the DIRLIST is a single directory or entirely redundant (i.e. + DIRLIST_COUNT == 1), we loop across all bit patterns dominated by + MASK, excluding MASK itself. + In either case, we loop down from MASK to 0. This has the effect + that the extra bits in the locale name are dropped in this order: + first the modifier, then the territory, then the codeset, then the + normalized_codeset. */ + for (cnt = dirlist_count > 1 ? mask : mask - 1; cnt >= 0; --cnt) + if ((cnt & ~mask) == 0 + && ((cnt & CEN_SPECIFIC) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_SPECIFIC) == 0) + && ((cnt & XPG_CODESET) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_NORM_CODESET) == 0)) + { + if (dirlist_count > 1) + { + /* Iterate over all elements of the DIRLIST. */ + char *dir = NULL; + + while ((dir = __argz_next ((char *) dirlist, dirlist_len, dir)) + != NULL) + retval->successor[entries++] + = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dir, strlen (dir) + 1, + cnt, language, territory, codeset, + normalized_codeset, modifier, special, + sponsor, revision, filename, 1); + } + else + retval->successor[entries++] + = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len, + cnt, language, territory, codeset, + normalized_codeset, modifier, special, + sponsor, revision, filename, 1); + } + retval->successor[entries] = NULL; + + return retval; +} + +/* Normalize codeset name. There is no standard for the codeset + names. Normalization allows the user to use any of the common + names. The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be + freed by the caller. */ +const char * +_nl_normalize_codeset (codeset, name_len) + const char *codeset; + size_t name_len; +{ + int len = 0; + int only_digit = 1; + char *retval; + char *wp; + size_t cnt; + + for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt) + if (isalnum ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) + { + ++len; + + if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) + only_digit = 0; + } + + retval = (char *) malloc ((only_digit ? 3 : 0) + len + 1); + + if (retval != NULL) + { + if (only_digit) + wp = stpcpy (retval, "iso"); + else + wp = retval; + + for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt) + if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) + *wp++ = tolower ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]); + else if (isdigit ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) + *wp++ = codeset[cnt]; + + *wp = '\0'; + } + + return (const char *) retval; +} + + +/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ + +/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library. So we + avoid the non-standard function stpcpy. In GNU C Library this + function is available, though. Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY + to be defined. */ +#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY +static char * +stpcpy (dest, src) + char *dest; + const char *src; +{ + while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0') + /* Do nothing. */ ; + return dest - 1; +} +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/libgnuintl.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,309 @@ +/* Message catalogs for internationalization. + Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef _LIBINTL_H +#define _LIBINTL_H 1 + +#include <locale.h> + +/* The LC_MESSAGES locale category is the category used by the functions + gettext() and dgettext(). It is specified in POSIX, but not in ANSI C. + On systems that don't define it, use an arbitrary value instead. + On Solaris, <locale.h> defines __LOCALE_H (or _LOCALE_H in Solaris 2.5) + then includes <libintl.h> (i.e. this file!) and then only defines + LC_MESSAGES. To avoid a redefinition warning, don't define LC_MESSAGES + in this case. */ +#if !defined LC_MESSAGES && !(defined __LOCALE_H || (defined _LOCALE_H && defined __sun)) +# define LC_MESSAGES 1729 +#endif + +/* We define an additional symbol to signal that we use the GNU + implementation of gettext. */ +#define __USE_GNU_GETTEXT 1 + +/* Provide information about the supported file formats. Returns the + maximum minor revision number supported for a given major revision. */ +#define __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(major) \ + ((major) == 0 ? 1 : -1) + +/* Resolve a platform specific conflict on DJGPP. GNU gettext takes + precedence over _conio_gettext. */ +#ifdef __DJGPP__ +# undef gettext +#endif + +/* Use _INTL_PARAMS, not PARAMS, in order to avoid clashes with identifiers + used by programs. Similarly, test __PROTOTYPES, not PROTOTYPES. */ +#ifndef _INTL_PARAMS +# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES +# define _INTL_PARAMS(args) args +# else +# define _INTL_PARAMS(args) () +# endif +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + + +/* We redirect the functions to those prefixed with "libintl_". This is + necessary, because some systems define gettext/textdomain/... in the C + library (namely, Solaris 2.4 and newer, and GNU libc 2.0 and newer). + If we used the unprefixed names, there would be cases where the + definition in the C library would override the one in the libintl.so + shared library. Recall that on ELF systems, the symbols are looked + up in the following order: + 1. in the executable, + 2. in the shared libraries specified on the link command line, in order, + 3. in the dependencies of the shared libraries specified on the link + command line, + 4. in the dlopen()ed shared libraries, in the order in which they were + dlopen()ed. + The definition in the C library would override the one in libintl.so if + either + * -lc is given on the link command line and -lintl isn't, or + * -lc is given on the link command line before -lintl, or + * libintl.so is a dependency of a dlopen()ed shared library but not + linked to the executable at link time. + Since Solaris gettext() behaves differently than GNU gettext(), this + would be unacceptable. + + The redirection happens by default through macros in C, so that &gettext + is independent of the compilation unit, but through inline functions in + C++, in order not to interfere with the name mangling of class fields or + class methods called 'gettext'. */ + +/* The user can define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE or _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS. + If he doesn't, we choose the method. A third possible method is + _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM, supported only by GCC. */ +#if !(defined _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE || defined _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS) +# if __GNUC__ >= 2 && !defined __APPLE_CC__ && (defined __STDC__ || defined __cplusplus) +# define _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM +# else +# ifdef __cplusplus +# define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +# else +# define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# endif +# endif +#endif +/* Auxiliary macros. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM +# define _INTL_ASM(cname) __asm__ (_INTL_ASMNAME (__USER_LABEL_PREFIX__, #cname)) +# define _INTL_ASMNAME(prefix,cnamestring) _INTL_STRINGIFY (prefix) cnamestring +# define _INTL_STRINGIFY(prefix) #prefix +#else +# define _INTL_ASM(cname) +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current + LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default + text). */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_gettext (const char *__msgid); +static inline char *gettext (const char *__msgid) +{ + return libintl_gettext (__msgid); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define gettext libintl_gettext +#endif +extern char *gettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__msgid)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_gettext); +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current + LC_MESSAGES locale. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid); +static inline char *dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid) +{ + return libintl_dgettext (__domainname, __msgid); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define dgettext libintl_dgettext +#endif +extern char *dgettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_dgettext); +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY + locale. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid, + int __category); +static inline char *dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid, + int __category) +{ + return libintl_dcgettext (__domainname, __msgid, __category); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define dcgettext libintl_dcgettext +#endif +extern char *dcgettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid, + int __category)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcgettext); +#endif + + +/* Similar to `gettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the + number N. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n); +static inline char *ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n) +{ + return libintl_ngettext (__msgid1, __msgid2, __n); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define ngettext libintl_ngettext +#endif +extern char *ngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__msgid1, + const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_ngettext); +#endif + +/* Similar to `dgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the + number N. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1, + const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n); +static inline char *dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1, + const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n) +{ + return libintl_dngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define dngettext libintl_dngettext +#endif +extern char *dngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, + const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_dngettext); +#endif + +/* Similar to `dcgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the + number N. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_dcngettext (const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n, int __category); +static inline char *dcngettext (const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n, int __category) +{ + return libintl_dcngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n, __category); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define dcngettext libintl_dcngettext +#endif +extern char *dcngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__msgid1, + const char *__msgid2, + unsigned long int __n, + int __category)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcngettext); +#endif + + +/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME. + If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default. + If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages". */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_textdomain (const char *__domainname); +static inline char *textdomain (const char *__domainname) +{ + return libintl_textdomain (__domainname); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define textdomain libintl_textdomain +#endif +extern char *textdomain _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_textdomain); +#endif + +/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found + in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname, + const char *__dirname); +static inline char *bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname, + const char *__dirname) +{ + return libintl_bindtextdomain (__domainname, __dirname); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define bindtextdomain libintl_bindtextdomain +#endif +extern char *bindtextdomain _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__dirname)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_bindtextdomain); +#endif + +/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the + DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned. */ +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE +extern char *libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname, + const char *__codeset); +static inline char *bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname, + const char *__codeset) +{ + return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (__domainname, __codeset); +} +#else +#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS +# define bind_textdomain_codeset libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset +#endif +extern char *bind_textdomain_codeset _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, + const char *__codeset)) + _INTL_ASM (libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset); +#endif + + +/* Support for relocatable packages. */ + +/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package. + Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix + by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both + prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" + instead of "/"). */ +#define libintl_set_relocation_prefix libintl_set_relocation_prefix +extern void + libintl_set_relocation_prefix _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *orig_prefix, + const char *curr_prefix)); + + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif /* libintl.h */
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/loadinfo.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,156 @@ +/* Copyright (C) 1996-1999, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + This file is part of the GNU C Library. + Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef _LOADINFO_H +#define _LOADINFO_H 1 + +/* Declarations of locale dependent catalog lookup functions. + Implemented in + + localealias.c Possibly replace a locale name by another. + explodename.c Split a locale name into its various fields. + l10nflist.c Generate a list of filenames of possible message catalogs. + finddomain.c Find and open the relevant message catalogs. + + The main function _nl_find_domain() in finddomain.c is declared + in gettextP.h. + */ + +#ifndef PARAMS +# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES +# define PARAMS(args) args +# else +# define PARAMS(args) () +# endif +#endif + +#ifndef internal_function +# define internal_function +#endif + +/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is + almost always true or almost always false. */ +#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT +# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr) +#endif + +/* Separator in PATH like lists of pathnames. */ +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ + /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ +# define PATH_SEPARATOR ';' +#else + /* Unix */ +# define PATH_SEPARATOR ':' +#endif + +/* Encoding of locale name parts. */ +#define CEN_REVISION 1 +#define CEN_SPONSOR 2 +#define CEN_SPECIAL 4 +#define XPG_NORM_CODESET 8 +#define XPG_CODESET 16 +#define TERRITORY 32 +#define CEN_AUDIENCE 64 +#define XPG_MODIFIER 128 + +#define CEN_SPECIFIC (CEN_REVISION|CEN_SPONSOR|CEN_SPECIAL|CEN_AUDIENCE) +#define XPG_SPECIFIC (XPG_CODESET|XPG_NORM_CODESET|XPG_MODIFIER) + + +struct loaded_l10nfile +{ + const char *filename; + int decided; + + const void *data; + + struct loaded_l10nfile *next; + struct loaded_l10nfile *successor[1]; +}; + + +/* Normalize codeset name. There is no standard for the codeset + names. Normalization allows the user to use any of the common + names. The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be + freed by the caller. */ +extern const char *_nl_normalize_codeset PARAMS ((const char *codeset, + size_t name_len)); + +/* Lookup a locale dependent file. + *L10NFILE_LIST denotes a pool of lookup results of locale dependent + files of the same kind, sorted in decreasing order of ->filename. + DIRLIST and DIRLIST_LEN are an argz list of directories in which to + look, containing at least one directory (i.e. DIRLIST_LEN > 0). + MASK, LANGUAGE, TERRITORY, CODESET, NORMALIZED_CODESET, MODIFIER, + SPECIAL, SPONSOR, REVISION are the pieces of the locale name, as + produced by _nl_explode_name(). FILENAME is the filename suffix. + The return value is the lookup result, either found in *L10NFILE_LIST, + or - if DO_ALLOCATE is nonzero - freshly allocated, or possibly NULL. + If the return value is non-NULL, it is added to *L10NFILE_LIST, and + its ->next field denotes the chaining inside *L10NFILE_LIST, and + furthermore its ->successor[] field contains a list of other lookup + results from which this lookup result inherits. */ +extern struct loaded_l10nfile * +_nl_make_l10nflist PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list, + const char *dirlist, size_t dirlist_len, int mask, + const char *language, const char *territory, + const char *codeset, + const char *normalized_codeset, + const char *modifier, const char *special, + const char *sponsor, const char *revision, + const char *filename, int do_allocate)); + +/* Lookup the real locale name for a locale alias NAME, or NULL if + NAME is not a locale alias (but possibly a real locale name). + The return value is statically allocated and must not be freed. */ +extern const char *_nl_expand_alias PARAMS ((const char *name)); + +/* Split a locale name NAME into its pieces: language, modifier, + territory, codeset, special, sponsor, revision. + NAME gets destructively modified: NUL bytes are inserted here and + there. *LANGUAGE gets assigned NAME. Each of *MODIFIER, *TERRITORY, + *CODESET, *SPECIAL, *SPONSOR, *REVISION gets assigned either a + pointer into the old NAME string, or NULL. *NORMALIZED_CODESET + gets assigned the expanded *CODESET, if it is different from *CODESET; + this one is dynamically allocated and has to be freed by the caller. + The return value is a bitmask, where each bit corresponds to one + filled-in value: + XPG_MODIFIER, CEN_AUDIENCE for *MODIFIER, + TERRITORY for *TERRITORY, + XPG_CODESET for *CODESET, + XPG_NORM_CODESET for *NORMALIZED_CODESET, + CEN_SPECIAL for *SPECIAL, + CEN_SPONSOR for *SPONSOR, + CEN_REVISION for *REVISION. + */ +extern int _nl_explode_name PARAMS ((char *name, const char **language, + const char **modifier, + const char **territory, + const char **codeset, + const char **normalized_codeset, + const char **special, + const char **sponsor, + const char **revision)); + +/* Split a locale name NAME into a leading language part and all the + rest. Return a pointer to the first character after the language, + i.e. to the first byte of the rest. */ +extern char *_nl_find_language PARAMS ((const char *name)); + +#endif /* loadinfo.h */
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/loadmsgcat.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,1322 @@ +/* Load needed message catalogs. + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy(). + This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include + <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ +#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE +# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <ctype.h> +#include <errno.h> +#include <fcntl.h> +#include <sys/types.h> +#include <sys/stat.h> + +#ifdef __GNUC__ +# undef alloca +# define alloca __builtin_alloca +# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1 +#else +# ifdef _MSC_VER +# include <malloc.h> +# define alloca _alloca +# else +# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC +# include <alloca.h> +# else +# ifdef _AIX + #pragma alloca +# else +# ifndef alloca +char *alloca (); +# endif +# endif +# endif +# endif +#endif + +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC +# include <unistd.h> +#endif + +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <langinfo.h> +# include <locale.h> +#endif + +#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \ + || (defined _LIBC && defined _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES) +# include <sys/mman.h> +# undef HAVE_MMAP +# define HAVE_MMAP 1 +#else +# undef HAVE_MMAP +#endif + +#if defined HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX || defined _LIBC +# include <stdint.h> +#endif +#if defined HAVE_INTTYPES_H || defined _LIBC +# include <inttypes.h> +#endif + +#include "gmo.h" +#include "gettextP.h" +#include "hash-string.h" +#include "plural-exp.h" + +#ifdef _LIBC +# include "../locale/localeinfo.h" +#endif + +/* Provide fallback values for macros that ought to be defined in <inttypes.h>. + Note that our fallback values need not be literal strings, because we don't + use them with preprocessor string concatenation. */ +#if !defined PRId8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRId8 +# define PRId8 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIi8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIi8 +# define PRIi8 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIo8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIo8 +# define PRIo8 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIu8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIu8 +# define PRIu8 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIx8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIx8 +# define PRIx8 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIX8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIX8 +# define PRIX8 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRId16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRId16 +# define PRId16 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIi16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIi16 +# define PRIi16 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIo16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIo16 +# define PRIo16 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIu16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIu16 +# define PRIu16 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIx16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIx16 +# define PRIx16 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIX16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIX16 +# define PRIX16 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRId32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRId32 +# define PRId32 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIi32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIi32 +# define PRIi32 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIo32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIo32 +# define PRIo32 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIu32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIu32 +# define PRIu32 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIx32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIx32 +# define PRIx32 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIX32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIX32 +# define PRIX32 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRId64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRId64 +# define PRId64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "ld" : "lld") +#endif +#if !defined PRIi64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIi64 +# define PRIi64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "li" : "lli") +#endif +#if !defined PRIo64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIo64 +# define PRIo64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lo" : "llo") +#endif +#if !defined PRIu64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIu64 +# define PRIu64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lu" : "llu") +#endif +#if !defined PRIx64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIx64 +# define PRIx64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lx" : "llx") +#endif +#if !defined PRIX64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIX64 +# define PRIX64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lX" : "llX") +#endif +#if !defined PRIdLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdLEAST8 +# define PRIdLEAST8 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIiLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiLEAST8 +# define PRIiLEAST8 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIoLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoLEAST8 +# define PRIoLEAST8 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIuLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuLEAST8 +# define PRIuLEAST8 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIxLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxLEAST8 +# define PRIxLEAST8 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIXLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXLEAST8 +# define PRIXLEAST8 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRIdLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdLEAST16 +# define PRIdLEAST16 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIiLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiLEAST16 +# define PRIiLEAST16 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIoLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoLEAST16 +# define PRIoLEAST16 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIuLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuLEAST16 +# define PRIuLEAST16 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIxLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxLEAST16 +# define PRIxLEAST16 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIXLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXLEAST16 +# define PRIXLEAST16 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRIdLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdLEAST32 +# define PRIdLEAST32 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIiLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiLEAST32 +# define PRIiLEAST32 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIoLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoLEAST32 +# define PRIoLEAST32 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIuLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuLEAST32 +# define PRIuLEAST32 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIxLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxLEAST32 +# define PRIxLEAST32 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIXLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXLEAST32 +# define PRIXLEAST32 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRIdLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdLEAST64 +# define PRIdLEAST64 PRId64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIiLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiLEAST64 +# define PRIiLEAST64 PRIi64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIoLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoLEAST64 +# define PRIoLEAST64 PRIo64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIuLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuLEAST64 +# define PRIuLEAST64 PRIu64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIxLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxLEAST64 +# define PRIxLEAST64 PRIx64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIXLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXLEAST64 +# define PRIXLEAST64 PRIX64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIdFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdFAST8 +# define PRIdFAST8 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIiFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiFAST8 +# define PRIiFAST8 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIoFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoFAST8 +# define PRIoFAST8 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIuFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuFAST8 +# define PRIuFAST8 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIxFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxFAST8 +# define PRIxFAST8 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIXFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXFAST8 +# define PRIXFAST8 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRIdFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdFAST16 +# define PRIdFAST16 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIiFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiFAST16 +# define PRIiFAST16 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIoFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoFAST16 +# define PRIoFAST16 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIuFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuFAST16 +# define PRIuFAST16 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIxFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxFAST16 +# define PRIxFAST16 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIXFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXFAST16 +# define PRIXFAST16 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRIdFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdFAST32 +# define PRIdFAST32 "d" +#endif +#if !defined PRIiFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiFAST32 +# define PRIiFAST32 "i" +#endif +#if !defined PRIoFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoFAST32 +# define PRIoFAST32 "o" +#endif +#if !defined PRIuFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuFAST32 +# define PRIuFAST32 "u" +#endif +#if !defined PRIxFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxFAST32 +# define PRIxFAST32 "x" +#endif +#if !defined PRIXFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXFAST32 +# define PRIXFAST32 "X" +#endif +#if !defined PRIdFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdFAST64 +# define PRIdFAST64 PRId64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIiFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiFAST64 +# define PRIiFAST64 PRIi64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIoFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoFAST64 +# define PRIoFAST64 PRIo64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIuFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuFAST64 +# define PRIuFAST64 PRIu64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIxFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxFAST64 +# define PRIxFAST64 PRIx64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIXFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXFAST64 +# define PRIXFAST64 PRIX64 +#endif +#if !defined PRIdMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdMAX +# define PRIdMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : "lld") +#endif +#if !defined PRIiMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiMAX +# define PRIiMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : "lli") +#endif +#if !defined PRIoMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoMAX +# define PRIoMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : "llo") +#endif +#if !defined PRIuMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuMAX +# define PRIuMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : "llu") +#endif +#if !defined PRIxMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxMAX +# define PRIxMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : "llx") +#endif +#if !defined PRIXMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXMAX +# define PRIXMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : "llX") +#endif +#if !defined PRIdPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIdPTR +# define PRIdPTR \ + (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : \ + sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "d" : \ + "lld") +#endif +#if !defined PRIiPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIiPTR +# define PRIiPTR \ + (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : \ + sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "i" : \ + "lli") +#endif +#if !defined PRIoPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIoPTR +# define PRIoPTR \ + (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : \ + sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "o" : \ + "llo") +#endif +#if !defined PRIuPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIuPTR +# define PRIuPTR \ + (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : \ + sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "u" : \ + "llu") +#endif +#if !defined PRIxPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIxPTR +# define PRIxPTR \ + (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : \ + sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "x" : \ + "llx") +#endif +#if !defined PRIXPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN +# undef PRIXPTR +# define PRIXPTR \ + (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : \ + sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "X" : \ + "llX") +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Rename the non ISO C functions. This is required by the standard + because some ISO C functions will require linking with this object + file and the name space must not be polluted. */ +# define open __open +# define close __close +# define read __read +# define mmap __mmap +# define munmap __munmap +#endif + +/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add + some additional code emulating it. */ +#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA +# define freea(p) /* nothing */ +#else +# define alloca(n) malloc (n) +# define freea(p) free (p) +#endif + +/* For systems that distinguish between text and binary I/O. + O_BINARY is usually declared in <fcntl.h>. */ +#if !defined O_BINARY && defined _O_BINARY + /* For MSC-compatible compilers. */ +# define O_BINARY _O_BINARY +# define O_TEXT _O_TEXT +#endif +#ifdef __BEOS__ + /* BeOS 5 has O_BINARY and O_TEXT, but they have no effect. */ +# undef O_BINARY +# undef O_TEXT +#endif +/* On reasonable systems, binary I/O is the default. */ +#ifndef O_BINARY +# define O_BINARY 0 +#endif + + +/* Prototypes for local functions. Needed to ensure compiler checking of + function argument counts despite of K&R C function definition syntax. */ +static const char *get_sysdep_segment_value PARAMS ((const char *name)); + + +/* We need a sign, whether a new catalog was loaded, which can be associated + with all translations. This is important if the translations are + cached by one of GCC's features. */ +int _nl_msg_cat_cntr; + + +/* Expand a system dependent string segment. Return NULL if unsupported. */ +static const char * +get_sysdep_segment_value (name) + const char *name; +{ + /* Test for an ISO C 99 section 7.8.1 format string directive. + Syntax: + P R I { d | i | o | u | x | X } + { { | LEAST | FAST } { 8 | 16 | 32 | 64 } | MAX | PTR } */ + /* We don't use a table of 14 times 6 'const char *' strings here, because + data relocations cost startup time. */ + if (name[0] == 'P' && name[1] == 'R' && name[2] == 'I') + { + if (name[3] == 'd' || name[3] == 'i' || name[3] == 'o' || name[3] == 'u' + || name[3] == 'x' || name[3] == 'X') + { + if (name[4] == '8' && name[5] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRId8; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIi8; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIo8; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIu8; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIx8; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIX8; + abort (); + } + if (name[4] == '1' && name[5] == '6' && name[6] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRId16; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIi16; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIo16; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIu16; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIx16; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIX16; + abort (); + } + if (name[4] == '3' && name[5] == '2' && name[6] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRId32; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIi32; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIo32; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIu32; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIx32; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIX32; + abort (); + } + if (name[4] == '6' && name[5] == '4' && name[6] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRId64; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIi64; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIo64; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIu64; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIx64; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIX64; + abort (); + } + if (name[4] == 'L' && name[5] == 'E' && name[6] == 'A' + && name[7] == 'S' && name[8] == 'T') + { + if (name[9] == '8' && name[10] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdLEAST8; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiLEAST8; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoLEAST8; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuLEAST8; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxLEAST8; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXLEAST8; + abort (); + } + if (name[9] == '1' && name[10] == '6' && name[11] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdLEAST16; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiLEAST16; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoLEAST16; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuLEAST16; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxLEAST16; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXLEAST16; + abort (); + } + if (name[9] == '3' && name[10] == '2' && name[11] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdLEAST32; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiLEAST32; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoLEAST32; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuLEAST32; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxLEAST32; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXLEAST32; + abort (); + } + if (name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '4' && name[11] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdLEAST64; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiLEAST64; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoLEAST64; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuLEAST64; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxLEAST64; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXLEAST64; + abort (); + } + } + if (name[4] == 'F' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'S' + && name[7] == 'T') + { + if (name[8] == '8' && name[9] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdFAST8; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiFAST8; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoFAST8; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuFAST8; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxFAST8; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXFAST8; + abort (); + } + if (name[8] == '1' && name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdFAST16; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiFAST16; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoFAST16; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuFAST16; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxFAST16; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXFAST16; + abort (); + } + if (name[8] == '3' && name[9] == '2' && name[10] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdFAST32; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiFAST32; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoFAST32; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuFAST32; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxFAST32; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXFAST32; + abort (); + } + if (name[8] == '6' && name[9] == '4' && name[10] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdFAST64; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiFAST64; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoFAST64; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuFAST64; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxFAST64; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXFAST64; + abort (); + } + } + if (name[4] == 'M' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'X' + && name[7] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdMAX; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiMAX; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoMAX; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuMAX; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxMAX; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXMAX; + abort (); + } + if (name[4] == 'P' && name[5] == 'T' && name[6] == 'R' + && name[7] == '\0') + { + if (name[3] == 'd') + return PRIdPTR; + if (name[3] == 'i') + return PRIiPTR; + if (name[3] == 'o') + return PRIoPTR; + if (name[3] == 'u') + return PRIuPTR; + if (name[3] == 'x') + return PRIxPTR; + if (name[3] == 'X') + return PRIXPTR; + abort (); + } + } + } + /* Other system dependent strings are not valid. */ + return NULL; +} + +/* Initialize the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog. + Return the header entry. */ +const char * +internal_function +_nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding) + struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file; + struct loaded_domain *domain; + struct binding *domainbinding; +{ + /* Find out about the character set the file is encoded with. + This can be found (in textual form) in the entry "". If this + entry does not exist or if this does not contain the `charset=' + information, we will assume the charset matches the one the + current locale and we don't have to perform any conversion. */ + char *nullentry; + size_t nullentrylen; + + /* Preinitialize fields, to avoid recursion during _nl_find_msg. */ + domain->codeset_cntr = + (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0); +#ifdef _LIBC + domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1; +#else +# if HAVE_ICONV + domain->conv = (iconv_t) -1; +# endif +#endif + domain->conv_tab = NULL; + + /* Get the header entry. */ + nullentry = _nl_find_msg (domain_file, domainbinding, "", &nullentrylen); + + if (nullentry != NULL) + { +#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV + const char *charsetstr; + + charsetstr = strstr (nullentry, "charset="); + if (charsetstr != NULL) + { + size_t len; + char *charset; + const char *outcharset; + + charsetstr += strlen ("charset="); + len = strcspn (charsetstr, " \t\n"); + + charset = (char *) alloca (len + 1); +# if defined _LIBC || HAVE_MEMPCPY + *((char *) mempcpy (charset, charsetstr, len)) = '\0'; +# else + memcpy (charset, charsetstr, len); + charset[len] = '\0'; +# endif + + /* The output charset should normally be determined by the + locale. But sometimes the locale is not used or not correctly + set up, so we provide a possibility for the user to override + this. Moreover, the value specified through + bind_textdomain_codeset overrides both. */ + if (domainbinding != NULL && domainbinding->codeset != NULL) + outcharset = domainbinding->codeset; + else + { + outcharset = getenv ("OUTPUT_CHARSET"); + if (outcharset == NULL || outcharset[0] == '\0') + { +# ifdef _LIBC + outcharset = _NL_CURRENT (LC_CTYPE, CODESET); +# else +# if HAVE_ICONV + extern const char *locale_charset PARAMS ((void)); + outcharset = locale_charset (); +# endif +# endif + } + } + +# ifdef _LIBC + /* We always want to use transliteration. */ + outcharset = norm_add_slashes (outcharset, "TRANSLIT"); + charset = norm_add_slashes (charset, NULL); + if (__gconv_open (outcharset, charset, &domain->conv, + GCONV_AVOID_NOCONV) + != __GCONV_OK) + domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1; +# else +# if HAVE_ICONV + /* When using GNU libc >= 2.2 or GNU libiconv >= 1.5, + we want to use transliteration. */ +# if (__GLIBC__ == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ >= 2) || __GLIBC__ > 2 \ + || _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0105 + if (strchr (outcharset, '/') == NULL) + { + char *tmp; + + len = strlen (outcharset); + tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 10 + 1); + memcpy (tmp, outcharset, len); + memcpy (tmp + len, "//TRANSLIT", 10 + 1); + outcharset = tmp; + + domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset); + + freea (outcharset); + } + else +# endif + domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset); +# endif +# endif + + freea (charset); + } +#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */ + } + + return nullentry; +} + +/* Frees the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog. */ +void +internal_function +_nl_free_domain_conv (domain) + struct loaded_domain *domain; +{ + if (domain->conv_tab != NULL && domain->conv_tab != (char **) -1) + free (domain->conv_tab); + +#ifdef _LIBC + if (domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1) + __gconv_close (domain->conv); +#else +# if HAVE_ICONV + if (domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1) + iconv_close (domain->conv); +# endif +#endif +} + +/* Load the message catalogs specified by FILENAME. If it is no valid + message catalog do nothing. */ +void +internal_function +_nl_load_domain (domain_file, domainbinding) + struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file; + struct binding *domainbinding; +{ + int fd; + size_t size; +#ifdef _LIBC + struct stat64 st; +#else + struct stat st; +#endif + struct mo_file_header *data = (struct mo_file_header *) -1; + int use_mmap = 0; + struct loaded_domain *domain; + int revision; + const char *nullentry; + + domain_file->decided = 1; + domain_file->data = NULL; + + /* Note that it would be useless to store domainbinding in domain_file + because domainbinding might be == NULL now but != NULL later (after + a call to bind_textdomain_codeset). */ + + /* If the record does not represent a valid locale the FILENAME + might be NULL. This can happen when according to the given + specification the locale file name is different for XPG and CEN + syntax. */ + if (domain_file->filename == NULL) + return; + + /* Try to open the addressed file. */ + fd = open (domain_file->filename, O_RDONLY | O_BINARY); + if (fd == -1) + return; + + /* We must know about the size of the file. */ + if ( +#ifdef _LIBC + __builtin_expect (fstat64 (fd, &st) != 0, 0) +#else + __builtin_expect (fstat (fd, &st) != 0, 0) +#endif + || __builtin_expect ((size = (size_t) st.st_size) != st.st_size, 0) + || __builtin_expect (size < sizeof (struct mo_file_header), 0)) + { + /* Something went wrong. */ + close (fd); + return; + } + +#ifdef HAVE_MMAP + /* Now we are ready to load the file. If mmap() is available we try + this first. If not available or it failed we try to load it. */ + data = (struct mo_file_header *) mmap (NULL, size, PROT_READ, + MAP_PRIVATE, fd, 0); + + if (__builtin_expect (data != (struct mo_file_header *) -1, 1)) + { + /* mmap() call was successful. */ + close (fd); + use_mmap = 1; + } +#endif + + /* If the data is not yet available (i.e. mmap'ed) we try to load + it manually. */ + if (data == (struct mo_file_header *) -1) + { + size_t to_read; + char *read_ptr; + + data = (struct mo_file_header *) malloc (size); + if (data == NULL) + return; + + to_read = size; + read_ptr = (char *) data; + do + { + long int nb = (long int) read (fd, read_ptr, to_read); + if (nb <= 0) + { +#ifdef EINTR + if (nb == -1 && errno == EINTR) + continue; +#endif + close (fd); + return; + } + read_ptr += nb; + to_read -= nb; + } + while (to_read > 0); + + close (fd); + } + + /* Using the magic number we can test whether it really is a message + catalog file. */ + if (__builtin_expect (data->magic != _MAGIC && data->magic != _MAGIC_SWAPPED, + 0)) + { + /* The magic number is wrong: not a message catalog file. */ +#ifdef HAVE_MMAP + if (use_mmap) + munmap ((caddr_t) data, size); + else +#endif + free (data); + return; + } + + domain = (struct loaded_domain *) malloc (sizeof (struct loaded_domain)); + if (domain == NULL) + return; + domain_file->data = domain; + + domain->data = (char *) data; + domain->use_mmap = use_mmap; + domain->mmap_size = size; + domain->must_swap = data->magic != _MAGIC; + domain->malloced = NULL; + + /* Fill in the information about the available tables. */ + revision = W (domain->must_swap, data->revision); + /* We support only the major revision 0. */ + switch (revision >> 16) + { + case 0: + domain->nstrings = W (domain->must_swap, data->nstrings); + domain->orig_tab = (const struct string_desc *) + ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_tab_offset)); + domain->trans_tab = (const struct string_desc *) + ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_tab_offset)); + domain->hash_size = W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_size); + domain->hash_tab = + (domain->hash_size > 2 + ? (const nls_uint32 *) + ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_offset)) + : NULL); + domain->must_swap_hash_tab = domain->must_swap; + + /* Now dispatch on the minor revision. */ + switch (revision & 0xffff) + { + case 0: + domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0; + domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL; + domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL; + break; + case 1: + default: + { + nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings; + + if (domain->hash_tab == NULL) + /* This is invalid. These minor revisions need a hash table. */ + goto invalid; + + n_sysdep_strings = + W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_strings); + if (n_sysdep_strings > 0) + { + nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments; + const struct sysdep_segment *sysdep_segments; + const char **sysdep_segment_values; + const nls_uint32 *orig_sysdep_tab; + const nls_uint32 *trans_sysdep_tab; + size_t memneed; + char *mem; + struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_orig_sysdep_tab; + struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_trans_sysdep_tab; + nls_uint32 *inmem_hash_tab; + unsigned int i; + + /* Get the values of the system dependent segments. */ + n_sysdep_segments = + W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_segments); + sysdep_segments = (const struct sysdep_segment *) + ((char *) data + + W (domain->must_swap, data->sysdep_segments_offset)); + sysdep_segment_values = + alloca (n_sysdep_segments * sizeof (const char *)); + for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_segments; i++) + { + const char *name = + (char *) data + + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].offset); + nls_uint32 namelen = + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].length); + + if (!(namelen > 0 && name[namelen - 1] == '\0')) + { + freea (sysdep_segment_values); + goto invalid; + } + + sysdep_segment_values[i] = get_sysdep_segment_value (name); + } + + orig_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *) + ((char *) data + + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_sysdep_tab_offset)); + trans_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *) + ((char *) data + + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_sysdep_tab_offset)); + + /* Compute the amount of additional memory needed for the + system dependent strings and the augmented hash table. */ + memneed = 2 * n_sysdep_strings + * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc) + + domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32); + for (i = 0; i < 2 * n_sysdep_strings; i++) + { + const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string = + (const struct sysdep_string *) + ((char *) data + + W (domain->must_swap, + i < n_sysdep_strings + ? orig_sysdep_tab[i] + : trans_sysdep_tab[i - n_sysdep_strings])); + size_t need = 0; + const struct segment_pair *p = sysdep_string->segments; + + if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref) != SEGMENTS_END) + for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++) + { + nls_uint32 sysdepref; + + need += W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize); + + sysdepref = W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref); + if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END) + break; + + if (sysdepref >= n_sysdep_segments) + { + /* Invalid. */ + freea (sysdep_segment_values); + goto invalid; + } + + need += strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]); + } + + memneed += need; + } + + /* Allocate additional memory. */ + mem = (char *) malloc (memneed); + if (mem == NULL) + goto invalid; + + domain->malloced = mem; + inmem_orig_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem; + mem += n_sysdep_strings * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc); + inmem_trans_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem; + mem += n_sysdep_strings * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc); + inmem_hash_tab = (nls_uint32 *) mem; + mem += domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32); + + /* Compute the system dependent strings. */ + for (i = 0; i < 2 * n_sysdep_strings; i++) + { + const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string = + (const struct sysdep_string *) + ((char *) data + + W (domain->must_swap, + i < n_sysdep_strings + ? orig_sysdep_tab[i] + : trans_sysdep_tab[i - n_sysdep_strings])); + const char *static_segments = + (char *) data + + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_string->offset); + const struct segment_pair *p = sysdep_string->segments; + + /* Concatenate the segments, and fill + inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i] (for i < n_sysdep_strings) and + inmem_trans_sysdep_tab[i-n_sysdep_strings] (for + i >= n_sysdep_strings). */ + + if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref) == SEGMENTS_END) + { + /* Only one static segment. */ + inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].length = + W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize); + inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer = static_segments; + } + else + { + inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer = mem; + + for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++) + { + nls_uint32 segsize = + W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize); + nls_uint32 sysdepref = + W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref); + size_t n; + + if (segsize > 0) + { + memcpy (mem, static_segments, segsize); + mem += segsize; + static_segments += segsize; + } + + if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END) + break; + + n = strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]); + memcpy (mem, sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref], n); + mem += n; + } + + inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].length = + mem - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer; + } + } + + /* Compute the augmented hash table. */ + for (i = 0; i < domain->hash_size; i++) + inmem_hash_tab[i] = + W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[i]); + for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_strings; i++) + { + const char *msgid = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer; + nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid); + nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size; + nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2)); + + for (;;) + { + if (inmem_hash_tab[idx] == 0) + { + /* Hash table entry is empty. Use it. */ + inmem_hash_tab[idx] = 1 + domain->nstrings + i; + break; + } + + if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr) + idx -= domain->hash_size - incr; + else + idx += incr; + } + } + + freea (sysdep_segment_values); + + domain->n_sysdep_strings = n_sysdep_strings; + domain->orig_sysdep_tab = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab; + domain->trans_sysdep_tab = inmem_trans_sysdep_tab; + + domain->hash_tab = inmem_hash_tab; + domain->must_swap_hash_tab = 0; + } + else + { + domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0; + domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL; + domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL; + } + } + break; + } + break; + default: + /* This is an invalid revision. */ + invalid: + /* This is an invalid .mo file. */ + if (domain->malloced) + free (domain->malloced); +#ifdef HAVE_MMAP + if (use_mmap) + munmap ((caddr_t) data, size); + else +#endif + free (data); + free (domain); + domain_file->data = NULL; + return; + } + + /* Now initialize the character set converter from the character set + the file is encoded with (found in the header entry) to the domain's + specified character set or the locale's character set. */ + nullentry = _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding); + + /* Also look for a plural specification. */ + EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (nullentry, &domain->plural, &domain->nplurals); +} + + +#ifdef _LIBC +void +internal_function +_nl_unload_domain (domain) + struct loaded_domain *domain; +{ + if (domain->plural != &__gettext_germanic_plural) + __gettext_free_exp (domain->plural); + + _nl_free_domain_conv (domain); + + if (domain->malloced) + free (domain->malloced); + +# ifdef _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES + if (domain->use_mmap) + munmap ((caddr_t) domain->data, domain->mmap_size); + else +# endif /* _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES */ + free ((void *) domain->data); + + free (domain); +} +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/localcharset.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,398 @@ +/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding. + + Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +/* Specification. */ +#include "localcharset.h" + +#if HAVE_STDDEF_H +# include <stddef.h> +#endif + +#include <stdio.h> +#if HAVE_STRING_H +# include <string.h> +#else +# include <strings.h> +#endif +#if HAVE_STDLIB_H +# include <stdlib.h> +#endif + +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ +# undef WIN32 /* avoid warning on mingw32 */ +# define WIN32 +#endif + +#if defined __EMX__ +/* Assume EMX program runs on OS/2, even if compiled under DOS. */ +# define OS2 +#endif + +#if !defined WIN32 +# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET +# include <langinfo.h> +# else +# if HAVE_SETLOCALE +# include <locale.h> +# endif +# endif +#elif defined WIN32 +# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN +# include <windows.h> +#endif +#if defined OS2 +# define INCL_DOS +# include <os2.h> +#endif + +#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE +# include "relocatable.h" +#else +# define relocate(pathname) (pathname) +#endif + +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ + /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') +#endif + +#ifndef DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR +# define DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR '/' +#endif + +#ifndef ISSLASH +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR) +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_GETC_UNLOCKED +# undef getc +# define getc getc_unlocked +#endif + +/* The following static variable is declared 'volatile' to avoid a + possible multithread problem in the function get_charset_aliases. If we + are running in a threaded environment, and if two threads initialize + 'charset_aliases' simultaneously, both will produce the same value, + and everything will be ok if the two assignments to 'charset_aliases' + are atomic. But I don't know what will happen if the two assignments mix. */ +#if __STDC__ != 1 +# define volatile /* empty */ +#endif +/* Pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file, if it has already been + read, else NULL. Its format is: + ALIAS_1 '\0' CANONICAL_1 '\0' ... ALIAS_n '\0' CANONICAL_n '\0' '\0' */ +static const char * volatile charset_aliases; + +/* Return a pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file. */ +static const char * +get_charset_aliases () +{ + const char *cp; + + cp = charset_aliases; + if (cp == NULL) + { +#if !(defined VMS || defined WIN32) + FILE *fp; + const char *dir = relocate (LIBDIR); + const char *base = "charset.alias"; + char *file_name; + + /* Concatenate dir and base into freshly allocated file_name. */ + { + size_t dir_len = strlen (dir); + size_t base_len = strlen (base); + int add_slash = (dir_len > 0 && !ISSLASH (dir[dir_len - 1])); + file_name = (char *) malloc (dir_len + add_slash + base_len + 1); + if (file_name != NULL) + { + memcpy (file_name, dir, dir_len); + if (add_slash) + file_name[dir_len] = DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR; + memcpy (file_name + dir_len + add_slash, base, base_len + 1); + } + } + + if (file_name == NULL || (fp = fopen (file_name, "r")) == NULL) + /* Out of memory or file not found, treat it as empty. */ + cp = ""; + else + { + /* Parse the file's contents. */ + int c; + char buf1[50+1]; + char buf2[50+1]; + char *res_ptr = NULL; + size_t res_size = 0; + size_t l1, l2; + + for (;;) + { + c = getc (fp); + if (c == EOF) + break; + if (c == '\n' || c == ' ' || c == '\t') + continue; + if (c == '#') + { + /* Skip comment, to end of line. */ + do + c = getc (fp); + while (!(c == EOF || c == '\n')); + if (c == EOF) + break; + continue; + } + ungetc (c, fp); + if (fscanf (fp, "%50s %50s", buf1, buf2) < 2) + break; + l1 = strlen (buf1); + l2 = strlen (buf2); + if (res_size == 0) + { + res_size = l1 + 1 + l2 + 1; + res_ptr = (char *) malloc (res_size + 1); + } + else + { + res_size += l1 + 1 + l2 + 1; + res_ptr = (char *) realloc (res_ptr, res_size + 1); + } + if (res_ptr == NULL) + { + /* Out of memory. */ + res_size = 0; + break; + } + strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1) - (l1 + 1), buf1); + strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1), buf2); + } + fclose (fp); + if (res_size == 0) + cp = ""; + else + { + *(res_ptr + res_size) = '\0'; + cp = res_ptr; + } + } + + if (file_name != NULL) + free (file_name); + +#else + +# if defined VMS + /* To avoid the troubles of an extra file charset.alias_vms in the + sources of many GNU packages, simply inline the aliases here. */ + /* The list of encodings is taken from the OpenVMS 7.3-1 documentation + "Compaq C Run-Time Library Reference Manual for OpenVMS systems" + section 10.7 "Handling Different Character Sets". */ + cp = "ISO8859-1" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0" + "ISO8859-2" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0" + "ISO8859-5" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0" + "ISO8859-7" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0" + "ISO8859-8" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0" + "ISO8859-9" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0" + /* Japanese */ + "eucJP" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0" + "SJIS" "\0" "SHIFT_JIS" "\0" + "DECKANJI" "\0" "DEC-KANJI" "\0" + "SDECKANJI" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0" + /* Chinese */ + "eucTW" "\0" "EUC-TW" "\0" + "DECHANYU" "\0" "DEC-HANYU" "\0" + "DECHANZI" "\0" "GB2312" "\0" + /* Korean */ + "DECKOREAN" "\0" "EUC-KR" "\0"; +# endif + +# if defined WIN32 + /* To avoid the troubles of installing a separate file in the same + directory as the DLL and of retrieving the DLL's directory at + runtime, simply inline the aliases here. */ + + cp = "CP936" "\0" "GBK" "\0" + "CP1361" "\0" "JOHAB" "\0" + "CP20127" "\0" "ASCII" "\0" + "CP20866" "\0" "KOI8-R" "\0" + "CP21866" "\0" "KOI8-RU" "\0" + "CP28591" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0" + "CP28592" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0" + "CP28593" "\0" "ISO-8859-3" "\0" + "CP28594" "\0" "ISO-8859-4" "\0" + "CP28595" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0" + "CP28596" "\0" "ISO-8859-6" "\0" + "CP28597" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0" + "CP28598" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0" + "CP28599" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0" + "CP28605" "\0" "ISO-8859-15" "\0"; +# endif +#endif + + charset_aliases = cp; + } + + return cp; +} + +/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it + into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset. + The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated. + If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical + name. */ + +#ifdef STATIC +STATIC +#endif +const char * +locale_charset () +{ + const char *codeset; + const char *aliases; + +#if !(defined WIN32 || defined OS2) + +# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET + + /* Most systems support nl_langinfo (CODESET) nowadays. */ + codeset = nl_langinfo (CODESET); + +# else + + /* On old systems which lack it, use setlocale or getenv. */ + const char *locale = NULL; + + /* But most old systems don't have a complete set of locales. Some + (like SunOS 4 or DJGPP) have only the C locale. Therefore we don't + use setlocale here; it would return "C" when it doesn't support the + locale name the user has set. */ +# if HAVE_SETLOCALE && 0 + locale = setlocale (LC_CTYPE, NULL); +# endif + if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') + { + locale = getenv ("LC_ALL"); + if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') + { + locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE"); + if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') + locale = getenv ("LANG"); + } + } + + /* On some old systems, one used to set locale = "iso8859_1". On others, + you set it to "language_COUNTRY.charset". In any case, we resolve it + through the charset.alias file. */ + codeset = locale; + +# endif + +#elif defined WIN32 + + static char buf[2 + 10 + 1]; + + /* Woe32 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number. */ + sprintf (buf, "CP%u", GetACP ()); + codeset = buf; + +#elif defined OS2 + + const char *locale; + static char buf[2 + 10 + 1]; + ULONG cp[3]; + ULONG cplen; + + /* Allow user to override the codeset, as set in the operating system, + with standard language environment variables. */ + locale = getenv ("LC_ALL"); + if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') + { + locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE"); + if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') + locale = getenv ("LANG"); + } + if (locale != NULL && locale[0] != '\0') + { + /* If the locale name contains an encoding after the dot, return it. */ + const char *dot = strchr (locale, '.'); + + if (dot != NULL) + { + const char *modifier; + + dot++; + /* Look for the possible @... trailer and remove it, if any. */ + modifier = strchr (dot, '@'); + if (modifier == NULL) + return dot; + if (modifier - dot < sizeof (buf)) + { + memcpy (buf, dot, modifier - dot); + buf [modifier - dot] = '\0'; + return buf; + } + } + + /* Resolve through the charset.alias file. */ + codeset = locale; + } + else + { + /* OS/2 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number. */ + if (DosQueryCp (sizeof (cp), cp, &cplen)) + codeset = ""; + else + { + sprintf (buf, "CP%u", cp[0]); + codeset = buf; + } + } + +#endif + + if (codeset == NULL) + /* The canonical name cannot be determined. */ + codeset = ""; + + /* Resolve alias. */ + for (aliases = get_charset_aliases (); + *aliases != '\0'; + aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1, aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1) + if (strcmp (codeset, aliases) == 0 + || (aliases[0] == '*' && aliases[1] == '\0')) + { + codeset = aliases + strlen (aliases) + 1; + break; + } + + /* Don't return an empty string. GNU libc and GNU libiconv interpret + the empty string as denoting "the locale's character encoding", + thus GNU libiconv would call this function a second time. */ + if (codeset[0] == '\0') + codeset = "ASCII"; + + return codeset; +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/localcharset.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ +/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding. + Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + This file is part of the GNU CHARSET Library. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef _LOCALCHARSET_H +#define _LOCALCHARSET_H + + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + + +/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it + into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset. + The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated. + If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical + name. */ +extern const char * locale_charset (void); + + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + + +#endif /* _LOCALCHARSET_H */
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/locale.alias Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,78 @@ +# Locale name alias data base. +# Copyright (C) 1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +# +# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it +# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published +# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) +# any later version. +# +# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, +# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of +# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU +# Library General Public License for more details. +# +# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public +# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software +# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, +# USA. + +# The format of this file is the same as for the corresponding file of +# the X Window System, which normally can be found in +# /usr/lib/X11/locale/locale.alias +# A single line contains two fields: an alias and a substitution value. +# All entries are case independent. + +# Note: This file is far from being complete. If you have a value for +# your own site which you think might be useful for others too, share +# it with the rest of us. Send it using the `glibcbug' script to +# bugs@gnu.org. + +# Packages using this file: + +bokmal no_NO.ISO-8859-1 +bokmål no_NO.ISO-8859-1 +catalan ca_ES.ISO-8859-1 +croatian hr_HR.ISO-8859-2 +czech cs_CZ.ISO-8859-2 +danish da_DK.ISO-8859-1 +dansk da_DK.ISO-8859-1 +deutsch de_DE.ISO-8859-1 +dutch nl_NL.ISO-8859-1 +eesti et_EE.ISO-8859-1 +estonian et_EE.ISO-8859-1 +finnish fi_FI.ISO-8859-1 +français fr_FR.ISO-8859-1 +french fr_FR.ISO-8859-1 +galego gl_ES.ISO-8859-1 +galician gl_ES.ISO-8859-1 +german de_DE.ISO-8859-1 +greek el_GR.ISO-8859-7 +hebrew he_IL.ISO-8859-8 +hrvatski hr_HR.ISO-8859-2 +hungarian hu_HU.ISO-8859-2 +icelandic is_IS.ISO-8859-1 +italian it_IT.ISO-8859-1 +japanese ja_JP.eucJP +japanese.euc ja_JP.eucJP +ja_JP ja_JP.eucJP +ja_JP.ujis ja_JP.eucJP +japanese.sjis ja_JP.SJIS +korean ko_KR.eucKR +korean.euc ko_KR.eucKR +ko_KR ko_KR.eucKR +lithuanian lt_LT.ISO-8859-13 +nb_NO no_NO.ISO-8859-1 +nb_NO.ISO-8859-1 no_NO.ISO-8859-1 +norwegian no_NO.ISO-8859-1 +nynorsk nn_NO.ISO-8859-1 +polish pl_PL.ISO-8859-2 +portuguese pt_PT.ISO-8859-1 +romanian ro_RO.ISO-8859-2 +russian ru_RU.ISO-8859-5 +slovak sk_SK.ISO-8859-2 +slovene sl_SI.ISO-8859-2 +slovenian sl_SI.ISO-8859-2 +spanish es_ES.ISO-8859-1 +swedish sv_SE.ISO-8859-1 +thai th_TH.TIS-620 +turkish tr_TR.ISO-8859-9
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/localealias.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,419 @@ +/* Handle aliases for locale names. + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy(). + This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include + <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ +#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE +# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <ctype.h> +#include <stdio.h> +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE___FSETLOCKING +# include <stdio_ext.h> +#endif +#include <sys/types.h> + +#ifdef __GNUC__ +# undef alloca +# define alloca __builtin_alloca +# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1 +#else +# ifdef _MSC_VER +# include <malloc.h> +# define alloca _alloca +# else +# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC +# include <alloca.h> +# else +# ifdef _AIX + #pragma alloca +# else +# ifndef alloca +char *alloca (); +# endif +# endif +# endif +# endif +#endif + +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#include "gettextP.h" + +#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE +# include "relocatable.h" +#else +# define relocate(pathname) (pathname) +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard + because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object + file and the name space must not be polluted. */ +# define strcasecmp __strcasecmp + +# ifndef mempcpy +# define mempcpy __mempcpy +# endif +# define HAVE_MEMPCPY 1 +# define HAVE___FSETLOCKING 1 + +/* We need locking here since we can be called from different places. */ +# include <bits/libc-lock.h> + +__libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock); +#endif + +#ifndef internal_function +# define internal_function +#endif + +/* Some optimizations for glibc. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define FEOF(fp) feof_unlocked (fp) +# define FGETS(buf, n, fp) fgets_unlocked (buf, n, fp) +#else +# define FEOF(fp) feof (fp) +# define FGETS(buf, n, fp) fgets (buf, n, fp) +#endif + +/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add + some additional code emulating it. */ +#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA +# define freea(p) /* nothing */ +#else +# define alloca(n) malloc (n) +# define freea(p) free (p) +#endif + +#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || defined HAVE_FGETS_UNLOCKED +# undef fgets +# define fgets(buf, len, s) fgets_unlocked (buf, len, s) +#endif +#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || defined HAVE_FEOF_UNLOCKED +# undef feof +# define feof(s) feof_unlocked (s) +#endif + + +struct alias_map +{ + const char *alias; + const char *value; +}; + + +#ifndef _LIBC +# define libc_freeres_ptr(decl) decl +#endif + +libc_freeres_ptr (static char *string_space); +static size_t string_space_act; +static size_t string_space_max; +libc_freeres_ptr (static struct alias_map *map); +static size_t nmap; +static size_t maxmap; + + +/* Prototypes for local functions. */ +static size_t read_alias_file PARAMS ((const char *fname, int fname_len)) + internal_function; +static int extend_alias_table PARAMS ((void)); +static int alias_compare PARAMS ((const struct alias_map *map1, + const struct alias_map *map2)); + + +const char * +_nl_expand_alias (name) + const char *name; +{ + static const char *locale_alias_path; + struct alias_map *retval; + const char *result = NULL; + size_t added; + +#ifdef _LIBC + __libc_lock_lock (lock); +#endif + + if (locale_alias_path == NULL) + locale_alias_path = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH; + + do + { + struct alias_map item; + + item.alias = name; + + if (nmap > 0) + retval = (struct alias_map *) bsearch (&item, map, nmap, + sizeof (struct alias_map), + (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *, + const void *)) + ) alias_compare); + else + retval = NULL; + + /* We really found an alias. Return the value. */ + if (retval != NULL) + { + result = retval->value; + break; + } + + /* Perhaps we can find another alias file. */ + added = 0; + while (added == 0 && locale_alias_path[0] != '\0') + { + const char *start; + + while (locale_alias_path[0] == PATH_SEPARATOR) + ++locale_alias_path; + start = locale_alias_path; + + while (locale_alias_path[0] != '\0' + && locale_alias_path[0] != PATH_SEPARATOR) + ++locale_alias_path; + + if (start < locale_alias_path) + added = read_alias_file (start, locale_alias_path - start); + } + } + while (added != 0); + +#ifdef _LIBC + __libc_lock_unlock (lock); +#endif + + return result; +} + + +static size_t +internal_function +read_alias_file (fname, fname_len) + const char *fname; + int fname_len; +{ + FILE *fp; + char *full_fname; + size_t added; + static const char aliasfile[] = "/locale.alias"; + + full_fname = (char *) alloca (fname_len + sizeof aliasfile); +#ifdef HAVE_MEMPCPY + mempcpy (mempcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len), + aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile); +#else + memcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len); + memcpy (&full_fname[fname_len], aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile); +#endif + + fp = fopen (relocate (full_fname), "r"); + freea (full_fname); + if (fp == NULL) + return 0; + +#ifdef HAVE___FSETLOCKING + /* No threads present. */ + __fsetlocking (fp, FSETLOCKING_BYCALLER); +#endif + + added = 0; + while (!FEOF (fp)) + { + /* It is a reasonable approach to use a fix buffer here because + a) we are only interested in the first two fields + b) these fields must be usable as file names and so must not + be that long + We avoid a multi-kilobyte buffer here since this would use up + stack space which we might not have if the program ran out of + memory. */ + char buf[400]; + char *alias; + char *value; + char *cp; + + if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL) + /* EOF reached. */ + break; + + cp = buf; + /* Ignore leading white space. */ + while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) + ++cp; + + /* A leading '#' signals a comment line. */ + if (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '#') + { + alias = cp++; + while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) + ++cp; + /* Terminate alias name. */ + if (cp[0] != '\0') + *cp++ = '\0'; + + /* Now look for the beginning of the value. */ + while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) + ++cp; + + if (cp[0] != '\0') + { + size_t alias_len; + size_t value_len; + + value = cp++; + while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) + ++cp; + /* Terminate value. */ + if (cp[0] == '\n') + { + /* This has to be done to make the following test + for the end of line possible. We are looking for + the terminating '\n' which do not overwrite here. */ + *cp++ = '\0'; + *cp = '\n'; + } + else if (cp[0] != '\0') + *cp++ = '\0'; + + if (nmap >= maxmap) + if (__builtin_expect (extend_alias_table (), 0)) + return added; + + alias_len = strlen (alias) + 1; + value_len = strlen (value) + 1; + + if (string_space_act + alias_len + value_len > string_space_max) + { + /* Increase size of memory pool. */ + size_t new_size = (string_space_max + + (alias_len + value_len > 1024 + ? alias_len + value_len : 1024)); + char *new_pool = (char *) realloc (string_space, new_size); + if (new_pool == NULL) + return added; + + if (__builtin_expect (string_space != new_pool, 0)) + { + size_t i; + + for (i = 0; i < nmap; i++) + { + map[i].alias += new_pool - string_space; + map[i].value += new_pool - string_space; + } + } + + string_space = new_pool; + string_space_max = new_size; + } + + map[nmap].alias = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act], + alias, alias_len); + string_space_act += alias_len; + + map[nmap].value = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act], + value, value_len); + string_space_act += value_len; + + ++nmap; + ++added; + } + } + + /* Possibly not the whole line fits into the buffer. Ignore + the rest of the line. */ + while (strchr (buf, '\n') == NULL) + if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL) + /* Make sure the inner loop will be left. The outer loop + will exit at the `feof' test. */ + break; + } + + /* Should we test for ferror()? I think we have to silently ignore + errors. --drepper */ + fclose (fp); + + if (added > 0) + qsort (map, nmap, sizeof (struct alias_map), + (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *, const void *))) alias_compare); + + return added; +} + + +static int +extend_alias_table () +{ + size_t new_size; + struct alias_map *new_map; + + new_size = maxmap == 0 ? 100 : 2 * maxmap; + new_map = (struct alias_map *) realloc (map, (new_size + * sizeof (struct alias_map))); + if (new_map == NULL) + /* Simply don't extend: we don't have any more core. */ + return -1; + + map = new_map; + maxmap = new_size; + return 0; +} + + +static int +alias_compare (map1, map2) + const struct alias_map *map1; + const struct alias_map *map2; +{ +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRCASECMP + return strcasecmp (map1->alias, map2->alias); +#else + const unsigned char *p1 = (const unsigned char *) map1->alias; + const unsigned char *p2 = (const unsigned char *) map2->alias; + unsigned char c1, c2; + + if (p1 == p2) + return 0; + + do + { + /* I know this seems to be odd but the tolower() function in + some systems libc cannot handle nonalpha characters. */ + c1 = isupper (*p1) ? tolower (*p1) : *p1; + c2 = isupper (*p2) ? tolower (*p2) : *p2; + if (c1 == '\0') + break; + ++p1; + ++p2; + } + while (c1 == c2); + + return c1 - c2; +#endif +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/localename.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,772 @@ +/* Determine the current selected locale. + Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995. */ +/* Win32 code written by Tor Lillqvist <tml@iki.fi>. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <locale.h> + +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ +# undef WIN32 /* avoid warning on mingw32 */ +# define WIN32 +#endif + +#ifdef WIN32 +# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN +# include <windows.h> +/* Mingw headers don't have latest language and sublanguage codes. */ +# ifndef LANG_AFRIKAANS +# define LANG_AFRIKAANS 0x36 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_ALBANIAN +# define LANG_ALBANIAN 0x1c +# endif +# ifndef LANG_ARABIC +# define LANG_ARABIC 0x01 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_ARMENIAN +# define LANG_ARMENIAN 0x2b +# endif +# ifndef LANG_ASSAMESE +# define LANG_ASSAMESE 0x4d +# endif +# ifndef LANG_AZERI +# define LANG_AZERI 0x2c +# endif +# ifndef LANG_BASQUE +# define LANG_BASQUE 0x2d +# endif +# ifndef LANG_BELARUSIAN +# define LANG_BELARUSIAN 0x23 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_BENGALI +# define LANG_BENGALI 0x45 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_CATALAN +# define LANG_CATALAN 0x03 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_DIVEHI +# define LANG_DIVEHI 0x65 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_ESTONIAN +# define LANG_ESTONIAN 0x25 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_FAEROESE +# define LANG_FAEROESE 0x38 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_FARSI +# define LANG_FARSI 0x29 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_GALICIAN +# define LANG_GALICIAN 0x56 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_GEORGIAN +# define LANG_GEORGIAN 0x37 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_GUJARATI +# define LANG_GUJARATI 0x47 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_HEBREW +# define LANG_HEBREW 0x0d +# endif +# ifndef LANG_HINDI +# define LANG_HINDI 0x39 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_INDONESIAN +# define LANG_INDONESIAN 0x21 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_KANNADA +# define LANG_KANNADA 0x4b +# endif +# ifndef LANG_KASHMIRI +# define LANG_KASHMIRI 0x60 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_KAZAK +# define LANG_KAZAK 0x3f +# endif +# ifndef LANG_KONKANI +# define LANG_KONKANI 0x57 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_KYRGYZ +# define LANG_KYRGYZ 0x40 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_LATVIAN +# define LANG_LATVIAN 0x26 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_LITHUANIAN +# define LANG_LITHUANIAN 0x27 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_MACEDONIAN +# define LANG_MACEDONIAN 0x2f +# endif +# ifndef LANG_MALAY +# define LANG_MALAY 0x3e +# endif +# ifndef LANG_MALAYALAM +# define LANG_MALAYALAM 0x4c +# endif +# ifndef LANG_MANIPURI +# define LANG_MANIPURI 0x58 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_MARATHI +# define LANG_MARATHI 0x4e +# endif +# ifndef LANG_MONGOLIAN +# define LANG_MONGOLIAN 0x50 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_NEPALI +# define LANG_NEPALI 0x61 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_ORIYA +# define LANG_ORIYA 0x48 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_PUNJABI +# define LANG_PUNJABI 0x46 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_SANSKRIT +# define LANG_SANSKRIT 0x4f +# endif +# ifndef LANG_SERBIAN +# define LANG_SERBIAN 0x1a +# endif +# ifndef LANG_SINDHI +# define LANG_SINDHI 0x59 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_SLOVAK +# define LANG_SLOVAK 0x1b +# endif +# ifndef LANG_SORBIAN +# define LANG_SORBIAN 0x2e +# endif +# ifndef LANG_SWAHILI +# define LANG_SWAHILI 0x41 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_SYRIAC +# define LANG_SYRIAC 0x5a +# endif +# ifndef LANG_TAMIL +# define LANG_TAMIL 0x49 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_TATAR +# define LANG_TATAR 0x44 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_TELUGU +# define LANG_TELUGU 0x4a +# endif +# ifndef LANG_THAI +# define LANG_THAI 0x1e +# endif +# ifndef LANG_UKRAINIAN +# define LANG_UKRAINIAN 0x22 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_URDU +# define LANG_URDU 0x20 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_UZBEK +# define LANG_UZBEK 0x43 +# endif +# ifndef LANG_VIETNAMESE +# define LANG_VIETNAMESE 0x2a +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA 0x01 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT 0x03 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA 0x04 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA 0x05 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO 0x06 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA 0x07 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN 0x08 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN 0x09 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA 0x0a +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN 0x0b +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON 0x0c +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT 0x0d +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE 0x0e +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN 0x0f +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR +# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR 0x10 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN +# define SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN 0x01 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC +# define SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU +# define SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU 0x05 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA +# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA 0x07 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA +# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA 0x08 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN +# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN 0x09 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE +# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE 0x0a +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD +# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD 0x0b +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE +# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE 0x0c +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES +# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES 0x0d +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG +# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG 0x05 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO +# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO 0x06 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG +# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG 0x04 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN +# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN 0x05 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA +# define SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA +# define SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA 0x01 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM +# define SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA +# define SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN +# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC +# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC 0x03 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA 0x04 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA 0x05 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA 0x06 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC 0x07 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA 0x08 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA 0x09 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU 0x0a +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA 0x0b +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR 0x0c +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE 0x0d +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY 0x0e +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY 0x0f +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA 0x10 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR 0x11 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS 0x12 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA 0x13 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO +# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO 0x14 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND +# define SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN +# define SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN 0x01 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA +# define SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA 0x02 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN +# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN 0x01 +# endif +# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC +# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC 0x02 +# endif +#endif + +/* XPG3 defines the result of 'setlocale (category, NULL)' as: + "Directs 'setlocale()' to query 'category' and return the current + setting of 'local'." + However it does not specify the exact format. Neither do SUSV2 and + ISO C 99. So we can use this feature only on selected systems (e.g. + those using GNU C Library). */ +#if defined _LIBC || (defined __GNU_LIBRARY__ && __GNU_LIBRARY__ >= 2) +# define HAVE_LOCALE_NULL +#endif + +/* Determine the current locale's name, and canonicalize it into XPG syntax + language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier] + The codeset part in the result is not reliable; the locale_charset() + should be used for codeset information instead. + The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated. */ + +const char * +_nl_locale_name (category, categoryname) + int category; + const char *categoryname; +{ + const char *retval; + +#ifndef WIN32 + + /* Use the POSIX methods of looking to 'LC_ALL', 'LC_xxx', and 'LANG'. + On some systems this can be done by the 'setlocale' function itself. */ +# if defined HAVE_SETLOCALE && defined HAVE_LC_MESSAGES && defined HAVE_LOCALE_NULL + retval = setlocale (category, NULL); +# else + /* Setting of LC_ALL overwrites all other. */ + retval = getenv ("LC_ALL"); + if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0') + { + /* Next comes the name of the desired category. */ + retval = getenv (categoryname); + if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0') + { + /* Last possibility is the LANG environment variable. */ + retval = getenv ("LANG"); + if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0') + /* We use C as the default domain. POSIX says this is + implementation defined. */ + retval = "C"; + } + } +# endif + + return retval; + +#else /* WIN32 */ + + /* Return an XPG style locale name language[_territory][@modifier]. + Don't even bother determining the codeset; it's not useful in this + context, because message catalogs are not specific to a single + codeset. */ + + LCID lcid; + LANGID langid; + int primary, sub; + + /* Let the user override the system settings through environment + variables, as on POSIX systems. */ + retval = getenv ("LC_ALL"); + if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0') + return retval; + retval = getenv (categoryname); + if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0') + return retval; + retval = getenv ("LANG"); + if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0') + return retval; + + /* Use native Win32 API locale ID. */ + lcid = GetThreadLocale (); + + /* Strip off the sorting rules, keep only the language part. */ + langid = LANGIDFROMLCID (lcid); + + /* Split into language and territory part. */ + primary = PRIMARYLANGID (langid); + sub = SUBLANGID (langid); + + /* Dispatch on language. + See also http://www.unicode.org/unicode/onlinedat/languages.html . + For details about languages, see http://www.ethnologue.com/ . */ + switch (primary) + { + case LANG_AFRIKAANS: return "af_ZA"; + case LANG_ALBANIAN: return "sq_AL"; + case 0x5e: /* AMHARIC */ return "am_ET"; + case LANG_ARABIC: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA: return "ar_SA"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ: return "ar_IQ"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT: return "ar_EG"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA: return "ar_LY"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA: return "ar_DZ"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO: return "ar_MA"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA: return "ar_TN"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN: return "ar_OM"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN: return "ar_YE"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA: return "ar_SY"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN: return "ar_JO"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON: return "ar_LB"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT: return "ar_KW"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE: return "ar_AE"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN: return "ar_BH"; + case SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR: return "ar_QA"; + } + return "ar"; + case LANG_ARMENIAN: return "hy_AM"; + case LANG_ASSAMESE: return "as_IN"; + case LANG_AZERI: + switch (sub) + { + /* FIXME: Adjust this when Azerbaijani locales appear on Unix. */ + case SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN: return "az_AZ@latin"; + case SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC: return "az_AZ@cyrillic"; + } + return "az"; + case LANG_BASQUE: + return "eu"; /* Ambiguous: could be "eu_ES" or "eu_FR". */ + case LANG_BELARUSIAN: return "be_BY"; + case LANG_BENGALI: return "bn_IN"; + case LANG_BULGARIAN: return "bg_BG"; + case 0x55: /* BURMESE */ return "my_MM"; + case 0x53: /* CAMBODIAN */ return "km_KH"; + case LANG_CATALAN: return "ca_ES"; + case 0x5c: /* CHEROKEE */ return "chr_US"; + case LANG_CHINESE: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_CHINESE_TRADITIONAL: return "zh_TW"; + case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SIMPLIFIED: return "zh_CN"; + case SUBLANG_CHINESE_HONGKONG: return "zh_HK"; + case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SINGAPORE: return "zh_SG"; + case SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU: return "zh_MO"; + } + return "zh"; + case LANG_CROATIAN: /* LANG_CROATIAN == LANG_SERBIAN + * What used to be called Serbo-Croatian + * should really now be two separate + * languages because of political reasons. + * (Says tml, who knows nothing about Serbian + * or Croatian.) + * (I can feel those flames coming already.) + */ + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "hr_HR"; + case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN: return "sr_YU"; + case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC: return "sr_YU@cyrillic"; + } + return "hr"; + case LANG_CZECH: return "cs_CZ"; + case LANG_DANISH: return "da_DK"; + case LANG_DIVEHI: return "div_MV"; + case LANG_DUTCH: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_DUTCH: return "nl_NL"; + case SUBLANG_DUTCH_BELGIAN: /* FLEMISH, VLAAMS */ return "nl_BE"; + } + return "nl"; + case 0x66: /* EDO */ return "bin_NG"; + case LANG_ENGLISH: + switch (sub) + { + /* SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. Heh. I thought + * English was the language spoken in England. + * Oh well. + */ + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US: return "en_US"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_UK: return "en_GB"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_AUS: return "en_AU"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CAN: return "en_CA"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_NZ: return "en_NZ"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_EIRE: return "en_IE"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA: return "en_ZA"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA: return "en_JM"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN: return "en_GD"; /* Grenada? */ + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE: return "en_BZ"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD: return "en_TT"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE: return "en_ZW"; + case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES: return "en_PH"; + } + return "en"; + case LANG_ESTONIAN: return "et_EE"; + case LANG_FAEROESE: return "fo_FO"; + case LANG_FARSI: return "fa_IR"; + case LANG_FINNISH: return "fi_FI"; + case LANG_FRENCH: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_FRENCH: return "fr_FR"; + case SUBLANG_FRENCH_BELGIAN: /* WALLOON */ return "fr_BE"; + case SUBLANG_FRENCH_CANADIAN: return "fr_CA"; + case SUBLANG_FRENCH_SWISS: return "fr_CH"; + case SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG: return "fr_LU"; + case SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO: return "fr_MC"; + } + return "fr"; + case 0x62: /* FRISIAN */ return "fy_NL"; + case 0x67: /* FULFULDE */ return "ful_NG"; + case 0x3c: /* GAELIC */ + switch (sub) + { + case 0x01: /* SCOTTISH */ return "gd_GB"; + case 0x02: /* IRISH */ return "ga_IE"; + } + return "C"; + case LANG_GALICIAN: return "gl_ES"; + case LANG_GEORGIAN: return "ka_GE"; + case LANG_GERMAN: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_GERMAN: return "de_DE"; + case SUBLANG_GERMAN_SWISS: return "de_CH"; + case SUBLANG_GERMAN_AUSTRIAN: return "de_AT"; + case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG: return "de_LU"; + case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN: return "de_LI"; + } + return "de"; + case LANG_GREEK: return "el_GR"; + case 0x74: /* GUARANI */ return "gn_PY"; + case LANG_GUJARATI: return "gu_IN"; + case 0x68: /* HAUSA */ return "ha_NG"; + case 0x75: /* HAWAIIAN */ + /* FIXME: Do they mean Hawaiian ("haw_US", 1000 speakers) + or Hawaii Creole English ("cpe_US", 600000 speakers)? */ + return "cpe_US"; + case LANG_HEBREW: return "he_IL"; + case LANG_HINDI: return "hi_IN"; + case LANG_HUNGARIAN: return "hu_HU"; + case 0x69: /* IBIBIO */ return "nic_NG"; + case LANG_ICELANDIC: return "is_IS"; + case 0x70: /* IGBO */ return "ibo_NG"; + case LANG_INDONESIAN: return "id_ID"; + case 0x5d: /* INUKTITUT */ return "iu_CA"; + case LANG_ITALIAN: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_ITALIAN: return "it_IT"; + case SUBLANG_ITALIAN_SWISS: return "it_CH"; + } + return "it"; + case LANG_JAPANESE: return "ja_JP"; + case LANG_KANNADA: return "kn_IN"; + case 0x71: /* KANURI */ return "kau_NG"; + case LANG_KASHMIRI: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ks_PK"; + case SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA: return "ks_IN"; + } + return "ks"; + case LANG_KAZAK: return "kk_KZ"; + case LANG_KONKANI: + /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */ + return "kok_IN"; + case LANG_KOREAN: return "ko_KR"; + case LANG_KYRGYZ: return "ky_KG"; + case 0x54: /* LAO */ return "lo_LA"; + case 0x76: /* LATIN */ return "la_VA"; + case LANG_LATVIAN: return "lv_LV"; + case LANG_LITHUANIAN: return "lt_LT"; + case LANG_MACEDONIAN: return "mk_MK"; + case LANG_MALAY: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA: return "ms_MY"; + case SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM: return "ms_BN"; + } + return "ms"; + case LANG_MALAYALAM: return "ml_IN"; + case 0x3a: /* MALTESE */ return "mt_MT"; + case LANG_MANIPURI: + /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */ + return "mni_IN"; + case LANG_MARATHI: return "mr_IN"; + case LANG_MONGOLIAN: + return "mn"; /* Ambiguous: could be "mn_CN" or "mn_MN". */ + case LANG_NEPALI: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ne_NP"; + case SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA: return "ne_IN"; + } + return "ne"; + case LANG_NORWEGIAN: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_BOKMAL: return "no_NO"; + case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_NYNORSK: return "nn_NO"; + } + return "no"; + case LANG_ORIYA: return "or_IN"; + case 0x72: /* OROMO */ return "om_ET"; + case 0x79: /* PAPIAMENTU */ return "pap_AN"; + case 0x63: /* PASHTO */ + return "ps"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ps_PK" or "ps_AF". */ + case LANG_POLISH: return "pl_PL"; + case LANG_PORTUGUESE: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE: return "pt_PT"; + /* Hmm. SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. + Same phenomenon as SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. */ + case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN: return "pt_BR"; + } + return "pt"; + case LANG_PUNJABI: return "pa_IN"; + case 0x17: /* RHAETO-ROMANCE */ return "rm_CH"; + case LANG_ROMANIAN: return "ro_RO"; + case LANG_RUSSIAN: + return "ru"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ru_RU" or "ru_UA". */ + case 0x3b: /* SAMI */ return "se_NO"; + case LANG_SANSKRIT: return "sa_IN"; + case LANG_SINDHI: return "sd"; + case 0x5b: /* SINHALESE */ return "si_LK"; + case LANG_SLOVAK: return "sk_SK"; + case LANG_SLOVENIAN: return "sl_SI"; + case 0x77: /* SOMALI */ return "so_SO"; + case LANG_SORBIAN: + /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */ + return "wen_DE"; + case LANG_SPANISH: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_SPANISH: return "es_ES"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MEXICAN: return "es_MX"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MODERN: + return "es_ES@modern"; /* not seen on Unix */ + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA: return "es_GT"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA: return "es_CR"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA: return "es_PA"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC: return "es_DO"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA: return "es_VE"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA: return "es_CO"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU: return "es_PE"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA: return "es_AR"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR: return "es_EC"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE: return "es_CL"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY: return "es_UY"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY: return "es_PY"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA: return "es_BO"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR: return "es_SV"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS: return "es_HN"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA: return "es_NI"; + case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO: return "es_PR"; + } + return "es"; + case 0x30: /* SUTU */ return "bnt_TZ"; + case LANG_SWAHILI: return "sw_KE"; + case LANG_SWEDISH: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "sv_SE"; + case SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND: return "sv_FI"; + } + return "sv"; + case LANG_SYRIAC: return "syr_TR"; /* An extinct language. */ + case 0x64: /* TAGALOG */ return "tl_PH"; + case 0x28: /* TAJIK */ return "tg_TJ"; + case 0x5f: /* TAMAZIGHT */ return "ber_MA"; + case LANG_TAMIL: + return "ta"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ta_IN" or "ta_LK" or "ta_SG". */ + case LANG_TATAR: return "tt_RU"; + case LANG_TELUGU: return "te_IN"; + case LANG_THAI: return "th_TH"; + case 0x51: /* TIBETAN */ return "bo_CN"; + case 0x73: /* TIGRINYA */ return "ti_ET"; + case 0x31: /* TSONGA */ return "ts_ZA"; + case LANG_TURKISH: return "tr_TR"; + case 0x42: /* TURKMEN */ return "tk_TM"; + case LANG_UKRAINIAN: return "uk_UA"; + case LANG_URDU: + switch (sub) + { + case SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN: return "ur_PK"; + case SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA: return "ur_IN"; + } + return "ur"; + case LANG_UZBEK: + switch (sub) + { + /* FIXME: Adjust this when Uzbek locales appear on Unix. */ + case SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN: return "uz_UZ@latin"; + case SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC: return "uz_UZ@cyrillic"; + } + return "uz"; + case 0x33: /* VENDA */ return "ven_ZA"; + case LANG_VIETNAMESE: return "vi_VN"; + case 0x52: /* WELSH */ return "cy_GB"; + case 0x34: /* XHOSA */ return "xh_ZA"; + case 0x78: /* YI */ return "sit_CN"; + case 0x3d: /* YIDDISH */ return "yi_IL"; + case 0x6a: /* YORUBA */ return "yo_NG"; + case 0x35: /* ZULU */ return "zu_ZA"; + default: return "C"; + } + +#endif +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/log.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,104 @@ +/* Log file output. + Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stdio.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +/* Print an ASCII string with quotes and escape sequences where needed. */ +static void +print_escaped (stream, str) + FILE *stream; + const char *str; +{ + putc ('"', stream); + for (; *str != '\0'; str++) + if (*str == '\n') + { + fputs ("\\n\"", stream); + if (str[1] == '\0') + return; + fputs ("\n\"", stream); + } + else + { + if (*str == '"' || *str == '\\') + putc ('\\', stream); + putc (*str, stream); + } + putc ('"', stream); +} + +/* Add to the log file an entry denoting a failed translation. */ +void +_nl_log_untranslated (logfilename, domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural) + const char *logfilename; + const char *domainname; + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + int plural; +{ + static char *last_logfilename = NULL; + static FILE *last_logfile = NULL; + FILE *logfile; + + /* Can we reuse the last opened logfile? */ + if (last_logfilename == NULL || strcmp (logfilename, last_logfilename) != 0) + { + /* Close the last used logfile. */ + if (last_logfilename != NULL) + { + if (last_logfile != NULL) + { + fclose (last_logfile); + last_logfile = NULL; + } + free (last_logfilename); + last_logfilename = NULL; + } + /* Open the logfile. */ + last_logfilename = (char *) malloc (strlen (logfilename) + 1); + if (last_logfilename == NULL) + return; + strcpy (last_logfilename, logfilename); + last_logfile = fopen (logfilename, "a"); + if (last_logfile == NULL) + return; + } + logfile = last_logfile; + + fprintf (logfile, "domain "); + print_escaped (logfile, domainname); + fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid "); + print_escaped (logfile, msgid1); + if (plural) + { + fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid_plural "); + print_escaped (logfile, msgid2); + fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr[0] \"\"\n"); + } + else + fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr \"\"\n"); + putc ('\n', logfile); +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/ngettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,68 @@ +/* Implementation of ngettext(3) function. + Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#ifdef _LIBC +# define __need_NULL +# include <stddef.h> +#else +# include <stdlib.h> /* Just for NULL. */ +#endif + +#include "gettextP.h" +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif + +#include <locale.h> + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define NGETTEXT __ngettext +# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext +#else +# define NGETTEXT libintl_ngettext +# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext +#endif + +/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current + LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default + text). */ +char * +NGETTEXT (msgid1, msgid2, n) + const char *msgid1; + const char *msgid2; + unsigned long int n; +{ + return DCNGETTEXT (NULL, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES); +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ +weak_alias (__ngettext, ngettext); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/os2compat.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,98 @@ +/* OS/2 compatibility functions. + Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#define OS2_AWARE +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +#include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> +#include <sys/param.h> + +/* A version of getenv() that works from DLLs */ +extern unsigned long DosScanEnv (const unsigned char *pszName, unsigned char **ppszValue); + +char * +_nl_getenv (const char *name) +{ + unsigned char *value; + if (DosScanEnv (name, &value)) + return NULL; + else + return value; +} + +/* A fixed size buffer. */ +char libintl_nl_default_dirname[MAXPATHLEN+1]; + +char *_nlos2_libdir = NULL; +char *_nlos2_localealiaspath = NULL; +char *_nlos2_localedir = NULL; + +static __attribute__((constructor)) void +nlos2_initialize () +{ + char *root = getenv ("UNIXROOT"); + char *gnulocaledir = getenv ("GNULOCALEDIR"); + + _nlos2_libdir = gnulocaledir; + if (!_nlos2_libdir) + { + if (root) + { + size_t sl = strlen (root); + _nlos2_libdir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LIBDIR) + 1); + memcpy (_nlos2_libdir, root, sl); + memcpy (_nlos2_libdir + sl, LIBDIR, strlen (LIBDIR) + 1); + } + else + _nlos2_libdir = LIBDIR; + } + + _nlos2_localealiaspath = gnulocaledir; + if (!_nlos2_localealiaspath) + { + if (root) + { + size_t sl = strlen (root); + _nlos2_localealiaspath = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1); + memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath, root, sl); + memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath + sl, LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH, strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1); + } + else + _nlos2_localealiaspath = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH; + } + + _nlos2_localedir = gnulocaledir; + if (!_nlos2_localedir) + { + if (root) + { + size_t sl = strlen (root); + _nlos2_localedir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1); + memcpy (_nlos2_localedir, root, sl); + memcpy (_nlos2_localedir + sl, LOCALEDIR, strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1); + } + else + _nlos2_localedir = LOCALEDIR; + } + + if (strlen (_nlos2_localedir) <= MAXPATHLEN) + strcpy (libintl_nl_default_dirname, _nlos2_localedir); +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/os2compat.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,46 @@ +/* OS/2 compatibility defines. + This file is intended to be included from config.h + Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* When included from os2compat.h we need all the original definitions */ +#ifndef OS2_AWARE + +#undef LIBDIR +#define LIBDIR _nlos2_libdir +extern char *_nlos2_libdir; + +#undef LOCALEDIR +#define LOCALEDIR _nlos2_localedir +extern char *_nlos2_localedir; + +#undef LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH +#define LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH _nlos2_localealiaspath +extern char *_nlos2_localealiaspath; + +#endif + +#undef HAVE_STRCASECMP +#define HAVE_STRCASECMP 1 +#define strcasecmp stricmp +#define strncasecmp strnicmp + +/* We have our own getenv() which works even if library is compiled as DLL */ +#define getenv _nl_getenv + +/* Older versions of gettext used -1 as the value of LC_MESSAGES */ +#define LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT (-1)
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/osdep.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,24 @@ +/* OS dependent parts of libintl. + Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#if defined __EMX__ +# include "os2compat.c" +#else +/* Avoid AIX compiler warning. */ +typedef int dummy; +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/plural-exp.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,156 @@ +/* Expression parsing for plural form selection. + Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <ctype.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#include "plural-exp.h" + +#if (defined __GNUC__ && !defined __APPLE_CC__) \ + || (defined __STDC_VERSION__ && __STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L) + +/* These structs are the constant expression for the germanic plural + form determination. It represents the expression "n != 1". */ +static const struct expression plvar = +{ + .nargs = 0, + .operation = var, +}; +static const struct expression plone = +{ + .nargs = 0, + .operation = num, + .val = + { + .num = 1 + } +}; +struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL = +{ + .nargs = 2, + .operation = not_equal, + .val = + { + .args = + { + [0] = (struct expression *) &plvar, + [1] = (struct expression *) &plone + } + } +}; + +# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL() + +#else + +/* For compilers without support for ISO C 99 struct/union initializers: + Initialization at run-time. */ + +static struct expression plvar; +static struct expression plone; +struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL; + +static void +init_germanic_plural () +{ + if (plone.val.num == 0) + { + plvar.nargs = 0; + plvar.operation = var; + + plone.nargs = 0; + plone.operation = num; + plone.val.num = 1; + + GERMANIC_PLURAL.nargs = 2; + GERMANIC_PLURAL.operation = not_equal; + GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[0] = &plvar; + GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[1] = &plone; + } +} + +# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL() init_germanic_plural () + +#endif + +void +internal_function +EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (nullentry, pluralp, npluralsp) + const char *nullentry; + struct expression **pluralp; + unsigned long int *npluralsp; +{ + if (nullentry != NULL) + { + const char *plural; + const char *nplurals; + + plural = strstr (nullentry, "plural="); + nplurals = strstr (nullentry, "nplurals="); + if (plural == NULL || nplurals == NULL) + goto no_plural; + else + { + char *endp; + unsigned long int n; + struct parse_args args; + + /* First get the number. */ + nplurals += 9; + while (*nplurals != '\0' && isspace ((unsigned char) *nplurals)) + ++nplurals; + if (!(*nplurals >= '0' && *nplurals <= '9')) + goto no_plural; +#if defined HAVE_STRTOUL || defined _LIBC + n = strtoul (nplurals, &endp, 10); +#else + for (endp = nplurals, n = 0; *endp >= '0' && *endp <= '9'; endp++) + n = n * 10 + (*endp - '0'); +#endif + if (nplurals == endp) + goto no_plural; + *npluralsp = n; + + /* Due to the restrictions bison imposes onto the interface of the + scanner function we have to put the input string and the result + passed up from the parser into the same structure which address + is passed down to the parser. */ + plural += 7; + args.cp = plural; + if (PLURAL_PARSE (&args) != 0) + goto no_plural; + *pluralp = args.res; + } + } + else + { + /* By default we are using the Germanic form: singular form only + for `one', the plural form otherwise. Yes, this is also what + English is using since English is a Germanic language. */ + no_plural: + INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL (); + *pluralp = &GERMANIC_PLURAL; + *npluralsp = 2; + } +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/plural-exp.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,126 @@ +/* Expression parsing and evaluation for plural form selection. + Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef _PLURAL_EXP_H +#define _PLURAL_EXP_H + +#ifndef PARAMS +# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES +# define PARAMS(args) args +# else +# define PARAMS(args) () +# endif +#endif + +#ifndef internal_function +# define internal_function +#endif + +#ifndef attribute_hidden +# define attribute_hidden +#endif + + +/* This is the representation of the expressions to determine the + plural form. */ +struct expression +{ + int nargs; /* Number of arguments. */ + enum operator + { + /* Without arguments: */ + var, /* The variable "n". */ + num, /* Decimal number. */ + /* Unary operators: */ + lnot, /* Logical NOT. */ + /* Binary operators: */ + mult, /* Multiplication. */ + divide, /* Division. */ + module, /* Modulo operation. */ + plus, /* Addition. */ + minus, /* Subtraction. */ + less_than, /* Comparison. */ + greater_than, /* Comparison. */ + less_or_equal, /* Comparison. */ + greater_or_equal, /* Comparison. */ + equal, /* Comparison for equality. */ + not_equal, /* Comparison for inequality. */ + land, /* Logical AND. */ + lor, /* Logical OR. */ + /* Ternary operators: */ + qmop /* Question mark operator. */ + } operation; + union + { + unsigned long int num; /* Number value for `num'. */ + struct expression *args[3]; /* Up to three arguments. */ + } val; +}; + +/* This is the data structure to pass information to the parser and get + the result in a thread-safe way. */ +struct parse_args +{ + const char *cp; + struct expression *res; +}; + + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. This source code is used + 1. in the GNU C Library library, + 2. in the GNU libintl library, + 3. in the GNU gettext tools. + The function names in each situation must be different, to allow for + binary incompatible changes in 'struct expression'. Furthermore, + 1. in the GNU C Library library, the names have a __ prefix, + 2.+3. in the GNU libintl library and in the GNU gettext tools, the names + must follow ANSI C and not start with __. + So we have to distinguish the three cases. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define FREE_EXPRESSION __gettext_free_exp +# define PLURAL_PARSE __gettextparse +# define GERMANIC_PLURAL __gettext_germanic_plural +# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION __gettext_extract_plural +#elif defined (IN_LIBINTL) +# define FREE_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_free_exp +# define PLURAL_PARSE libintl_gettextparse +# define GERMANIC_PLURAL libintl_gettext_germanic_plural +# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_extract_plural +#else +# define FREE_EXPRESSION free_plural_expression +# define PLURAL_PARSE parse_plural_expression +# define GERMANIC_PLURAL germanic_plural +# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION extract_plural_expression +#endif + +extern void FREE_EXPRESSION PARAMS ((struct expression *exp)) + internal_function; +extern int PLURAL_PARSE PARAMS ((void *arg)); +extern struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL attribute_hidden; +extern void EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION PARAMS ((const char *nullentry, + struct expression **pluralp, + unsigned long int *npluralsp)) + internal_function; + +#if !defined (_LIBC) && !defined (IN_LIBINTL) +extern unsigned long int plural_eval PARAMS ((struct expression *pexp, + unsigned long int n)); +#endif + +#endif /* _PLURAL_EXP_H */
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/plural.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,1518 @@ +/* A Bison parser, made from plural.y + by GNU bison 1.35. */ + +#define YYBISON 1 /* Identify Bison output. */ + +#define yyparse __gettextparse +#define yylex __gettextlex +#define yyerror __gettexterror +#define yylval __gettextlval +#define yychar __gettextchar +#define yydebug __gettextdebug +#define yynerrs __gettextnerrs +# define EQUOP2 257 +# define CMPOP2 258 +# define ADDOP2 259 +# define MULOP2 260 +# define NUMBER 261 + +#line 1 "plural.y" + +/* Expression parsing for plural form selection. + Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* The bison generated parser uses alloca. AIX 3 forces us to put this + declaration at the beginning of the file. The declaration in bison's + skeleton file comes too late. This must come before <config.h> + because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers. */ +#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__ + #pragma alloca +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stddef.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include "plural-exp.h" + +/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse, + but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE. */ +#ifndef _LIBC +# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE +#endif + +#define YYLEX_PARAM &((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp +#define YYPARSE_PARAM arg + +#line 49 "plural.y" +#ifndef YYSTYPE +typedef union { + unsigned long int num; + enum operator op; + struct expression *exp; +} yystype; +# define YYSTYPE yystype +# define YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL 1 +#endif +#line 55 "plural.y" + +/* Prototypes for local functions. */ +static struct expression *new_exp PARAMS ((int nargs, enum operator op, + struct expression * const *args)); +static inline struct expression *new_exp_0 PARAMS ((enum operator op)); +static inline struct expression *new_exp_1 PARAMS ((enum operator op, + struct expression *right)); +static struct expression *new_exp_2 PARAMS ((enum operator op, + struct expression *left, + struct expression *right)); +static inline struct expression *new_exp_3 PARAMS ((enum operator op, + struct expression *bexp, + struct expression *tbranch, + struct expression *fbranch)); +static int yylex PARAMS ((YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp)); +static void yyerror PARAMS ((const char *str)); + +/* Allocation of expressions. */ + +static struct expression * +new_exp (nargs, op, args) + int nargs; + enum operator op; + struct expression * const *args; +{ + int i; + struct expression *newp; + + /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL. */ + for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) + if (args[i] == NULL) + goto fail; + + /* Allocate a new expression. */ + newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp)); + if (newp != NULL) + { + newp->nargs = nargs; + newp->operation = op; + for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) + newp->val.args[i] = args[i]; + return newp; + } + + fail: + for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) + FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]); + + return NULL; +} + +static inline struct expression * +new_exp_0 (op) + enum operator op; +{ + return new_exp (0, op, NULL); +} + +static inline struct expression * +new_exp_1 (op, right) + enum operator op; + struct expression *right; +{ + struct expression *args[1]; + + args[0] = right; + return new_exp (1, op, args); +} + +static struct expression * +new_exp_2 (op, left, right) + enum operator op; + struct expression *left; + struct expression *right; +{ + struct expression *args[2]; + + args[0] = left; + args[1] = right; + return new_exp (2, op, args); +} + +static inline struct expression * +new_exp_3 (op, bexp, tbranch, fbranch) + enum operator op; + struct expression *bexp; + struct expression *tbranch; + struct expression *fbranch; +{ + struct expression *args[3]; + + args[0] = bexp; + args[1] = tbranch; + args[2] = fbranch; + return new_exp (3, op, args); +} + +#ifndef YYDEBUG +# define YYDEBUG 0 +#endif + + + +#define YYFINAL 27 +#define YYFLAG -32768 +#define YYNTBASE 16 + +/* YYTRANSLATE(YYLEX) -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */ +#define YYTRANSLATE(x) ((unsigned)(x) <= 261 ? yytranslate[x] : 18) + +/* YYTRANSLATE[YYLEX] -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */ +static const char yytranslate[] = +{ + 0, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 10, 2, 2, 2, 2, 5, 2, + 14, 15, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 12, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 3, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 13, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 4, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, + 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 1, 6, 7, 8, + 9, 11 +}; + +#if YYDEBUG +static const short yyprhs[] = +{ + 0, 0, 2, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, 28, 32, + 35, 37, 39 +}; +static const short yyrhs[] = +{ + 17, 0, 17, 3, 17, 12, 17, 0, 17, 4, + 17, 0, 17, 5, 17, 0, 17, 6, 17, 0, + 17, 7, 17, 0, 17, 8, 17, 0, 17, 9, + 17, 0, 10, 17, 0, 13, 0, 11, 0, 14, + 17, 15, 0 +}; + +#endif + +#if YYDEBUG +/* YYRLINE[YYN] -- source line where rule number YYN was defined. */ +static const short yyrline[] = +{ + 0, 174, 182, 186, 190, 194, 198, 202, 206, 210, + 214, 218, 223 +}; +#endif + + +#if (YYDEBUG) || defined YYERROR_VERBOSE + +/* YYTNAME[TOKEN_NUM] -- String name of the token TOKEN_NUM. */ +static const char *const yytname[] = +{ + "$", "error", "$undefined.", "'?'", "'|'", "'&'", "EQUOP2", "CMPOP2", + "ADDOP2", "MULOP2", "'!'", "NUMBER", "':'", "'n'", "'('", "')'", + "start", "exp", 0 +}; +#endif + +/* YYR1[YYN] -- Symbol number of symbol that rule YYN derives. */ +static const short yyr1[] = +{ + 0, 16, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, + 17, 17, 17 +}; + +/* YYR2[YYN] -- Number of symbols composing right hand side of rule YYN. */ +static const short yyr2[] = +{ + 0, 1, 5, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 2, + 1, 1, 3 +}; + +/* YYDEFACT[S] -- default rule to reduce with in state S when YYTABLE + doesn't specify something else to do. Zero means the default is an + error. */ +static const short yydefact[] = +{ + 0, 0, 11, 10, 0, 1, 9, 0, 0, 0, + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 12, 0, 3, 4, 5, + 6, 7, 8, 0, 2, 0, 0, 0 +}; + +static const short yydefgoto[] = +{ + 25, 5 +}; + +static const short yypact[] = +{ + -9, -9,-32768,-32768, -9, 34,-32768, 11, -9, -9, + -9, -9, -9, -9, -9,-32768, 24, 39, 43, 16, + 26, -3,-32768, -9, 34, 21, 53,-32768 +}; + +static const short yypgoto[] = +{ + -32768, -1 +}; + + +#define YYLAST 53 + + +static const short yytable[] = +{ + 6, 1, 2, 7, 3, 4, 14, 16, 17, 18, + 19, 20, 21, 22, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, + 14, 26, 24, 12, 13, 14, 15, 8, 9, 10, + 11, 12, 13, 14, 13, 14, 23, 8, 9, 10, + 11, 12, 13, 14, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 11, + 12, 13, 14, 27 +}; + +static const short yycheck[] = +{ + 1, 10, 11, 4, 13, 14, 9, 8, 9, 10, + 11, 12, 13, 14, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, + 9, 0, 23, 7, 8, 9, 15, 3, 4, 5, + 6, 7, 8, 9, 8, 9, 12, 3, 4, 5, + 6, 7, 8, 9, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 6, + 7, 8, 9, 0 +}; +#define YYPURE 1 + +/* -*-C-*- Note some compilers choke on comments on `#line' lines. */ +#line 3 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple" + +/* Skeleton output parser for bison, + + Copyright (C) 1984, 1989, 1990, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software + Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify + it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by + the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + GNU General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, + Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */ + +/* As a special exception, when this file is copied by Bison into a + Bison output file, you may use that output file without restriction. + This special exception was added by the Free Software Foundation + in version 1.24 of Bison. */ + +/* This is the parser code that is written into each bison parser when + the %semantic_parser declaration is not specified in the grammar. + It was written by Richard Stallman by simplifying the hairy parser + used when %semantic_parser is specified. */ + +/* All symbols defined below should begin with yy or YY, to avoid + infringing on user name space. This should be done even for local + variables, as they might otherwise be expanded by user macros. + There are some unavoidable exceptions within include files to + define necessary library symbols; they are noted "INFRINGES ON + USER NAME SPACE" below. */ + +#if ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) + +/* The parser invokes alloca or malloc; define the necessary symbols. */ + +# if YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA +# define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca +# else +# ifndef YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA +# if defined (alloca) || defined (_ALLOCA_H) +# define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca +# else +# ifdef __GNUC__ +# define YYSTACK_ALLOC __builtin_alloca +# endif +# endif +# endif +# endif + +# ifdef YYSTACK_ALLOC + /* Pacify GCC's `empty if-body' warning. */ +# define YYSTACK_FREE(Ptr) do { /* empty */; } while (0) +# else +# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) +# include <stdlib.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */ +# define YYSIZE_T size_t +# endif +# define YYSTACK_ALLOC malloc +# define YYSTACK_FREE free +# endif +#endif /* ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */ + + +#if (! defined (yyoverflow) \ + && (! defined (__cplusplus) \ + || (YYLTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL && YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL))) + +/* A type that is properly aligned for any stack member. */ +union yyalloc +{ + short yyss; + YYSTYPE yyvs; +# if YYLSP_NEEDED + YYLTYPE yyls; +# endif +}; + +/* The size of the maximum gap between one aligned stack and the next. */ +# define YYSTACK_GAP_MAX (sizeof (union yyalloc) - 1) + +/* The size of an array large to enough to hold all stacks, each with + N elements. */ +# if YYLSP_NEEDED +# define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \ + ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE) + sizeof (YYLTYPE)) \ + + 2 * YYSTACK_GAP_MAX) +# else +# define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \ + ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE)) \ + + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX) +# endif + +/* Copy COUNT objects from FROM to TO. The source and destination do + not overlap. */ +# ifndef YYCOPY +# if 1 < __GNUC__ +# define YYCOPY(To, From, Count) \ + __builtin_memcpy (To, From, (Count) * sizeof (*(From))) +# else +# define YYCOPY(To, From, Count) \ + do \ + { \ + register YYSIZE_T yyi; \ + for (yyi = 0; yyi < (Count); yyi++) \ + (To)[yyi] = (From)[yyi]; \ + } \ + while (0) +# endif +# endif + +/* Relocate STACK from its old location to the new one. The + local variables YYSIZE and YYSTACKSIZE give the old and new number of + elements in the stack, and YYPTR gives the new location of the + stack. Advance YYPTR to a properly aligned location for the next + stack. */ +# define YYSTACK_RELOCATE(Stack) \ + do \ + { \ + YYSIZE_T yynewbytes; \ + YYCOPY (&yyptr->Stack, Stack, yysize); \ + Stack = &yyptr->Stack; \ + yynewbytes = yystacksize * sizeof (*Stack) + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX; \ + yyptr += yynewbytes / sizeof (*yyptr); \ + } \ + while (0) + +#endif + + +#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (__SIZE_TYPE__) +# define YYSIZE_T __SIZE_TYPE__ +#endif +#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (size_t) +# define YYSIZE_T size_t +#endif +#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) +# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) +# include <stddef.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */ +# define YYSIZE_T size_t +# endif +#endif +#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) +# define YYSIZE_T unsigned int +#endif + +#define yyerrok (yyerrstatus = 0) +#define yyclearin (yychar = YYEMPTY) +#define YYEMPTY -2 +#define YYEOF 0 +#define YYACCEPT goto yyacceptlab +#define YYABORT goto yyabortlab +#define YYERROR goto yyerrlab1 +/* Like YYERROR except do call yyerror. This remains here temporarily + to ease the transition to the new meaning of YYERROR, for GCC. + Once GCC version 2 has supplanted version 1, this can go. */ +#define YYFAIL goto yyerrlab +#define YYRECOVERING() (!!yyerrstatus) +#define YYBACKUP(Token, Value) \ +do \ + if (yychar == YYEMPTY && yylen == 1) \ + { \ + yychar = (Token); \ + yylval = (Value); \ + yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar); \ + YYPOPSTACK; \ + goto yybackup; \ + } \ + else \ + { \ + yyerror ("syntax error: cannot back up"); \ + YYERROR; \ + } \ +while (0) + +#define YYTERROR 1 +#define YYERRCODE 256 + + +/* YYLLOC_DEFAULT -- Compute the default location (before the actions + are run). + + When YYLLOC_DEFAULT is run, CURRENT is set the location of the + first token. By default, to implement support for ranges, extend + its range to the last symbol. */ + +#ifndef YYLLOC_DEFAULT +# define YYLLOC_DEFAULT(Current, Rhs, N) \ + Current.last_line = Rhs[N].last_line; \ + Current.last_column = Rhs[N].last_column; +#endif + + +/* YYLEX -- calling `yylex' with the right arguments. */ + +#if YYPURE +# if YYLSP_NEEDED +# ifdef YYLEX_PARAM +# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, &yylloc, YYLEX_PARAM) +# else +# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, &yylloc) +# endif +# else /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */ +# ifdef YYLEX_PARAM +# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, YYLEX_PARAM) +# else +# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval) +# endif +# endif /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */ +#else /* !YYPURE */ +# define YYLEX yylex () +#endif /* !YYPURE */ + + +/* Enable debugging if requested. */ +#if YYDEBUG + +# ifndef YYFPRINTF +# include <stdio.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */ +# define YYFPRINTF fprintf +# endif + +# define YYDPRINTF(Args) \ +do { \ + if (yydebug) \ + YYFPRINTF Args; \ +} while (0) +/* Nonzero means print parse trace. It is left uninitialized so that + multiple parsers can coexist. */ +int yydebug; +#else /* !YYDEBUG */ +# define YYDPRINTF(Args) +#endif /* !YYDEBUG */ + +/* YYINITDEPTH -- initial size of the parser's stacks. */ +#ifndef YYINITDEPTH +# define YYINITDEPTH 200 +#endif + +/* YYMAXDEPTH -- maximum size the stacks can grow to (effective only + if the built-in stack extension method is used). + + Do not make this value too large; the results are undefined if + SIZE_MAX < YYSTACK_BYTES (YYMAXDEPTH) + evaluated with infinite-precision integer arithmetic. */ + +#if YYMAXDEPTH == 0 +# undef YYMAXDEPTH +#endif + +#ifndef YYMAXDEPTH +# define YYMAXDEPTH 10000 +#endif + +#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE + +# ifndef yystrlen +# if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H) +# define yystrlen strlen +# else +/* Return the length of YYSTR. */ +static YYSIZE_T +# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) +yystrlen (const char *yystr) +# else +yystrlen (yystr) + const char *yystr; +# endif +{ + register const char *yys = yystr; + + while (*yys++ != '\0') + continue; + + return yys - yystr - 1; +} +# endif +# endif + +# ifndef yystpcpy +# if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H) && defined (_GNU_SOURCE) +# define yystpcpy stpcpy +# else +/* Copy YYSRC to YYDEST, returning the address of the terminating '\0' in + YYDEST. */ +static char * +# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) +yystpcpy (char *yydest, const char *yysrc) +# else +yystpcpy (yydest, yysrc) + char *yydest; + const char *yysrc; +# endif +{ + register char *yyd = yydest; + register const char *yys = yysrc; + + while ((*yyd++ = *yys++) != '\0') + continue; + + return yyd - 1; +} +# endif +# endif +#endif + +#line 315 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple" + + +/* The user can define YYPARSE_PARAM as the name of an argument to be passed + into yyparse. The argument should have type void *. + It should actually point to an object. + Grammar actions can access the variable by casting it + to the proper pointer type. */ + +#ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM +# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) +# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG void *YYPARSE_PARAM +# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL +# else +# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG YYPARSE_PARAM +# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL void *YYPARSE_PARAM; +# endif +#else /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */ +# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG +# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL +#endif /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */ + +/* Prevent warning if -Wstrict-prototypes. */ +#ifdef __GNUC__ +# ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM +int yyparse (void *); +# else +int yyparse (void); +# endif +#endif + +/* YY_DECL_VARIABLES -- depending whether we use a pure parser, + variables are global, or local to YYPARSE. */ + +#define YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES \ +/* The lookahead symbol. */ \ +int yychar; \ + \ +/* The semantic value of the lookahead symbol. */ \ +YYSTYPE yylval; \ + \ +/* Number of parse errors so far. */ \ +int yynerrs; + +#if YYLSP_NEEDED +# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES \ +YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES \ + \ +/* Location data for the lookahead symbol. */ \ +YYLTYPE yylloc; +#else +# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES \ +YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES +#endif + + +/* If nonreentrant, generate the variables here. */ + +#if !YYPURE +YY_DECL_VARIABLES +#endif /* !YYPURE */ + +int +yyparse (YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG) + YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL +{ + /* If reentrant, generate the variables here. */ +#if YYPURE + YY_DECL_VARIABLES +#endif /* !YYPURE */ + + register int yystate; + register int yyn; + int yyresult; + /* Number of tokens to shift before error messages enabled. */ + int yyerrstatus; + /* Lookahead token as an internal (translated) token number. */ + int yychar1 = 0; + + /* Three stacks and their tools: + `yyss': related to states, + `yyvs': related to semantic values, + `yyls': related to locations. + + Refer to the stacks thru separate pointers, to allow yyoverflow + to reallocate them elsewhere. */ + + /* The state stack. */ + short yyssa[YYINITDEPTH]; + short *yyss = yyssa; + register short *yyssp; + + /* The semantic value stack. */ + YYSTYPE yyvsa[YYINITDEPTH]; + YYSTYPE *yyvs = yyvsa; + register YYSTYPE *yyvsp; + +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + /* The location stack. */ + YYLTYPE yylsa[YYINITDEPTH]; + YYLTYPE *yyls = yylsa; + YYLTYPE *yylsp; +#endif + +#if YYLSP_NEEDED +# define YYPOPSTACK (yyvsp--, yyssp--, yylsp--) +#else +# define YYPOPSTACK (yyvsp--, yyssp--) +#endif + + YYSIZE_T yystacksize = YYINITDEPTH; + + + /* The variables used to return semantic value and location from the + action routines. */ + YYSTYPE yyval; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + YYLTYPE yyloc; +#endif + + /* When reducing, the number of symbols on the RHS of the reduced + rule. */ + int yylen; + + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Starting parse\n")); + + yystate = 0; + yyerrstatus = 0; + yynerrs = 0; + yychar = YYEMPTY; /* Cause a token to be read. */ + + /* Initialize stack pointers. + Waste one element of value and location stack + so that they stay on the same level as the state stack. + The wasted elements are never initialized. */ + + yyssp = yyss; + yyvsp = yyvs; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + yylsp = yyls; +#endif + goto yysetstate; + +/*------------------------------------------------------------. +| yynewstate -- Push a new state, which is found in yystate. | +`------------------------------------------------------------*/ + yynewstate: + /* In all cases, when you get here, the value and location stacks + have just been pushed. so pushing a state here evens the stacks. + */ + yyssp++; + + yysetstate: + *yyssp = yystate; + + if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1) + { + /* Get the current used size of the three stacks, in elements. */ + YYSIZE_T yysize = yyssp - yyss + 1; + +#ifdef yyoverflow + { + /* Give user a chance to reallocate the stack. Use copies of + these so that the &'s don't force the real ones into + memory. */ + YYSTYPE *yyvs1 = yyvs; + short *yyss1 = yyss; + + /* Each stack pointer address is followed by the size of the + data in use in that stack, in bytes. */ +# if YYLSP_NEEDED + YYLTYPE *yyls1 = yyls; + /* This used to be a conditional around just the two extra args, + but that might be undefined if yyoverflow is a macro. */ + yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow", + &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp), + &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp), + &yyls1, yysize * sizeof (*yylsp), + &yystacksize); + yyls = yyls1; +# else + yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow", + &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp), + &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp), + &yystacksize); +# endif + yyss = yyss1; + yyvs = yyvs1; + } +#else /* no yyoverflow */ +# ifndef YYSTACK_RELOCATE + goto yyoverflowlab; +# else + /* Extend the stack our own way. */ + if (yystacksize >= YYMAXDEPTH) + goto yyoverflowlab; + yystacksize *= 2; + if (yystacksize > YYMAXDEPTH) + yystacksize = YYMAXDEPTH; + + { + short *yyss1 = yyss; + union yyalloc *yyptr = + (union yyalloc *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (YYSTACK_BYTES (yystacksize)); + if (! yyptr) + goto yyoverflowlab; + YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyss); + YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyvs); +# if YYLSP_NEEDED + YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyls); +# endif +# undef YYSTACK_RELOCATE + if (yyss1 != yyssa) + YYSTACK_FREE (yyss1); + } +# endif +#endif /* no yyoverflow */ + + yyssp = yyss + yysize - 1; + yyvsp = yyvs + yysize - 1; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + yylsp = yyls + yysize - 1; +#endif + + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Stack size increased to %lu\n", + (unsigned long int) yystacksize)); + + if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1) + YYABORT; + } + + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Entering state %d\n", yystate)); + + goto yybackup; + + +/*-----------. +| yybackup. | +`-----------*/ +yybackup: + +/* Do appropriate processing given the current state. */ +/* Read a lookahead token if we need one and don't already have one. */ +/* yyresume: */ + + /* First try to decide what to do without reference to lookahead token. */ + + yyn = yypact[yystate]; + if (yyn == YYFLAG) + goto yydefault; + + /* Not known => get a lookahead token if don't already have one. */ + + /* yychar is either YYEMPTY or YYEOF + or a valid token in external form. */ + + if (yychar == YYEMPTY) + { + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Reading a token: ")); + yychar = YYLEX; + } + + /* Convert token to internal form (in yychar1) for indexing tables with */ + + if (yychar <= 0) /* This means end of input. */ + { + yychar1 = 0; + yychar = YYEOF; /* Don't call YYLEX any more */ + + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Now at end of input.\n")); + } + else + { + yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar); + +#if YYDEBUG + /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables + which are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set. */ + if (yydebug) + { + YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Next token is %d (%s", + yychar, yytname[yychar1]); + /* Give the individual parser a way to print the precise + meaning of a token, for further debugging info. */ +# ifdef YYPRINT + YYPRINT (stderr, yychar, yylval); +# endif + YYFPRINTF (stderr, ")\n"); + } +#endif + } + + yyn += yychar1; + if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != yychar1) + goto yydefault; + + yyn = yytable[yyn]; + + /* yyn is what to do for this token type in this state. + Negative => reduce, -yyn is rule number. + Positive => shift, yyn is new state. + New state is final state => don't bother to shift, + just return success. + 0, or most negative number => error. */ + + if (yyn < 0) + { + if (yyn == YYFLAG) + goto yyerrlab; + yyn = -yyn; + goto yyreduce; + } + else if (yyn == 0) + goto yyerrlab; + + if (yyn == YYFINAL) + YYACCEPT; + + /* Shift the lookahead token. */ + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting token %d (%s), ", + yychar, yytname[yychar1])); + + /* Discard the token being shifted unless it is eof. */ + if (yychar != YYEOF) + yychar = YYEMPTY; + + *++yyvsp = yylval; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + *++yylsp = yylloc; +#endif + + /* Count tokens shifted since error; after three, turn off error + status. */ + if (yyerrstatus) + yyerrstatus--; + + yystate = yyn; + goto yynewstate; + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------. +| yydefault -- do the default action for the current state. | +`-----------------------------------------------------------*/ +yydefault: + yyn = yydefact[yystate]; + if (yyn == 0) + goto yyerrlab; + goto yyreduce; + + +/*-----------------------------. +| yyreduce -- Do a reduction. | +`-----------------------------*/ +yyreduce: + /* yyn is the number of a rule to reduce with. */ + yylen = yyr2[yyn]; + + /* If YYLEN is nonzero, implement the default value of the action: + `$$ = $1'. + + Otherwise, the following line sets YYVAL to the semantic value of + the lookahead token. This behavior is undocumented and Bison + users should not rely upon it. Assigning to YYVAL + unconditionally makes the parser a bit smaller, and it avoids a + GCC warning that YYVAL may be used uninitialized. */ + yyval = yyvsp[1-yylen]; + +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + /* Similarly for the default location. Let the user run additional + commands if for instance locations are ranges. */ + yyloc = yylsp[1-yylen]; + YYLLOC_DEFAULT (yyloc, (yylsp - yylen), yylen); +#endif + +#if YYDEBUG + /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables which + are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set. */ + if (yydebug) + { + int yyi; + + YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Reducing via rule %d (line %d), ", + yyn, yyrline[yyn]); + + /* Print the symbols being reduced, and their result. */ + for (yyi = yyprhs[yyn]; yyrhs[yyi] > 0; yyi++) + YYFPRINTF (stderr, "%s ", yytname[yyrhs[yyi]]); + YYFPRINTF (stderr, " -> %s\n", yytname[yyr1[yyn]]); + } +#endif + + switch (yyn) { + +case 1: +#line 175 "plural.y" +{ + if (yyvsp[0].exp == NULL) + YYABORT; + ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = yyvsp[0].exp; + } + break; +case 2: +#line 183 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_3 (qmop, yyvsp[-4].exp, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 3: +#line 187 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (lor, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 4: +#line 191 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (land, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 5: +#line 195 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 6: +#line 199 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 7: +#line 203 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 8: +#line 207 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 9: +#line 211 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_1 (lnot, yyvsp[0].exp); + } + break; +case 10: +#line 215 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (var); + } + break; +case 11: +#line 219 "plural.y" +{ + if ((yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL) + yyval.exp->val.num = yyvsp[0].num; + } + break; +case 12: +#line 224 "plural.y" +{ + yyval.exp = yyvsp[-1].exp; + } + break; +} + +#line 705 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple" + + + yyvsp -= yylen; + yyssp -= yylen; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + yylsp -= yylen; +#endif + +#if YYDEBUG + if (yydebug) + { + short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1; + YYFPRINTF (stderr, "state stack now"); + while (yyssp1 != yyssp) + YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1); + YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n"); + } +#endif + + *++yyvsp = yyval; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + *++yylsp = yyloc; +#endif + + /* Now `shift' the result of the reduction. Determine what state + that goes to, based on the state we popped back to and the rule + number reduced by. */ + + yyn = yyr1[yyn]; + + yystate = yypgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE] + *yyssp; + if (yystate >= 0 && yystate <= YYLAST && yycheck[yystate] == *yyssp) + yystate = yytable[yystate]; + else + yystate = yydefgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE]; + + goto yynewstate; + + +/*------------------------------------. +| yyerrlab -- here on detecting error | +`------------------------------------*/ +yyerrlab: + /* If not already recovering from an error, report this error. */ + if (!yyerrstatus) + { + ++yynerrs; + +#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE + yyn = yypact[yystate]; + + if (yyn > YYFLAG && yyn < YYLAST) + { + YYSIZE_T yysize = 0; + char *yymsg; + int yyx, yycount; + + yycount = 0; + /* Start YYX at -YYN if negative to avoid negative indexes in + YYCHECK. */ + for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0; + yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *)); yyx++) + if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx) + yysize += yystrlen (yytname[yyx]) + 15, yycount++; + yysize += yystrlen ("parse error, unexpected ") + 1; + yysize += yystrlen (yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]); + yymsg = (char *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (yysize); + if (yymsg != 0) + { + char *yyp = yystpcpy (yymsg, "parse error, unexpected "); + yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]); + + if (yycount < 5) + { + yycount = 0; + for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0; + yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *)); + yyx++) + if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx) + { + const char *yyq = ! yycount ? ", expecting " : " or "; + yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yyq); + yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[yyx]); + yycount++; + } + } + yyerror (yymsg); + YYSTACK_FREE (yymsg); + } + else + yyerror ("parse error; also virtual memory exhausted"); + } + else +#endif /* defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */ + yyerror ("parse error"); + } + goto yyerrlab1; + + +/*--------------------------------------------------. +| yyerrlab1 -- error raised explicitly by an action | +`--------------------------------------------------*/ +yyerrlab1: + if (yyerrstatus == 3) + { + /* If just tried and failed to reuse lookahead token after an + error, discard it. */ + + /* return failure if at end of input */ + if (yychar == YYEOF) + YYABORT; + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Discarding token %d (%s).\n", + yychar, yytname[yychar1])); + yychar = YYEMPTY; + } + + /* Else will try to reuse lookahead token after shifting the error + token. */ + + yyerrstatus = 3; /* Each real token shifted decrements this */ + + goto yyerrhandle; + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------. +| yyerrdefault -- current state does not do anything special for the | +| error token. | +`-------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +yyerrdefault: +#if 0 + /* This is wrong; only states that explicitly want error tokens + should shift them. */ + + /* If its default is to accept any token, ok. Otherwise pop it. */ + yyn = yydefact[yystate]; + if (yyn) + goto yydefault; +#endif + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------. +| yyerrpop -- pop the current state because it cannot handle the | +| error token | +`---------------------------------------------------------------*/ +yyerrpop: + if (yyssp == yyss) + YYABORT; + yyvsp--; + yystate = *--yyssp; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + yylsp--; +#endif + +#if YYDEBUG + if (yydebug) + { + short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1; + YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Error: state stack now"); + while (yyssp1 != yyssp) + YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1); + YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n"); + } +#endif + +/*--------------. +| yyerrhandle. | +`--------------*/ +yyerrhandle: + yyn = yypact[yystate]; + if (yyn == YYFLAG) + goto yyerrdefault; + + yyn += YYTERROR; + if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != YYTERROR) + goto yyerrdefault; + + yyn = yytable[yyn]; + if (yyn < 0) + { + if (yyn == YYFLAG) + goto yyerrpop; + yyn = -yyn; + goto yyreduce; + } + else if (yyn == 0) + goto yyerrpop; + + if (yyn == YYFINAL) + YYACCEPT; + + YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting error token, ")); + + *++yyvsp = yylval; +#if YYLSP_NEEDED + *++yylsp = yylloc; +#endif + + yystate = yyn; + goto yynewstate; + + +/*-------------------------------------. +| yyacceptlab -- YYACCEPT comes here. | +`-------------------------------------*/ +yyacceptlab: + yyresult = 0; + goto yyreturn; + +/*-----------------------------------. +| yyabortlab -- YYABORT comes here. | +`-----------------------------------*/ +yyabortlab: + yyresult = 1; + goto yyreturn; + +/*---------------------------------------------. +| yyoverflowab -- parser overflow comes here. | +`---------------------------------------------*/ +yyoverflowlab: + yyerror ("parser stack overflow"); + yyresult = 2; + /* Fall through. */ + +yyreturn: +#ifndef yyoverflow + if (yyss != yyssa) + YYSTACK_FREE (yyss); +#endif + return yyresult; +} +#line 229 "plural.y" + + +void +internal_function +FREE_EXPRESSION (exp) + struct expression *exp; +{ + if (exp == NULL) + return; + + /* Handle the recursive case. */ + switch (exp->nargs) + { + case 3: + FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]); + /* FALLTHROUGH */ + case 2: + FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]); + /* FALLTHROUGH */ + case 1: + FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]); + /* FALLTHROUGH */ + default: + break; + } + + free (exp); +} + + +static int +yylex (lval, pexp) + YYSTYPE *lval; + const char **pexp; +{ + const char *exp = *pexp; + int result; + + while (1) + { + if (exp[0] == '\0') + { + *pexp = exp; + return YYEOF; + } + + if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t') + break; + + ++exp; + } + + result = *exp++; + switch (result) + { + case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': + case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': + { + unsigned long int n = result - '0'; + while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9') + { + n *= 10; + n += exp[0] - '0'; + ++exp; + } + lval->num = n; + result = NUMBER; + } + break; + + case '=': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = equal; + result = EQUOP2; + } + else + result = YYERRCODE; + break; + + case '!': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = not_equal; + result = EQUOP2; + } + break; + + case '&': + case '|': + if (exp[0] == result) + ++exp; + else + result = YYERRCODE; + break; + + case '<': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = less_or_equal; + } + else + lval->op = less_than; + result = CMPOP2; + break; + + case '>': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = greater_or_equal; + } + else + lval->op = greater_than; + result = CMPOP2; + break; + + case '*': + lval->op = mult; + result = MULOP2; + break; + + case '/': + lval->op = divide; + result = MULOP2; + break; + + case '%': + lval->op = module; + result = MULOP2; + break; + + case '+': + lval->op = plus; + result = ADDOP2; + break; + + case '-': + lval->op = minus; + result = ADDOP2; + break; + + case 'n': + case '?': + case ':': + case '(': + case ')': + /* Nothing, just return the character. */ + break; + + case ';': + case '\n': + case '\0': + /* Be safe and let the user call this function again. */ + --exp; + result = YYEOF; + break; + + default: + result = YYERRCODE; +#if YYDEBUG != 0 + --exp; +#endif + break; + } + + *pexp = exp; + + return result; +} + + +static void +yyerror (str) + const char *str; +{ + /* Do nothing. We don't print error messages here. */ +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/plural.y Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,409 @@ +%{ +/* Expression parsing for plural form selection. + Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +/* The bison generated parser uses alloca. AIX 3 forces us to put this + declaration at the beginning of the file. The declaration in bison's + skeleton file comes too late. This must come before <config.h> + because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers. */ +#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__ + #pragma alloca +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stddef.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include "plural-exp.h" + +/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse, + but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE. */ +#ifndef _LIBC +# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE +#endif + +#define YYLEX_PARAM &((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp +#define YYPARSE_PARAM arg +%} +%pure_parser +%expect 7 + +%union { + unsigned long int num; + enum operator op; + struct expression *exp; +} + +%{ +/* Prototypes for local functions. */ +static struct expression *new_exp PARAMS ((int nargs, enum operator op, + struct expression * const *args)); +static inline struct expression *new_exp_0 PARAMS ((enum operator op)); +static inline struct expression *new_exp_1 PARAMS ((enum operator op, + struct expression *right)); +static struct expression *new_exp_2 PARAMS ((enum operator op, + struct expression *left, + struct expression *right)); +static inline struct expression *new_exp_3 PARAMS ((enum operator op, + struct expression *bexp, + struct expression *tbranch, + struct expression *fbranch)); +static int yylex PARAMS ((YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp)); +static void yyerror PARAMS ((const char *str)); + +/* Allocation of expressions. */ + +static struct expression * +new_exp (nargs, op, args) + int nargs; + enum operator op; + struct expression * const *args; +{ + int i; + struct expression *newp; + + /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL. */ + for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) + if (args[i] == NULL) + goto fail; + + /* Allocate a new expression. */ + newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp)); + if (newp != NULL) + { + newp->nargs = nargs; + newp->operation = op; + for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) + newp->val.args[i] = args[i]; + return newp; + } + + fail: + for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) + FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]); + + return NULL; +} + +static inline struct expression * +new_exp_0 (op) + enum operator op; +{ + return new_exp (0, op, NULL); +} + +static inline struct expression * +new_exp_1 (op, right) + enum operator op; + struct expression *right; +{ + struct expression *args[1]; + + args[0] = right; + return new_exp (1, op, args); +} + +static struct expression * +new_exp_2 (op, left, right) + enum operator op; + struct expression *left; + struct expression *right; +{ + struct expression *args[2]; + + args[0] = left; + args[1] = right; + return new_exp (2, op, args); +} + +static inline struct expression * +new_exp_3 (op, bexp, tbranch, fbranch) + enum operator op; + struct expression *bexp; + struct expression *tbranch; + struct expression *fbranch; +{ + struct expression *args[3]; + + args[0] = bexp; + args[1] = tbranch; + args[2] = fbranch; + return new_exp (3, op, args); +} + +%} + +/* This declares that all operators have the same associativity and the + precedence order as in C. See [Harbison, Steele: C, A Reference Manual]. + There is no unary minus and no bitwise operators. + Operators with the same syntactic behaviour have been merged into a single + token, to save space in the array generated by bison. */ +%right '?' /* ? */ +%left '|' /* || */ +%left '&' /* && */ +%left EQUOP2 /* == != */ +%left CMPOP2 /* < > <= >= */ +%left ADDOP2 /* + - */ +%left MULOP2 /* * / % */ +%right '!' /* ! */ + +%token <op> EQUOP2 CMPOP2 ADDOP2 MULOP2 +%token <num> NUMBER +%type <exp> exp + +%% + +start: exp + { + if ($1 == NULL) + YYABORT; + ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = $1; + } + ; + +exp: exp '?' exp ':' exp + { + $$ = new_exp_3 (qmop, $1, $3, $5); + } + | exp '|' exp + { + $$ = new_exp_2 (lor, $1, $3); + } + | exp '&' exp + { + $$ = new_exp_2 (land, $1, $3); + } + | exp EQUOP2 exp + { + $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); + } + | exp CMPOP2 exp + { + $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); + } + | exp ADDOP2 exp + { + $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); + } + | exp MULOP2 exp + { + $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); + } + | '!' exp + { + $$ = new_exp_1 (lnot, $2); + } + | 'n' + { + $$ = new_exp_0 (var); + } + | NUMBER + { + if (($$ = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL) + $$->val.num = $1; + } + | '(' exp ')' + { + $$ = $2; + } + ; + +%% + +void +internal_function +FREE_EXPRESSION (exp) + struct expression *exp; +{ + if (exp == NULL) + return; + + /* Handle the recursive case. */ + switch (exp->nargs) + { + case 3: + FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]); + /* FALLTHROUGH */ + case 2: + FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]); + /* FALLTHROUGH */ + case 1: + FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]); + /* FALLTHROUGH */ + default: + break; + } + + free (exp); +} + + +static int +yylex (lval, pexp) + YYSTYPE *lval; + const char **pexp; +{ + const char *exp = *pexp; + int result; + + while (1) + { + if (exp[0] == '\0') + { + *pexp = exp; + return YYEOF; + } + + if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t') + break; + + ++exp; + } + + result = *exp++; + switch (result) + { + case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': + case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': + { + unsigned long int n = result - '0'; + while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9') + { + n *= 10; + n += exp[0] - '0'; + ++exp; + } + lval->num = n; + result = NUMBER; + } + break; + + case '=': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = equal; + result = EQUOP2; + } + else + result = YYERRCODE; + break; + + case '!': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = not_equal; + result = EQUOP2; + } + break; + + case '&': + case '|': + if (exp[0] == result) + ++exp; + else + result = YYERRCODE; + break; + + case '<': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = less_or_equal; + } + else + lval->op = less_than; + result = CMPOP2; + break; + + case '>': + if (exp[0] == '=') + { + ++exp; + lval->op = greater_or_equal; + } + else + lval->op = greater_than; + result = CMPOP2; + break; + + case '*': + lval->op = mult; + result = MULOP2; + break; + + case '/': + lval->op = divide; + result = MULOP2; + break; + + case '%': + lval->op = module; + result = MULOP2; + break; + + case '+': + lval->op = plus; + result = ADDOP2; + break; + + case '-': + lval->op = minus; + result = ADDOP2; + break; + + case 'n': + case '?': + case ':': + case '(': + case ')': + /* Nothing, just return the character. */ + break; + + case ';': + case '\n': + case '\0': + /* Be safe and let the user call this function again. */ + --exp; + result = YYEOF; + break; + + default: + result = YYERRCODE; +#if YYDEBUG != 0 + --exp; +#endif + break; + } + + *pexp = exp; + + return result; +} + + +static void +yyerror (str) + const char *str; +{ + /* Do nothing. We don't print error messages here. */ +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/ref-add.sin Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,31 @@ +# Add this package to a list of references stored in a text file. +# +# Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +# +# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it +# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published +# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) +# any later version. +# +# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, +# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of +# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU +# Library General Public License for more details. +# +# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public +# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software +# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, +# USA. +# +# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>. +# +/^# Packages using this file: / { + s/# Packages using this file:// + ta + :a + s/ @PACKAGE@ / @PACKAGE@ / + tb + s/ $/ @PACKAGE@ / + :b + s/^/# Packages using this file:/ +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/ref-del.sin Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +# Remove this package from a list of references stored in a text file. +# +# Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +# +# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it +# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published +# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) +# any later version. +# +# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, +# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of +# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU +# Library General Public License for more details. +# +# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public +# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software +# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, +# USA. +# +# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>. +# +/^# Packages using this file: / { + s/# Packages using this file:// + s/ @PACKAGE@ / / + s/^/# Packages using this file:/ +}
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/relocatable.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,439 @@ +/* Provide relocatable packages. + Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + + +/* Tell glibc's <stdio.h> to provide a prototype for getline(). + This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include + <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ +#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE +# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 +#endif + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include "config.h" +#endif + +/* Specification. */ +#include "relocatable.h" + +#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE + +#include <stddef.h> +#include <stdio.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#ifdef NO_XMALLOC +# define xmalloc malloc +#else +# include "xmalloc.h" +#endif + +#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET +# include <libcharset.h> +#endif +#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV +# include <iconv.h> +#endif +#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS +# include <libintl.h> +#endif + +/* Faked cheap 'bool'. */ +#undef bool +#undef false +#undef true +#define bool int +#define false 0 +#define true 1 + +/* Pathname support. + ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character. + IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) tests whether P contains a directory specification. + */ +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ + /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') +# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \ + ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \ + && (P)[1] == ':') +# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \ + (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P)) +# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) (HAS_DEVICE (P) ? 2 : 0) +#else + /* Unix */ +# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/') +# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL) +# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) 0 +#endif + +/* Original installation prefix. */ +static char *orig_prefix; +static size_t orig_prefix_len; +/* Current installation prefix. */ +static char *curr_prefix; +static size_t curr_prefix_len; +/* These prefixes do not end in a slash. Anything that will be concatenated + to them must start with a slash. */ + +/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of this module. + Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix + by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both + prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" + instead of "/"). */ +static void +set_this_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg, + const char *curr_prefix_arg) +{ + if (orig_prefix_arg != NULL && curr_prefix_arg != NULL + /* Optimization: if orig_prefix and curr_prefix are equal, the + relocation is a nop. */ + && strcmp (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg) != 0) + { + /* Duplicate the argument strings. */ + char *memory; + + orig_prefix_len = strlen (orig_prefix_arg); + curr_prefix_len = strlen (curr_prefix_arg); + memory = (char *) xmalloc (orig_prefix_len + 1 + curr_prefix_len + 1); +#ifdef NO_XMALLOC + if (memory != NULL) +#endif + { + memcpy (memory, orig_prefix_arg, orig_prefix_len + 1); + orig_prefix = memory; + memory += orig_prefix_len + 1; + memcpy (memory, curr_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_len + 1); + curr_prefix = memory; + return; + } + } + orig_prefix = NULL; + curr_prefix = NULL; + /* Don't worry about wasted memory here - this function is usually only + called once. */ +} + +/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package. + Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix + by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both + prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" + instead of "/"). */ +void +set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg, const char *curr_prefix_arg) +{ + set_this_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); + + /* Now notify all dependent libraries. */ +#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET + libcharset_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); +#endif +#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV && _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0109 + libiconv_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); +#endif +#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS && defined libintl_set_relocation_prefix + libintl_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); +#endif +} + +/* Convenience function: + Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original + installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular + file, and the current pathname of this file. Returns NULL upon failure. */ +#ifdef IN_LIBRARY +#define compute_curr_prefix local_compute_curr_prefix +static +#endif +const char * +compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix, + const char *orig_installdir, + const char *curr_pathname) +{ + const char *curr_installdir; + const char *rel_installdir; + + if (curr_pathname == NULL) + return NULL; + + /* Determine the relative installation directory, relative to the prefix. + This is simply the difference between orig_installprefix and + orig_installdir. */ + if (strncmp (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir, strlen (orig_installprefix)) + != 0) + /* Shouldn't happen - nothing should be installed outside $(prefix). */ + return NULL; + rel_installdir = orig_installdir + strlen (orig_installprefix); + + /* Determine the current installation directory. */ + { + const char *p_base = curr_pathname + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_pathname); + const char *p = curr_pathname + strlen (curr_pathname); + char *q; + + while (p > p_base) + { + p--; + if (ISSLASH (*p)) + break; + } + + q = (char *) xmalloc (p - curr_pathname + 1); +#ifdef NO_XMALLOC + if (q == NULL) + return NULL; +#endif + memcpy (q, curr_pathname, p - curr_pathname); + q[p - curr_pathname] = '\0'; + curr_installdir = q; + } + + /* Compute the current installation prefix by removing the trailing + rel_installdir from it. */ + { + const char *rp = rel_installdir + strlen (rel_installdir); + const char *cp = curr_installdir + strlen (curr_installdir); + const char *cp_base = + curr_installdir + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_installdir); + + while (rp > rel_installdir && cp > cp_base) + { + bool same = false; + const char *rpi = rp; + const char *cpi = cp; + + while (rpi > rel_installdir && cpi > cp_base) + { + rpi--; + cpi--; + if (ISSLASH (*rpi) || ISSLASH (*cpi)) + { + if (ISSLASH (*rpi) && ISSLASH (*cpi)) + same = true; + break; + } +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ + /* Win32, OS/2, DOS - case insignificant filesystem */ + if ((*rpi >= 'a' && *rpi <= 'z' ? *rpi - 'a' + 'A' : *rpi) + != (*cpi >= 'a' && *cpi <= 'z' ? *cpi - 'a' + 'A' : *cpi)) + break; +#else + if (*rpi != *cpi) + break; +#endif + } + if (!same) + break; + /* The last pathname component was the same. opi and cpi now point + to the slash before it. */ + rp = rpi; + cp = cpi; + } + + if (rp > rel_installdir) + /* Unexpected: The curr_installdir does not end with rel_installdir. */ + return NULL; + + { + size_t curr_prefix_len = cp - curr_installdir; + char *curr_prefix; + + curr_prefix = (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + 1); +#ifdef NO_XMALLOC + if (curr_prefix == NULL) + return NULL; +#endif + memcpy (curr_prefix, curr_installdir, curr_prefix_len); + curr_prefix[curr_prefix_len] = '\0'; + + return curr_prefix; + } + } +} + +#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR + +/* Full pathname of shared library, or NULL. */ +static char *shared_library_fullname; + +#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ + +/* Determine the full pathname of the shared library when it is loaded. */ + +BOOL WINAPI +DllMain (HINSTANCE module_handle, DWORD event, LPVOID reserved) +{ + (void) reserved; + + if (event == DLL_PROCESS_ATTACH) + { + /* The DLL is being loaded into an application's address range. */ + static char location[MAX_PATH]; + + if (!GetModuleFileName (module_handle, location, sizeof (location))) + /* Shouldn't happen. */ + return FALSE; + + if (!IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (location)) + /* Shouldn't happen. */ + return FALSE; + + shared_library_fullname = strdup (location); + } + + return TRUE; +} + +#else /* Unix */ + +static void +find_shared_library_fullname () +{ +#ifdef __linux__ + FILE *fp; + + /* Open the current process' maps file. It describes one VMA per line. */ + fp = fopen ("/proc/self/maps", "r"); + if (fp) + { + unsigned long address = (unsigned long) &find_shared_library_fullname; + for (;;) + { + unsigned long start, end; + int c; + + if (fscanf (fp, "%lx-%lx", &start, &end) != 2) + break; + if (address >= start && address <= end - 1) + { + /* Found it. Now see if this line contains a filename. */ + while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n' && c != '/') + continue; + if (c == '/') + { + size_t size; + int len; + + ungetc (c, fp); + shared_library_fullname = NULL; size = 0; + len = getline (&shared_library_fullname, &size, fp); + if (len >= 0) + { + /* Success: filled shared_library_fullname. */ + if (len > 0 && shared_library_fullname[len - 1] == '\n') + shared_library_fullname[len - 1] = '\0'; + } + } + break; + } + while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n') + continue; + } + fclose (fp); + } +#endif +} + +#endif /* WIN32 / Unix */ + +/* Return the full pathname of the current shared library. + Return NULL if unknown. + Guaranteed to work only on Linux and Woe32. */ +static char * +get_shared_library_fullname () +{ +#if !(defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__) + static bool tried_find_shared_library_fullname; + if (!tried_find_shared_library_fullname) + { + find_shared_library_fullname (); + tried_find_shared_library_fullname = true; + } +#endif + return shared_library_fullname; +} + +#endif /* PIC */ + +/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation + directory. */ +const char * +relocate (const char *pathname) +{ +#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR + static int initialized; + + /* Initialization code for a shared library. */ + if (!initialized) + { + /* At this point, orig_prefix and curr_prefix likely have already been + set through the main program's set_program_name_and_installdir + function. This is sufficient in the case that the library has + initially been installed in the same orig_prefix. But we can do + better, to also cover the cases that 1. it has been installed + in a different prefix before being moved to orig_prefix and (later) + to curr_prefix, 2. unlike the program, it has not moved away from + orig_prefix. */ + const char *orig_installprefix = INSTALLPREFIX; + const char *orig_installdir = INSTALLDIR; + const char *curr_prefix_better; + + curr_prefix_better = + compute_curr_prefix (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir, + get_shared_library_fullname ()); + if (curr_prefix_better == NULL) + curr_prefix_better = curr_prefix; + + set_relocation_prefix (orig_installprefix, curr_prefix_better); + + initialized = 1; + } +#endif + + /* Note: It is not necessary to perform case insensitive comparison here, + even for DOS-like filesystems, because the pathname argument was + typically created from the same Makefile variable as orig_prefix came + from. */ + if (orig_prefix != NULL && curr_prefix != NULL + && strncmp (pathname, orig_prefix, orig_prefix_len) == 0) + { + if (pathname[orig_prefix_len] == '\0') + /* pathname equals orig_prefix. */ + return curr_prefix; + if (ISSLASH (pathname[orig_prefix_len])) + { + /* pathname starts with orig_prefix. */ + const char *pathname_tail = &pathname[orig_prefix_len]; + char *result = + (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + strlen (pathname_tail) + 1); + +#ifdef NO_XMALLOC + if (result != NULL) +#endif + { + memcpy (result, curr_prefix, curr_prefix_len); + strcpy (result + curr_prefix_len, pathname_tail); + return result; + } + } + } + /* Nothing to relocate. */ + return pathname; +} + +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/relocatable.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,67 @@ +/* Provide relocatable packages. + Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifndef _RELOCATABLE_H +#define _RELOCATABLE_H + +/* This can be enabled through the configure --enable-relocatable option. */ +#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE + +/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions. Note that because + this is a private .h file, we don't need to use __declspec(dllimport) + in any case. */ +#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL +# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport) +#else +# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED +#endif + +/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package. + Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix + by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both + prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" + instead of "/"). */ +extern RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED void + set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix, + const char *curr_prefix); + +/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation + directory. */ +extern const char * relocate (const char *pathname); + +/* Memory management: relocate() leaks memory, because it has to construct + a fresh pathname. If this is a problem because your program calls + relocate() frequently, think about caching the result. */ + +/* Convenience function: + Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original + installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular + file, and the current pathname of this file. Returns NULL upon failure. */ +extern const char * compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix, + const char *orig_installdir, + const char *curr_pathname); + +#else + +/* By default, we use the hardwired pathnames. */ +#define relocate(pathname) (pathname) + +#endif + +#endif /* _RELOCATABLE_H */
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/textdomain.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,142 @@ +/* Implementation of the textdomain(3) function. + Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it + under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published + by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) + any later version. + + This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + Library General Public License for more details. + + You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public + License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, + USA. */ + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +# include <config.h> +#endif + +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <string.h> + +#ifdef _LIBC +# include <libintl.h> +#else +# include "libgnuintl.h" +#endif +#include "gettextP.h" + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications. */ +# include <bits/libc-lock.h> +#else +/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */ +# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME) +# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME) +# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME) +#endif + +/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different + names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs + using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */ +#if !defined _LIBC +# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain +# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain +#endif + +/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ + +/* Name of the default text domain. */ +extern const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden; + +/* Default text domain in which entries for gettext(3) are to be found. */ +extern const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden; + + +/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash + with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source + code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ + prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ +#ifdef _LIBC +# define TEXTDOMAIN __textdomain +# ifndef strdup +# define strdup(str) __strdup (str) +# endif +#else +# define TEXTDOMAIN libintl_textdomain +#endif + +/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */ +__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden) + +/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME. + If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default. + If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages". */ +char * +TEXTDOMAIN (domainname) + const char *domainname; +{ + char *new_domain; + char *old_domain; + + /* A NULL pointer requests the current setting. */ + if (domainname == NULL) + return (char *) _nl_current_default_domain; + + __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock); + + old_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain; + + /* If domain name is the null string set to default domain "messages". */ + if (domainname[0] == '\0' + || strcmp (domainname, _nl_default_default_domain) == 0) + { + _nl_current_default_domain = _nl_default_default_domain; + new_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain; + } + else if (strcmp (domainname, old_domain) == 0) + /* This can happen and people will use it to signal that some + environment variable changed. */ + new_domain = old_domain; + else + { + /* If the following malloc fails `_nl_current_default_domain' + will be NULL. This value will be returned and so signals we + are out of core. */ +#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP + new_domain = strdup (domainname); +#else + size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1; + new_domain = (char *) malloc (len); + if (new_domain != NULL) + memcpy (new_domain, domainname, len); +#endif + + if (new_domain != NULL) + _nl_current_default_domain = new_domain; + } + + /* We use this possibility to signal a change of the loaded catalogs + since this is most likely the case and there is no other easy we + to do it. Do it only when the call was successful. */ + if (new_domain != NULL) + { + ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr; + + if (old_domain != new_domain && old_domain != _nl_default_default_domain) + free (old_domain); + } + + __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); + + return new_domain; +} + +#ifdef _LIBC +/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ +weak_alias (__textdomain, textdomain); +#endif
--- /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 +++ b/src/audacious/intl/ui_skinned_textbox.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:34 2007 +0200 @@ -0,0 +1,912 @@ +/* + * Audacious - a cross-platform multimedia player + * Copyright (c) 2007 Audacious development team. + * + * Based on: + * BMP - Cross-platform multimedia player + * Copyright (C) 2003-2004 BMP development team. + * XMMS: + * Copyright (C) 1998-2003 XMMS development team. + * + * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify + * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by + * the Free Software Foundation; under version 2 of the License. + * + * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, + * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the + * GNU General Public License for more details. + * + * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + * along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software + * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. + */ + +#include "widgets/widgetcore.h" +#include "ui_skinned_textbox.h" +#include "main.h" +#include "util.h" +#include "strings.h" +#include <string.h> +#include <ctype.h> +#include <gtk/gtkmain.h> +#include <gtk/gtkmarshal.h> +#include <gtk/gtkimage.h> + +#define UI_TYPE_SKINNED_TEXTBOX (ui_skinned_textbox_get_type()) +#define UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(o) (G_TYPE_INSTANCE_GET_PRIVATE ((o), UI_TYPE_SKINNED_TEXTBOX, UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate)) +typedef struct _UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate; + +static GMutex *mutex = NULL; + +#define TEXTBOX_SCROLL_SMOOTH_TIMEOUT 30 +#define TEXTBOX_SCROLL_WAIT 80 + +enum { + CLICKED, + DOUBLE_CLICKED, + RIGHT_CLICKED, + DOUBLED, + REDRAW, + LAST_SIGNAL +}; + +struct _UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate { + SkinPixmapId skin_index; + GtkWidget *fixed; + gboolean double_size; + gboolean scroll_back; + gint nominal_y, nominal_height; + gint scroll_timeout; + gint font_ascent, font_descent; + PangoFontDescription *font; + gchar *fontname; + gchar *pixmap_text; + gint skin_id; + gint drag_x, drag_off, offset; + gboolean is_scrollable, is_dragging; + gint pixmap_width; + GdkPixmap *pixmap; + gboolean scroll_allowed, scroll_enabled; + gint scroll_dummy; + gint resize_width, resize_height; + gint move_x, move_y; +}; + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_class_init (UiSkinnedTextboxClass *klass); +static void ui_skinned_textbox_init (UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox); +static void ui_skinned_textbox_destroy (GtkObject *object); +static void ui_skinned_textbox_realize (GtkWidget *widget); +static void ui_skinned_textbox_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, GtkRequisition *requisition); +static void ui_skinned_textbox_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation); +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_expose (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventExpose *event); +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_button_press (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event); +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_button_release (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event); +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_motion_notify (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventMotion *event); +static void ui_skinned_textbox_toggle_doublesize (UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox); +static void ui_skinned_textbox_redraw (UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox); +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_should_scroll (UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox); +static void textbox_generate_xfont_pixmap (UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox, const gchar *pixmaptext); +static gboolean textbox_scroll (gpointer data); +static void textbox_generate_pixmap (UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox); +static void textbox_handle_special_char (gchar *c, gint * x, gint * y); + +static GtkWidgetClass *parent_class = NULL; +static guint textbox_signals[LAST_SIGNAL] = { 0 }; + +GType ui_skinned_textbox_get_type() { + static GType textbox_type = 0; + if (!textbox_type) { + static const GTypeInfo textbox_info = { + sizeof (UiSkinnedTextboxClass), + NULL, + NULL, + (GClassInitFunc) ui_skinned_textbox_class_init, + NULL, + NULL, + sizeof (UiSkinnedTextbox), + 0, + (GInstanceInitFunc) ui_skinned_textbox_init, + }; + textbox_type = g_type_register_static (GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, "UiSkinnedTextbox", &textbox_info, 0); + } + + return textbox_type; +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_class_init(UiSkinnedTextboxClass *klass) { + GObjectClass *gobject_class; + GtkObjectClass *object_class; + GtkWidgetClass *widget_class; + + gobject_class = G_OBJECT_CLASS(klass); + object_class = (GtkObjectClass*) klass; + widget_class = (GtkWidgetClass*) klass; + parent_class = gtk_type_class (gtk_widget_get_type ()); + + object_class->destroy = ui_skinned_textbox_destroy; + + widget_class->realize = ui_skinned_textbox_realize; + widget_class->expose_event = ui_skinned_textbox_expose; + widget_class->size_request = ui_skinned_textbox_size_request; + widget_class->size_allocate = ui_skinned_textbox_size_allocate; + widget_class->button_press_event = ui_skinned_textbox_button_press; + widget_class->button_release_event = ui_skinned_textbox_button_release; + widget_class->motion_notify_event = ui_skinned_textbox_motion_notify; + + klass->clicked = NULL; + klass->double_clicked = NULL; + klass->right_clicked = NULL; + klass->doubled = ui_skinned_textbox_toggle_doublesize; + klass->redraw = ui_skinned_textbox_redraw; + + textbox_signals[CLICKED] = + g_signal_new ("clicked", G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (object_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, + G_STRUCT_OFFSET (UiSkinnedTextboxClass, clicked), NULL, NULL, + gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); + + textbox_signals[DOUBLE_CLICKED] = + g_signal_new ("double-clicked", G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (object_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, + G_STRUCT_OFFSET (UiSkinnedTextboxClass, double_clicked), NULL, NULL, + gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); + + textbox_signals[RIGHT_CLICKED] = + g_signal_new ("right-clicked", G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (object_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, + G_STRUCT_OFFSET (UiSkinnedTextboxClass, right_clicked), NULL, NULL, + gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); + + textbox_signals[DOUBLED] = + g_signal_new ("toggle-double-size", G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (object_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, + G_STRUCT_OFFSET (UiSkinnedTextboxClass, doubled), NULL, NULL, + gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); + + textbox_signals[REDRAW] = + g_signal_new ("redraw", G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (object_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, + G_STRUCT_OFFSET (UiSkinnedTextboxClass, redraw), NULL, NULL, + gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); + + g_type_class_add_private (gobject_class, sizeof (UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate)); +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_init(UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox) { + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + mutex = g_mutex_new(); + priv->resize_width = 0; + priv->resize_height = 0; + priv->move_x = 0; + priv->move_y = 0; +} + +GtkWidget* ui_skinned_textbox_new(GtkWidget *fixed, gint x, gint y, gint w, gboolean allow_scroll, SkinPixmapId si) { + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = g_object_new (ui_skinned_textbox_get_type (), NULL); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + textbox->height = bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_height; + textbox->x = x; + textbox->y = y; + textbox->text = g_strdup(""); + textbox->width = w; + priv->scroll_allowed = allow_scroll; + priv->scroll_enabled = TRUE; + priv->skin_index = si; + priv->nominal_y = y; + priv->nominal_height = textbox->height; + priv->scroll_timeout = 0; + priv->scroll_dummy = 0; + + priv->fixed = fixed; + priv->double_size = FALSE; + + gtk_fixed_put(GTK_FIXED(priv->fixed), GTK_WIDGET(textbox), textbox->x, textbox->y); + + return GTK_WIDGET(textbox); +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_destroy(GtkObject *object) { + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox; + + g_return_if_fail (object != NULL); + g_return_if_fail (UI_SKINNED_IS_TEXTBOX (object)); + + textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX (object); + + if (GTK_OBJECT_CLASS (parent_class)->destroy) + (* GTK_OBJECT_CLASS (parent_class)->destroy) (object); +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_realize(GtkWidget *widget) { + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox; + GdkWindowAttr attributes; + gint attributes_mask; + + g_return_if_fail (widget != NULL); + g_return_if_fail (UI_SKINNED_IS_TEXTBOX(widget)); + + GTK_WIDGET_SET_FLAGS(widget, GTK_REALIZED); + textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX(widget); + + attributes.x = widget->allocation.x; + attributes.y = widget->allocation.y; + attributes.width = widget->allocation.width; + attributes.height = widget->allocation.height; + attributes.wclass = GDK_INPUT_OUTPUT; + attributes.window_type = GDK_WINDOW_CHILD; + attributes.event_mask = gtk_widget_get_events(widget); + attributes.event_mask |= GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK | GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK | + GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK | GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK | + GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK; + attributes.visual = gtk_widget_get_visual(widget); + attributes.colormap = gtk_widget_get_colormap(widget); + + attributes_mask = GDK_WA_X | GDK_WA_Y | GDK_WA_VISUAL | GDK_WA_COLORMAP; + widget->window = gdk_window_new(widget->parent->window, &attributes, attributes_mask); + + widget->style = gtk_style_attach(widget->style, widget->window); + + gdk_window_set_user_data(widget->window, widget); +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_size_request(GtkWidget *widget, GtkRequisition *requisition) { + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX(widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + requisition->width = textbox->width*(1+priv->double_size); + requisition->height = textbox->height*(1+priv->double_size); +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_size_allocate(GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation) { + g_mutex_lock(mutex); + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX (widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + widget->allocation = *allocation; + widget->allocation.x *= (1+priv->double_size); + widget->allocation.y *= (1+priv->double_size); + if (GTK_WIDGET_REALIZED (widget)) + gdk_window_move_resize(widget->window, widget->allocation.x, widget->allocation.y, allocation->width, allocation->height); + + textbox->x = widget->allocation.x/(priv->double_size ? 2 : 1); + textbox->y = widget->allocation.y/(priv->double_size ? 2 : 1); + priv->move_x = 0; + priv->move_y = 0; + + if (textbox->width != widget->allocation.width/(priv->double_size ? 2 : 1)) { + textbox->width = widget->allocation.width/(priv->double_size ? 2 : 1); + priv->resize_width = 0; + priv->resize_height = 0; + if (priv->pixmap_text) g_free(priv->pixmap_text); + priv->pixmap_text = NULL; + priv->offset = 0; + gtk_widget_queue_draw(GTK_WIDGET(textbox)); + } + g_mutex_unlock(mutex); +} + +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_expose(GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventExpose *event) { + g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE); + g_return_val_if_fail (UI_SKINNED_IS_TEXTBOX (widget), FALSE); + g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE); + + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX (widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + GdkPixmap *obj = NULL; + GdkGC *gc; + gint cw; + + if (textbox->text && (!priv->pixmap_text || strcmp(textbox->text, priv->pixmap_text))) + textbox_generate_pixmap(textbox); + + if (priv->pixmap) { + if (skin_get_id() != priv->skin_id) { + priv->skin_id = skin_get_id(); + textbox_generate_pixmap(textbox); + } + obj = gdk_pixmap_new(NULL, textbox->width, textbox->height, gdk_rgb_get_visual()->depth); + gc = gdk_gc_new(obj); + + if (cfg.twoway_scroll) { // twoway scroll + cw = priv->pixmap_width - priv->offset; + if (cw > textbox->width) + cw = textbox->width; + gdk_draw_drawable(obj, gc, priv->pixmap, priv->offset, 0, 0, 0, cw, textbox->height); + if (cw < textbox->width) + gdk_draw_drawable(obj, gc, priv->pixmap, 0, 0, + textbox->x + cw, textbox->y, + textbox->width - cw, textbox->height); + } else { // oneway scroll + int cw1, cw2; + + if (priv->offset >= priv->pixmap_width) + priv->offset = 0; + + if (priv->pixmap_width - priv->offset > textbox->width) { // case1 + cw1 = textbox->width; + gdk_draw_drawable(obj, gc, priv->pixmap, priv->offset, 0, + 0, 0, cw1, textbox->height); + } else { // case 2 + cw1 = priv->pixmap_width - priv->offset; + gdk_draw_drawable(obj, gc, priv->pixmap, priv->offset, 0, + 0, 0, cw1, textbox->height); + cw2 = textbox->width - cw1; + gdk_draw_drawable(obj, gc, priv->pixmap, 0, 0, cw1, 0, cw2, textbox->height); + } + + } + + GdkPixmap *image; + image = gdk_pixmap_new(NULL, textbox->width*(1+priv->double_size), + textbox->height*(1+priv->double_size), + gdk_rgb_get_visual()->depth); + + if (priv->double_size) { + GdkImage *img, *img2x; + img = gdk_drawable_get_image(obj, 0, 0, textbox->width, textbox->height); + img2x = create_dblsize_image(img); + gdk_draw_image (image, gc, img2x, 0, 0, 0, 0, textbox->width*2, textbox->height*2); + g_object_unref(img2x); + g_object_unref(img); + } else + gdk_draw_drawable (image, gc, obj, 0, 0, 0, 0, textbox->width, textbox->height); + + + g_object_unref(obj); + + gdk_draw_drawable (widget->window, gc, image, 0, 0, 0, 0, + textbox->width*(1+priv->double_size), textbox->height*(1+priv->double_size)); + g_object_unref(gc); + g_object_unref(image); + } + + return FALSE; +} + +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_button_press(GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event) { + g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE); + g_return_val_if_fail (UI_SKINNED_IS_TEXTBOX (widget), FALSE); + g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE); + + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX (widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + if (event->type == GDK_BUTTON_PRESS) { + textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX(widget); + if (event->button == 1) { + if (priv->scroll_allowed) { + if ((priv->pixmap_width > textbox->width) && priv->is_scrollable) { + priv->is_dragging = TRUE; + priv->drag_off = priv->offset; + priv->drag_x = event->x; + } + } else + g_signal_emit(widget, textbox_signals[CLICKED], 0); + + } else + priv->is_dragging = FALSE; + } else if (event->type == GDK_2BUTTON_PRESS) { + if (event->button == 1) { + g_signal_emit(widget, textbox_signals[DOUBLE_CLICKED], 0); + } + } + + return TRUE; +} + +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_button_release(GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventButton *event) { + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(widget); + + if (event->button == 1) { + priv->is_dragging = FALSE; + } else if (event->button == 3) { + g_signal_emit(widget, textbox_signals[RIGHT_CLICKED], 0); + } + + return TRUE; +} + +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_motion_notify(GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventMotion *event) { + g_return_val_if_fail (widget != NULL, FALSE); + g_return_val_if_fail (UI_SKINNED_IS_TEXTBOX (widget), FALSE); + g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, FALSE); + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX(widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(widget); + + if (priv->is_dragging) { + if (priv->scroll_allowed && + priv->pixmap_width > textbox->width) { + priv->offset = priv->drag_off - (event->x - priv->drag_x); + + while (priv->offset < 0) + priv->offset = 0; + + while (priv->offset > (priv->pixmap_width - textbox->width)) + priv->offset = (priv->pixmap_width - textbox->width); + + gtk_widget_queue_draw(widget); + } + } + + return TRUE; +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_toggle_doublesize(UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox) { + GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (textbox); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + priv->double_size = !priv->double_size; + + gtk_widget_set_size_request(widget, textbox->width*(1+priv->double_size), textbox->height*(1+priv->double_size)); + + gtk_widget_queue_draw(GTK_WIDGET(textbox)); +} + +static void ui_skinned_textbox_redraw(UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox) { + g_mutex_lock(mutex); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + if (priv->resize_width || priv->resize_height) + gtk_widget_set_size_request(GTK_WIDGET(textbox), + (textbox->width+priv->resize_width)*(1+priv->double_size), + (textbox->height+priv->resize_height)*(1+priv->double_size)); + if (priv->move_x || priv->move_y) + gtk_fixed_move(GTK_FIXED(priv->fixed), GTK_WIDGET(textbox), textbox->x+priv->move_x, textbox->y+priv->move_y); + + gtk_widget_queue_draw(GTK_WIDGET(textbox)); + g_mutex_unlock(mutex); +} + +static gboolean ui_skinned_textbox_should_scroll(UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox) { + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + if (!priv->scroll_allowed) + return FALSE; + + if (priv->font) { + gint width; + text_get_extents(priv->fontname, textbox->text, &width, NULL, NULL, NULL); + + if (width <= textbox->width) + return FALSE; + else + return TRUE; + } + + if (g_utf8_strlen(textbox->text, -1) * bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_width > textbox->width) + return TRUE; + + return FALSE; +} + +void ui_skinned_textbox_set_xfont(GtkWidget *widget, gboolean use_xfont, const gchar * fontname) { + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX (widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + gint ascent, descent; + + g_return_if_fail(textbox != NULL); + + if (priv->font) { + pango_font_description_free(priv->font); + priv->font = NULL; + } + + textbox->y = priv->nominal_y; + textbox->height = priv->nominal_height; + + /* Make sure the pixmap is regenerated */ + if (priv->pixmap_text) { + g_free(priv->pixmap_text); + priv->pixmap_text = NULL; + } + + if (!use_xfont || strlen(fontname) == 0) + return; + + priv->font = pango_font_description_from_string(fontname); + priv->fontname = g_strdup(fontname); + + text_get_extents(fontname, + "AaBbCcDdEeFfGgHhIiJjKkLlMmNnOoPpQqRrSsTtUuVvWwXxYyZz ", + NULL, NULL, &ascent, &descent); + priv->font_ascent = ascent; + priv->font_descent = descent; + + + if (priv->font == NULL) + return; + + textbox->height = priv->font_ascent; + if (textbox->height > priv->nominal_height) + textbox->y -= (textbox->height - priv->nominal_height) / 2; + else + textbox->height = priv->nominal_height; +} + +void ui_skinned_textbox_set_text(GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *text) { + g_return_if_fail(text != NULL); + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX (widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + if (!strcmp(textbox->text, text)) + return; + if (textbox->text) + g_free(textbox->text); + + textbox->text = str_to_utf8(text); + priv->scroll_back = FALSE; + gtk_widget_queue_draw(GTK_WIDGET(textbox)); +} + +static void textbox_generate_xfont_pixmap(UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox, const gchar *pixmaptext) { + gint length, i; + GdkGC *gc, *maskgc; + GdkColor *c, pattern; + GdkBitmap *mask; + PangoLayout *layout; + gint width; + + g_return_if_fail(textbox != NULL); + g_return_if_fail(pixmaptext != NULL); + + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + length = g_utf8_strlen(pixmaptext, -1); + + text_get_extents(priv->fontname, pixmaptext, &width, NULL, NULL, NULL); + + priv->pixmap_width = MAX(width, textbox->width); + priv->pixmap = gdk_pixmap_new(mainwin->window, priv->pixmap_width, + textbox->height, + gdk_rgb_get_visual()->depth); + gc = gdk_gc_new(priv->pixmap); + c = skin_get_color(bmp_active_skin, SKIN_TEXTBG); + for (i = 0; i < textbox->height; i++) { + gdk_gc_set_foreground(gc, &c[6 * i / textbox->height]); + gdk_draw_line(priv->pixmap, gc, 0, i, priv->pixmap_width, i); + } + + mask = gdk_pixmap_new(mainwin->window, priv->pixmap_width, textbox->height, 1); + maskgc = gdk_gc_new(mask); + pattern.pixel = 0; + gdk_gc_set_foreground(maskgc, &pattern); + + gdk_draw_rectangle(mask, maskgc, TRUE, 0, 0, priv->pixmap_width, textbox->height); + pattern.pixel = 1; + gdk_gc_set_foreground(maskgc, &pattern); + + gdk_gc_set_foreground(gc, skin_get_color(bmp_active_skin, SKIN_TEXTFG)); + + layout = gtk_widget_create_pango_layout(mainwin, pixmaptext); + pango_layout_set_font_description(layout, priv->font); + + gdk_draw_layout(priv->pixmap, gc, 0, (priv->font_descent / 2), layout); + g_object_unref(layout); + + g_object_unref(maskgc); + + gdk_gc_set_clip_mask(gc, mask); + c = skin_get_color(bmp_active_skin, SKIN_TEXTFG); + for (i = 0; i < textbox->height; i++) { + gdk_gc_set_foreground(gc, &c[6 * i / textbox->height]); + gdk_draw_line(priv->pixmap, gc, 0, i, priv->pixmap_width, i); + } + g_object_unref(mask); + g_object_unref(gc); +} + +static gboolean textbox_scroll(gpointer data) { + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX(data); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + if (!priv->is_dragging) { + if (priv->scroll_dummy < TEXTBOX_SCROLL_WAIT) + priv->scroll_dummy++; + else { + if(cfg.twoway_scroll) { + if (priv->scroll_back) + priv->offset -= 1; + else + priv->offset += 1; + + if (priv->offset >= (priv->pixmap_width - textbox->width)) { + priv->scroll_back = TRUE; + priv->scroll_dummy = 0; + } + if (priv->offset <= 0) { + priv->scroll_back = FALSE; + priv->scroll_dummy = 0; + } + } + else { // oneway scroll + priv->scroll_back = FALSE; + priv->offset += 1; + } + gtk_widget_queue_draw(GTK_WIDGET(textbox)); + } + } + return TRUE; +} + +static void textbox_generate_pixmap(UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox) { + gint length, i, x, y, wl; + gchar *pixmaptext; + gchar *tmp, *stxt; + GdkGC *gc; + + g_return_if_fail(textbox != NULL); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + if (priv->pixmap) { + g_object_unref(priv->pixmap); + priv->pixmap = NULL; + } + + /* + * Don't reset the offset if only text after the last '(' has + * changed. This is a hack to avoid visual noice on vbr files + * where we guess the length. + */ + if (!(priv->pixmap_text && strrchr(textbox->text, '(') && + !strncmp(priv->pixmap_text, textbox->text, + strrchr(textbox->text, '(') - textbox->text))) + priv->offset = 0; + + g_free(priv->pixmap_text); + priv->pixmap_text = g_strdup(textbox->text); + + /* + * wl is the number of (partial) letters visible. Only makes + * sense when using skinned font. + */ + wl = textbox->width / 5; + if (wl * 5 != textbox->width) + wl++; + + length = g_utf8_strlen(textbox->text, -1); + + priv->is_scrollable = FALSE; + + priv->is_scrollable = ui_skinned_textbox_should_scroll(textbox); + + if (priv->is_scrollable) { + if(!cfg.twoway_scroll) { + pixmaptext = g_strdup_printf("%s *** ", priv->pixmap_text); + length += 5; + } else + pixmaptext = g_strdup(priv->pixmap_text); + } else + if (!priv->font && length <= wl) { + gint pad = wl - length; + gchar *padchars = g_strnfill(pad, ' '); + + pixmaptext = g_strconcat(priv->pixmap_text, padchars, NULL); + g_free(padchars); + length += pad; + } else + pixmaptext = g_strdup(priv->pixmap_text); + + if (priv->is_scrollable) { + if (priv->scroll_enabled && !priv->scroll_timeout) { + gint tag; + tag = TEXTBOX_SCROLL_SMOOTH_TIMEOUT; + priv->scroll_timeout = g_timeout_add(tag, textbox_scroll, textbox); + } + } else { + if (priv->scroll_timeout) { + g_source_remove(priv->scroll_timeout); + priv->scroll_timeout = 0; + } + priv->offset = 0; + } + + if (priv->font) { + textbox_generate_xfont_pixmap(textbox, pixmaptext); + g_free(pixmaptext); + return; + } + + priv->pixmap_width = length * bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_width; + priv->pixmap = gdk_pixmap_new(NULL, + priv->pixmap_width, bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_height, + gdk_rgb_get_visual()->depth); + gc = gdk_gc_new(priv->pixmap); + + for (tmp = stxt = g_utf8_strup(pixmaptext, -1), i = 0; + tmp != NULL && i < length; i++, tmp = g_utf8_next_char(tmp)) { + gchar c = *tmp; + x = y = -1; + if (c >= 'A' && c <= 'Z') { + x = bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_width * (c - 'A'); + y = 0; + } + else if (c >= '0' && c <= '9') { + x = bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_width * (c - '0'); + y = bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_height; + } + else + textbox_handle_special_char(tmp, &x, &y); + + skin_draw_pixmap(bmp_active_skin, + priv->pixmap, gc, priv->skin_index, + x, y, i * bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_width, 0, + bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_width, + bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_height); + } + g_free(stxt); + g_free(pixmaptext); + g_object_unref(gc); +} + +void ui_skinned_textbox_set_scroll(GtkWidget *widget, gboolean scroll) { + g_return_if_fail(widget != NULL); + UiSkinnedTextbox *textbox = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX(widget); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(textbox); + + priv->scroll_enabled = scroll; + if (priv->scroll_enabled && priv->is_scrollable && priv->scroll_allowed) { + gint tag; + tag = TEXTBOX_SCROLL_SMOOTH_TIMEOUT; + if (priv->scroll_timeout) { + g_source_remove(priv->scroll_timeout); + priv->scroll_timeout = 0; + } + priv->scroll_timeout = g_timeout_add(tag, textbox_scroll, textbox); + + } else { + + if (priv->scroll_timeout) { + g_source_remove(priv->scroll_timeout); + priv->scroll_timeout = 0; + } + + priv->offset = 0; + gtk_widget_queue_draw(GTK_WIDGET(textbox)); + } +} + +static void textbox_handle_special_char(gchar *c, gint * x, gint * y) { + gint tx, ty; + + switch (*c) { + case '"': + tx = 26; + ty = 0; + break; + case '\r': + tx = 10; + ty = 1; + break; + case ':': + case ';': + tx = 12; + ty = 1; + break; + case '(': + tx = 13; + ty = 1; + break; + case ')': + tx = 14; + ty = 1; + break; + case '-': + tx = 15; + ty = 1; + break; + case '`': + case '\'': + tx = 16; + ty = 1; + break; + case '!': + tx = 17; + ty = 1; + break; + case '_': + tx = 18; + ty = 1; + break; + case '+': + tx = 19; + ty = 1; + break; + case '\\': + tx = 20; + ty = 1; + break; + case '/': + tx = 21; + ty = 1; + break; + case '[': + tx = 22; + ty = 1; + break; + case ']': + tx = 23; + ty = 1; + break; + case '^': + tx = 24; + ty = 1; + break; + case '&': + tx = 25; + ty = 1; + break; + case '%': + tx = 26; + ty = 1; + break; + case '.': + case ',': + tx = 27; + ty = 1; + break; + case '=': + tx = 28; + ty = 1; + break; + case '$': + tx = 29; + ty = 1; + break; + case '#': + tx = 30; + ty = 1; + break; + case '?': + tx = 3; + ty = 2; + break; + case '*': + tx = 4; + ty = 2; + break; + default: + tx = 29; + ty = 0; + break; + } + + const gchar *change[] = {"Ä„", "A", "Ę", "E", "Ć", "C", "Å", "L", "Ó", "O", "Åš", "S", "Å»", "Z", "Ź", "Z", + "Ãœ", "U", NULL}; + int i; + for (i = 0; change[i]; i+=2) { + if (!strncmp(c, change[i], strlen(change[i]))) { + tx = (*change[i+1] - 'A'); + break; + } + } + + /* those are commonly included into skins */ + if (!strncmp(c, "Ã…", strlen("Ã…"))) { + tx = 0; + ty = 2; + } else if (!strncmp(c, "Ö", strlen("Ö"))) { + tx = 1; + ty = 2; + } else if (!strncmp(c, "Ä", strlen("Ä"))) { + tx = 2; + ty = 2; + } + + *x = tx * bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_width; + *y = ty * bmp_active_skin->properties.textbox_bitmap_font_height; +} + +void ui_skinned_textbox_move_relative(GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y) { + g_mutex_lock(mutex); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(widget); + priv->move_x += x; + priv->move_y += y; + g_mutex_unlock(mutex); +} + +void ui_skinned_textbox_resize_relative(GtkWidget *widget, gint w, gint h) { + g_mutex_lock(mutex); + UiSkinnedTextboxPrivate *priv = UI_SKINNED_TEXTBOX_GET_PRIVATE(widget); + priv->resize_width += w; + priv->resize_height += h; + g_mutex_unlock(mutex); +}
--- a/src/intl/ChangeLog Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,4 +0,0 @@ -2003-05-22 GNU <bug-gnu-gettext@gnu.org> - - * Version 0.12.1 released. -
--- a/src/intl/Makefile Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,46 +0,0 @@ -include ../../mk/rules.mk -include ../../mk/init.mk - -localedir = $(datadir)/locale -gettextsrcdir = $(datadir)/gettext/intl -aliaspath = $(localedir) - -OBJECTIVE_LIBS_NOINST = libintl.a - -DEFS += -DLOCALEDIR=\"$(localedir)\" -DLOCALE_ALIAS_PATH=\"$(aliaspath)\" \ --DLIBDIR=\"$(libdir)\" -DIN_LIBINTL \ --DENABLE_RELOCATABLE=1 -DIN_LIBRARY -DINSTALLDIR=\"$(libdir)\" -DINSTALLPREFIX=\"$(libdir)\" -DNO_XMALLOC \ --Dset_relocation_prefix=libintl_set_relocation_prefix \ --Drelocate=libintl_relocate \ --DDEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV=1 - -CFLAGS += $(PICFLAGS) -I../.. -I. $(DEFS) - -SOURCES = \ - bindtextdom.c \ - dcgettext.c \ - dgettext.c \ - gettext.c \ - finddomain.c \ - loadmsgcat.c \ - localealias.c \ - textdomain.c \ - l10nflist.c \ - explodename.c \ - dcigettext.c \ - dcngettext.c \ - dngettext.c \ - ngettext.c \ - plural.c \ - plural-exp.c \ - localcharset.c \ - relocatable.c \ - localename.c \ - log.c \ - osdep.c \ - os2compat.c \ - intl-compat.c - -OBJECTS = ${SOURCES:.c=.o} - -include ../../mk/objective.mk
--- a/src/intl/VERSION Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,1 +0,0 @@ -GNU gettext library from gettext-0.12.1
--- a/src/intl/bindtextdom.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,374 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of the bindtextdomain(3) function - Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stddef.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif -#include "gettextP.h" - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications. */ -# include <bits/libc-lock.h> -#else -/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */ -# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME) -# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME) -# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME) -#endif - -/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different - names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs - using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */ -#if !defined _LIBC -# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname -# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings -#endif - -/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>. */ -#ifndef offsetof -# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident)) -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs. */ -extern const char _nl_default_dirname[]; -#ifdef _LIBC -extern const char _nl_default_dirname_internal[] attribute_hidden; -#else -# define INTUSE(name) name -#endif - -/* List with bindings of specific domains. */ -extern struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings; - -/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */ -__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden) - - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN __bindtextdomain -# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET __bind_textdomain_codeset -# ifndef strdup -# define strdup(str) __strdup (str) -# endif -#else -# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN libintl_bindtextdomain -# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset -#endif - -/* Prototypes for local functions. */ -static void set_binding_values PARAMS ((const char *domainname, - const char **dirnamep, - const char **codesetp)); - -/* Specifies the directory name *DIRNAMEP and the output codeset *CODESETP - to be used for the DOMAINNAME message catalog. - If *DIRNAMEP or *CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is not - modified, only the current value is returned. - If DIRNAMEP or CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is neither - modified nor returned. */ -static void -set_binding_values (domainname, dirnamep, codesetp) - const char *domainname; - const char **dirnamep; - const char **codesetp; -{ - struct binding *binding; - int modified; - - /* Some sanity checks. */ - if (domainname == NULL || domainname[0] == '\0') - { - if (dirnamep) - *dirnamep = NULL; - if (codesetp) - *codesetp = NULL; - return; - } - - __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock); - - modified = 0; - - for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next) - { - int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname); - if (compare == 0) - /* We found it! */ - break; - if (compare < 0) - { - /* It is not in the list. */ - binding = NULL; - break; - } - } - - if (binding != NULL) - { - if (dirnamep) - { - const char *dirname = *dirnamep; - - if (dirname == NULL) - /* The current binding has be to returned. */ - *dirnamep = binding->dirname; - else - { - /* The domain is already bound. If the new value and the old - one are equal we simply do nothing. Otherwise replace the - old binding. */ - char *result = binding->dirname; - if (strcmp (dirname, result) != 0) - { - if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0) - result = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); - else - { -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP - result = strdup (dirname); -#else - size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1; - result = (char *) malloc (len); - if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) - memcpy (result, dirname, len); -#endif - } - - if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) - { - if (binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) - free (binding->dirname); - - binding->dirname = result; - modified = 1; - } - } - *dirnamep = result; - } - } - - if (codesetp) - { - const char *codeset = *codesetp; - - if (codeset == NULL) - /* The current binding has be to returned. */ - *codesetp = binding->codeset; - else - { - /* The domain is already bound. If the new value and the old - one are equal we simply do nothing. Otherwise replace the - old binding. */ - char *result = binding->codeset; - if (result == NULL || strcmp (codeset, result) != 0) - { -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP - result = strdup (codeset); -#else - size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1; - result = (char *) malloc (len); - if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) - memcpy (result, codeset, len); -#endif - - if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1)) - { - if (binding->codeset != NULL) - free (binding->codeset); - - binding->codeset = result; - binding->codeset_cntr++; - modified = 1; - } - } - *codesetp = result; - } - } - } - else if ((dirnamep == NULL || *dirnamep == NULL) - && (codesetp == NULL || *codesetp == NULL)) - { - /* Simply return the default values. */ - if (dirnamep) - *dirnamep = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); - if (codesetp) - *codesetp = NULL; - } - else - { - /* We have to create a new binding. */ - size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1; - struct binding *new_binding = - (struct binding *) malloc (offsetof (struct binding, domainname) + len); - - if (__builtin_expect (new_binding == NULL, 0)) - goto failed; - - memcpy (new_binding->domainname, domainname, len); - - if (dirnamep) - { - const char *dirname = *dirnamep; - - if (dirname == NULL) - /* The default value. */ - dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); - else - { - if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0) - dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); - else - { - char *result; -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP - result = strdup (dirname); - if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) - goto failed_dirname; -#else - size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1; - result = (char *) malloc (len); - if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) - goto failed_dirname; - memcpy (result, dirname, len); -#endif - dirname = result; - } - } - *dirnamep = dirname; - new_binding->dirname = (char *) dirname; - } - else - /* The default value. */ - new_binding->dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); - - new_binding->codeset_cntr = 0; - - if (codesetp) - { - const char *codeset = *codesetp; - - if (codeset != NULL) - { - char *result; - -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP - result = strdup (codeset); - if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) - goto failed_codeset; -#else - size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1; - result = (char *) malloc (len); - if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0)) - goto failed_codeset; - memcpy (result, codeset, len); -#endif - codeset = result; - new_binding->codeset_cntr++; - } - *codesetp = codeset; - new_binding->codeset = (char *) codeset; - } - else - new_binding->codeset = NULL; - - /* Now enqueue it. */ - if (_nl_domain_bindings == NULL - || strcmp (domainname, _nl_domain_bindings->domainname) < 0) - { - new_binding->next = _nl_domain_bindings; - _nl_domain_bindings = new_binding; - } - else - { - binding = _nl_domain_bindings; - while (binding->next != NULL - && strcmp (domainname, binding->next->domainname) > 0) - binding = binding->next; - - new_binding->next = binding->next; - binding->next = new_binding; - } - - modified = 1; - - /* Here we deal with memory allocation failures. */ - if (0) - { - failed_codeset: - if (new_binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) - free (new_binding->dirname); - failed_dirname: - free (new_binding); - failed: - if (dirnamep) - *dirnamep = NULL; - if (codesetp) - *codesetp = NULL; - } - } - - /* If we modified any binding, we flush the caches. */ - if (modified) - ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr; - - __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); -} - -/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found - in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base. */ -char * -BINDTEXTDOMAIN (domainname, dirname) - const char *domainname; - const char *dirname; -{ - set_binding_values (domainname, &dirname, NULL); - return (char *) dirname; -} - -/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the - DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned. */ -char * -BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET (domainname, codeset) - const char *domainname; - const char *codeset; -{ - set_binding_values (domainname, NULL, &codeset); - return (char *) codeset; -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Aliases for function names in GNU C Library. */ -weak_alias (__bindtextdomain, bindtextdomain); -weak_alias (__bind_textdomain_codeset, bind_textdomain_codeset); -#endif
--- a/src/intl/config.charset Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,467 +0,0 @@ -#! /bin/sh -# Output a system dependent table of character encoding aliases. -# -# Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -# -# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it -# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published -# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) -# any later version. -# -# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, -# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of -# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU -# Library General Public License for more details. -# -# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public -# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software -# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, -# USA. -# -# The table consists of lines of the form -# ALIAS CANONICAL -# -# ALIAS is the (system dependent) result of "nl_langinfo (CODESET)". -# ALIAS is compared in a case sensitive way. -# -# CANONICAL is the GNU canonical name for this character encoding. -# It must be an encoding supported by libiconv. Support by GNU libc is -# also desirable. CANONICAL is case insensitive. Usually an upper case -# MIME charset name is preferred. -# The current list of GNU canonical charset names is as follows. -# -# name used by which systems a MIME name? -# ASCII, ANSI_X3.4-1968 glibc solaris freebsd -# ISO-8859-1 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes -# ISO-8859-2 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes -# ISO-8859-3 glibc solaris yes -# ISO-8859-4 osf solaris freebsd yes -# ISO-8859-5 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes -# ISO-8859-6 glibc aix hpux solaris yes -# ISO-8859-7 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris yes -# ISO-8859-8 glibc aix hpux osf solaris yes -# ISO-8859-9 glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris yes -# ISO-8859-13 glibc -# ISO-8859-14 glibc -# ISO-8859-15 glibc aix osf solaris freebsd -# KOI8-R glibc solaris freebsd yes -# KOI8-U glibc freebsd yes -# KOI8-T glibc -# CP437 dos -# CP775 dos -# CP850 aix osf dos -# CP852 dos -# CP855 dos -# CP856 aix -# CP857 dos -# CP861 dos -# CP862 dos -# CP864 dos -# CP865 dos -# CP866 freebsd dos -# CP869 dos -# CP874 woe32 dos -# CP922 aix -# CP932 aix woe32 dos -# CP943 aix -# CP949 osf woe32 dos -# CP950 woe32 dos -# CP1046 aix -# CP1124 aix -# CP1125 dos -# CP1129 aix -# CP1250 woe32 -# CP1251 glibc solaris woe32 -# CP1252 aix woe32 -# CP1253 woe32 -# CP1254 woe32 -# CP1255 glibc woe32 -# CP1256 woe32 -# CP1257 woe32 -# GB2312 glibc aix hpux irix solaris freebsd yes -# EUC-JP glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes -# EUC-KR glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd yes -# EUC-TW glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris -# BIG5 glibc aix hpux osf solaris freebsd yes -# BIG5-HKSCS glibc solaris -# GBK glibc aix osf solaris woe32 dos -# GB18030 glibc solaris -# SHIFT_JIS hpux osf solaris freebsd yes -# JOHAB glibc solaris woe32 -# TIS-620 glibc aix hpux osf solaris -# VISCII glibc yes -# TCVN5712-1 glibc -# GEORGIAN-PS glibc -# HP-ROMAN8 hpux -# HP-ARABIC8 hpux -# HP-GREEK8 hpux -# HP-HEBREW8 hpux -# HP-TURKISH8 hpux -# HP-KANA8 hpux -# DEC-KANJI osf -# DEC-HANYU osf -# UTF-8 glibc aix hpux osf solaris yes -# -# Note: Names which are not marked as being a MIME name should not be used in -# Internet protocols for information interchange (mail, news, etc.). -# -# Note: ASCII and ANSI_X3.4-1968 are synonymous canonical names. Applications -# must understand both names and treat them as equivalent. -# -# The first argument passed to this file is the canonical host specification, -# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM -# or -# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM - -host="$1" -os=`echo "$host" | sed -e 's/^[^-]*-[^-]*-\(.*\)$/\1/'` -echo "# This file contains a table of character encoding aliases," -echo "# suitable for operating system '${os}'." -echo "# It was automatically generated from config.charset." -# List of references, updated during installation: -echo "# Packages using this file: " -case "$os" in - linux* | *-gnu*) - # With glibc-2.1 or newer, we don't need any canonicalization, - # because glibc has iconv and both glibc and libiconv support all - # GNU canonical names directly. Therefore, the Makefile does not - # need to install the alias file at all. - # The following applies only to glibc-2.0.x and older libcs. - echo "ISO_646.IRV:1983 ASCII" - ;; - aix*) - echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" - echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" - echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" - echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6" - echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" - echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8" - echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" - echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" - echo "IBM-850 CP850" - echo "IBM-856 CP856" - echo "IBM-921 ISO-8859-13" - echo "IBM-922 CP922" - echo "IBM-932 CP932" - echo "IBM-943 CP943" - echo "IBM-1046 CP1046" - echo "IBM-1124 CP1124" - echo "IBM-1129 CP1129" - echo "IBM-1252 CP1252" - echo "IBM-eucCN GB2312" - echo "IBM-eucJP EUC-JP" - echo "IBM-eucKR EUC-KR" - echo "IBM-eucTW EUC-TW" - echo "big5 BIG5" - echo "GBK GBK" - echo "TIS-620 TIS-620" - echo "UTF-8 UTF-8" - ;; - hpux*) - echo "iso88591 ISO-8859-1" - echo "iso88592 ISO-8859-2" - echo "iso88595 ISO-8859-5" - echo "iso88596 ISO-8859-6" - echo "iso88597 ISO-8859-7" - echo "iso88598 ISO-8859-8" - echo "iso88599 ISO-8859-9" - echo "iso885915 ISO-8859-15" - echo "roman8 HP-ROMAN8" - echo "arabic8 HP-ARABIC8" - echo "greek8 HP-GREEK8" - echo "hebrew8 HP-HEBREW8" - echo "turkish8 HP-TURKISH8" - echo "kana8 HP-KANA8" - echo "tis620 TIS-620" - echo "big5 BIG5" - echo "eucJP EUC-JP" - echo "eucKR EUC-KR" - echo "eucTW EUC-TW" - echo "hp15CN GB2312" - #echo "ccdc ?" # what is this? - echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS" - echo "utf8 UTF-8" - ;; - irix*) - echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" - echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" - echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" - echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" - echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" - echo "eucCN GB2312" - echo "eucJP EUC-JP" - echo "eucKR EUC-KR" - echo "eucTW EUC-TW" - ;; - osf*) - echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" - echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" - echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4" - echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" - echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" - echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8" - echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" - echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" - echo "cp850 CP850" - echo "big5 BIG5" - echo "dechanyu DEC-HANYU" - echo "dechanzi GB2312" - echo "deckanji DEC-KANJI" - echo "deckorean EUC-KR" - echo "eucJP EUC-JP" - echo "eucKR EUC-KR" - echo "eucTW EUC-TW" - echo "GBK GBK" - echo "KSC5601 CP949" - echo "sdeckanji EUC-JP" - echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS" - echo "TACTIS TIS-620" - echo "UTF-8 UTF-8" - ;; - solaris*) - echo "646 ASCII" - echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" - echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" - echo "ISO8859-3 ISO-8859-3" - echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4" - echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" - echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6" - echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7" - echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8" - echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9" - echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" - echo "koi8-r KOI8-R" - echo "ansi-1251 CP1251" - echo "BIG5 BIG5" - echo "Big5-HKSCS BIG5-HKSCS" - echo "gb2312 GB2312" - echo "GBK GBK" - echo "GB18030 GB18030" - echo "cns11643 EUC-TW" - echo "5601 EUC-KR" - echo "ko_KR.johap92 JOHAB" - echo "eucJP EUC-JP" - echo "PCK SHIFT_JIS" - echo "TIS620.2533 TIS-620" - #echo "sun_eu_greek ?" # what is this? - echo "UTF-8 UTF-8" - ;; - freebsd* | os2*) - # FreeBSD 4.2 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore - # localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name - # from the environment variables. - # Likewise for OS/2. OS/2 has XFree86 just like FreeBSD. Just - # reuse FreeBSD's locale data for OS/2. - echo "C ASCII" - echo "US-ASCII ASCII" - for l in la_LN lt_LN; do - echo "$l.ASCII ASCII" - done - for l in da_DK de_AT de_CH de_DE en_AU en_CA en_GB en_US es_ES \ - fi_FI fr_BE fr_CA fr_CH fr_FR is_IS it_CH it_IT la_LN \ - lt_LN nl_BE nl_NL no_NO pt_PT sv_SE; do - echo "$l.ISO_8859-1 ISO-8859-1" - echo "$l.DIS_8859-15 ISO-8859-15" - done - for l in cs_CZ hr_HR hu_HU la_LN lt_LN pl_PL sl_SI; do - echo "$l.ISO_8859-2 ISO-8859-2" - done - for l in la_LN lt_LT; do - echo "$l.ISO_8859-4 ISO-8859-4" - done - for l in ru_RU ru_SU; do - echo "$l.KOI8-R KOI8-R" - echo "$l.ISO_8859-5 ISO-8859-5" - echo "$l.CP866 CP866" - done - echo "uk_UA.KOI8-U KOI8-U" - echo "zh_TW.BIG5 BIG5" - echo "zh_TW.Big5 BIG5" - echo "zh_CN.EUC GB2312" - echo "ja_JP.EUC EUC-JP" - echo "ja_JP.SJIS SHIFT_JIS" - echo "ja_JP.Shift_JIS SHIFT_JIS" - echo "ko_KR.EUC EUC-KR" - ;; - netbsd*) - echo "646 ASCII" - echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1" - echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2" - echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4" - echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5" - echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15" - echo "eucCN GB2312" - echo "eucJP EUC-JP" - echo "eucKR EUC-KR" - echo "eucTW EUC-TW" - echo "BIG5 BIG5" - echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS" - ;; - beos*) - # BeOS has a single locale, and it has UTF-8 encoding. - echo "* UTF-8" - ;; - msdosdjgpp*) - # DJGPP 2.03 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore - # localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name - # from the environment variables. - echo "#" - echo "# The encodings given here may not all be correct." - echo "# If you find that the encoding given for your language and" - echo "# country is not the one your DOS machine actually uses, just" - echo "# correct it in this file, and send a mail to" - echo "# Juan Manuel Guerrero <st001906@hrz1.hrz.tu-darmstadt.de>" - echo "# and Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>." - echo "#" - echo "C ASCII" - # ISO-8859-1 languages - echo "ca CP850" - echo "ca_ES CP850" - echo "da CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "da_DK CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "de CP850" - echo "de_AT CP850" - echo "de_CH CP850" - echo "de_DE CP850" - echo "en CP850" - echo "en_AU CP850" # not CP437 ?? - echo "en_CA CP850" - echo "en_GB CP850" - echo "en_NZ CP437" - echo "en_US CP437" - echo "en_ZA CP850" # not CP437 ?? - echo "es CP850" - echo "es_AR CP850" - echo "es_BO CP850" - echo "es_CL CP850" - echo "es_CO CP850" - echo "es_CR CP850" - echo "es_CU CP850" - echo "es_DO CP850" - echo "es_EC CP850" - echo "es_ES CP850" - echo "es_GT CP850" - echo "es_HN CP850" - echo "es_MX CP850" - echo "es_NI CP850" - echo "es_PA CP850" - echo "es_PY CP850" - echo "es_PE CP850" - echo "es_SV CP850" - echo "es_UY CP850" - echo "es_VE CP850" - echo "et CP850" - echo "et_EE CP850" - echo "eu CP850" - echo "eu_ES CP850" - echo "fi CP850" - echo "fi_FI CP850" - echo "fr CP850" - echo "fr_BE CP850" - echo "fr_CA CP850" - echo "fr_CH CP850" - echo "fr_FR CP850" - echo "ga CP850" - echo "ga_IE CP850" - echo "gd CP850" - echo "gd_GB CP850" - echo "gl CP850" - echo "gl_ES CP850" - echo "id CP850" # not CP437 ?? - echo "id_ID CP850" # not CP437 ?? - echo "is CP861" # not CP850 ?? - echo "is_IS CP861" # not CP850 ?? - echo "it CP850" - echo "it_CH CP850" - echo "it_IT CP850" - echo "lt CP775" - echo "lt_LT CP775" - echo "lv CP775" - echo "lv_LV CP775" - echo "nb CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "nb_NO CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "nl CP850" - echo "nl_BE CP850" - echo "nl_NL CP850" - echo "nn CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "nn_NO CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "no CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "no_NO CP865" # not CP850 ?? - echo "pt CP850" - echo "pt_BR CP850" - echo "pt_PT CP850" - echo "sv CP850" - echo "sv_SE CP850" - # ISO-8859-2 languages - echo "cs CP852" - echo "cs_CZ CP852" - echo "hr CP852" - echo "hr_HR CP852" - echo "hu CP852" - echo "hu_HU CP852" - echo "pl CP852" - echo "pl_PL CP852" - echo "ro CP852" - echo "ro_RO CP852" - echo "sk CP852" - echo "sk_SK CP852" - echo "sl CP852" - echo "sl_SI CP852" - echo "sq CP852" - echo "sq_AL CP852" - echo "sr CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ?? - echo "sr_YU CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ?? - # ISO-8859-3 languages - echo "mt CP850" - echo "mt_MT CP850" - # ISO-8859-5 languages - echo "be CP866" - echo "be_BE CP866" - echo "bg CP866" # not CP855 ?? - echo "bg_BG CP866" # not CP855 ?? - echo "mk CP866" # not CP855 ?? - echo "mk_MK CP866" # not CP855 ?? - echo "ru CP866" - echo "ru_RU CP866" - echo "uk CP1125" - echo "uk_UA CP1125" - # ISO-8859-6 languages - echo "ar CP864" - echo "ar_AE CP864" - echo "ar_DZ CP864" - echo "ar_EG CP864" - echo "ar_IQ CP864" - echo "ar_IR CP864" - echo "ar_JO CP864" - echo "ar_KW CP864" - echo "ar_MA CP864" - echo "ar_OM CP864" - echo "ar_QA CP864" - echo "ar_SA CP864" - echo "ar_SY CP864" - # ISO-8859-7 languages - echo "el CP869" - echo "el_GR CP869" - # ISO-8859-8 languages - echo "he CP862" - echo "he_IL CP862" - # ISO-8859-9 languages - echo "tr CP857" - echo "tr_TR CP857" - # Japanese - echo "ja CP932" - echo "ja_JP CP932" - # Chinese - echo "zh_CN GBK" - echo "zh_TW CP950" # not CP938 ?? - # Korean - echo "kr CP949" # not CP934 ?? - echo "kr_KR CP949" # not CP934 ?? - # Thai - echo "th CP874" - echo "th_TH CP874" - # Other - echo "eo CP850" - echo "eo_EO CP850" - ;; -esac
--- a/src/intl/dcgettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,59 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of the dcgettext(3) function. - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include "gettextP.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define DCGETTEXT __dcgettext -# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext -#else -# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext -# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY - locale. */ -char * -DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, category) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid; - int category; -{ - return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, NULL, 0, 0, category); -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ -INTDEF(__dcgettext) -weak_alias (__dcgettext, dcgettext); -#endif
--- a/src/intl/dcigettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,1238 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of the internal dcigettext function. - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy(). - This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include - <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ -#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE -# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <sys/types.h> - -#ifdef __GNUC__ -# define alloca __builtin_alloca -# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1 -#else -# ifdef _MSC_VER -# include <malloc.h> -# define alloca _alloca -# else -# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC -# include <alloca.h> -# else -# ifdef _AIX - #pragma alloca -# else -# ifndef alloca -char *alloca (); -# endif -# endif -# endif -# endif -#endif - -#include <errno.h> -#ifndef errno -extern int errno; -#endif -#ifndef __set_errno -# define __set_errno(val) errno = (val) -#endif - -#include <stddef.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC -# include <unistd.h> -#endif - -#include <locale.h> - -#ifdef _LIBC - /* Guess whether integer division by zero raises signal SIGFPE. - Set to 1 only if you know for sure. In case of doubt, set to 0. */ -# if defined __alpha__ || defined __arm__ || defined __i386__ \ - || defined __m68k__ || defined __s390__ -# define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 1 -# else -# define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 0 -# endif -#endif -#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE -# include <signal.h> -#endif - -#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H || defined _LIBC -# include <sys/param.h> -#endif - -#include "gettextP.h" -#include "plural-exp.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif -#include "hash-string.h" - -/* Thread safetyness. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <bits/libc-lock.h> -#else -/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */ -# define __libc_lock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME) -# define __libc_lock_lock(NAME) -# define __libc_lock_unlock(NAME) -# define __libc_rwlock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME) -# define __libc_rwlock_rdlock(NAME) -# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME) -#endif - -/* Alignment of types. */ -#if defined __GNUC__ && __GNUC__ >= 2 -# define alignof(TYPE) __alignof__ (TYPE) -#else -# define alignof(TYPE) \ - ((int) &((struct { char dummy1; TYPE dummy2; } *) 0)->dummy2) -#endif - -/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different - names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs - using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */ -#if !defined _LIBC -# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain -# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain -# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname -# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings -#endif - -/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>. */ -#ifndef offsetof -# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident)) -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard - because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object - file and the name space must not be polluted. */ -# define getcwd __getcwd -# ifndef stpcpy -# define stpcpy __stpcpy -# endif -# define tfind __tfind -#else -# if !defined HAVE_GETCWD -char *getwd (); -# define getcwd(buf, max) getwd (buf) -# else -char *getcwd (); -# endif -# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY -static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src)); -# endif -# ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY -static void *mempcpy PARAMS ((void *dest, const void *src, size_t n)); -# endif -#endif - -/* Amount to increase buffer size by in each try. */ -#define PATH_INCR 32 - -/* The following is from pathmax.h. */ -/* Non-POSIX BSD systems might have gcc's limits.h, which doesn't define - PATH_MAX but might cause redefinition warnings when sys/param.h is - later included (as on MORE/BSD 4.3). */ -#if defined _POSIX_VERSION || (defined HAVE_LIMITS_H && !defined __GNUC__) -# include <limits.h> -#endif - -#ifndef _POSIX_PATH_MAX -# define _POSIX_PATH_MAX 255 -#endif - -#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined _PC_PATH_MAX -# define PATH_MAX (pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX) < 1 ? 1024 : pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX)) -#endif - -/* Don't include sys/param.h if it already has been. */ -#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H && !defined PATH_MAX && !defined MAXPATHLEN -# include <sys/param.h> -#endif - -#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined MAXPATHLEN -# define PATH_MAX MAXPATHLEN -#endif - -#ifndef PATH_MAX -# define PATH_MAX _POSIX_PATH_MAX -#endif - -/* Pathname support. - ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character. - IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) tests whether P is an absolute path. If it is not, - it may be concatenated to a directory pathname. - IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) tests whether P contains a directory specification. - */ -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ - /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') -# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \ - ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \ - && (P)[1] == ':') -# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P)) -# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \ - (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P)) -#else - /* Unix */ -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/') -# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0]) -# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL) -#endif - -/* This is the type used for the search tree where known translations - are stored. */ -struct known_translation_t -{ - /* Domain in which to search. */ - char *domainname; - - /* The category. */ - int category; - - /* State of the catalog counter at the point the string was found. */ - int counter; - - /* Catalog where the string was found. */ - struct loaded_l10nfile *domain; - - /* And finally the translation. */ - const char *translation; - size_t translation_length; - - /* Pointer to the string in question. */ - char msgid[ZERO]; -}; - -/* Root of the search tree with known translations. We can use this - only if the system provides the `tsearch' function family. */ -#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC -# include <search.h> - -static void *root; - -# ifdef _LIBC -# define tsearch __tsearch -# endif - -/* Function to compare two entries in the table of known translations. */ -static int transcmp PARAMS ((const void *p1, const void *p2)); -static int -transcmp (p1, p2) - const void *p1; - const void *p2; -{ - const struct known_translation_t *s1; - const struct known_translation_t *s2; - int result; - - s1 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p1; - s2 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p2; - - result = strcmp (s1->msgid, s2->msgid); - if (result == 0) - { - result = strcmp (s1->domainname, s2->domainname); - if (result == 0) - /* We compare the category last (though this is the cheapest - operation) since it is hopefully always the same (namely - LC_MESSAGES). */ - result = s1->category - s2->category; - } - - return result; -} -#endif - -#ifndef INTVARDEF -# define INTVARDEF(name) -#endif -#ifndef INTUSE -# define INTUSE(name) name -#endif - -/* Name of the default domain used for gettext(3) prior any call to - textdomain(3). The default value for this is "messages". */ -const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden = "messages"; - -/* Value used as the default domain for gettext(3). */ -const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden - = _nl_default_default_domain; - -/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs. */ -#if defined __EMX__ -extern const char _nl_default_dirname[]; -#else -const char _nl_default_dirname[] = LOCALEDIR; -INTVARDEF (_nl_default_dirname) -#endif - -/* List with bindings of specific domains created by bindtextdomain() - calls. */ -struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings; - -/* Prototypes for local functions. */ -static char *plural_lookup PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *domain, - unsigned long int n, - const char *translation, - size_t translation_len)) - internal_function; -static const char *guess_category_value PARAMS ((int category, - const char *categoryname)) - internal_function; -#ifdef _LIBC -# include "../locale/localeinfo.h" -# define category_to_name(category) _nl_category_names[category] -#else -static const char *category_to_name PARAMS ((int category)) internal_function; -#endif - - -/* For those loosing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add - some additional code emulating it. */ -#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA -/* Nothing has to be done. */ -# define freea(p) /* nothing */ -# define ADD_BLOCK(list, address) /* nothing */ -# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) /* nothing */ -#else -struct block_list -{ - void *address; - struct block_list *next; -}; -# define ADD_BLOCK(list, addr) \ - do { \ - struct block_list *newp = (struct block_list *) malloc (sizeof (*newp)); \ - /* If we cannot get a free block we cannot add the new element to \ - the list. */ \ - if (newp != NULL) { \ - newp->address = (addr); \ - newp->next = (list); \ - (list) = newp; \ - } \ - } while (0) -# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) \ - do { \ - while (list != NULL) { \ - struct block_list *old = list; \ - list = list->next; \ - free (old->address); \ - free (old); \ - } \ - } while (0) -# undef alloca -# define alloca(size) (malloc (size)) -# define freea(p) free (p) -#endif /* have alloca */ - - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* List of blocks allocated for translations. */ -typedef struct transmem_list -{ - struct transmem_list *next; - char data[ZERO]; -} transmem_block_t; -static struct transmem_list *transmem_list; -#else -typedef unsigned char transmem_block_t; -#endif - - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext -#else -# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext -#endif - -/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -__libc_rwlock_define_initialized (, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden) -#endif - -/* Checking whether the binaries runs SUID must be done and glibc provides - easier methods therefore we make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define ENABLE_SECURE __libc_enable_secure -# define DETERMINE_SECURE -#else -# ifndef HAVE_GETUID -# define getuid() 0 -# endif -# ifndef HAVE_GETGID -# define getgid() 0 -# endif -# ifndef HAVE_GETEUID -# define geteuid() getuid() -# endif -# ifndef HAVE_GETEGID -# define getegid() getgid() -# endif -static int enable_secure; -# define ENABLE_SECURE (enable_secure == 1) -# define DETERMINE_SECURE \ - if (enable_secure == 0) \ - { \ - if (getuid () != geteuid () || getgid () != getegid ()) \ - enable_secure = 1; \ - else \ - enable_secure = -1; \ - } -#endif - -/* Get the function to evaluate the plural expression. */ -#include "eval-plural.h" - -/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current - CATEGORY locale and, if PLURAL is nonzero, search over string - depending on the plural form determined by N. */ -char * -DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural, n, category) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - int plural; - unsigned long int n; - int category; -{ -#ifndef HAVE_ALLOCA - struct block_list *block_list = NULL; -#endif - struct loaded_l10nfile *domain; - struct binding *binding; - const char *categoryname; - const char *categoryvalue; - char *dirname, *xdomainname; - char *single_locale; - char *retval; - size_t retlen; - int saved_errno; -#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC - struct known_translation_t *search; - struct known_translation_t **foundp = NULL; - size_t msgid_len; -#endif - size_t domainname_len; - - /* If no real MSGID is given return NULL. */ - if (msgid1 == NULL) - return NULL; - -#ifdef _LIBC - if (category < 0 || category >= __LC_LAST || category == LC_ALL) - /* Bogus. */ - return (plural == 0 - ? (char *) msgid1 - /* Use the Germanic plural rule. */ - : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2); -#endif - - __libc_rwlock_rdlock (_nl_state_lock); - - /* If DOMAINNAME is NULL, we are interested in the default domain. If - CATEGORY is not LC_MESSAGES this might not make much sense but the - definition left this undefined. */ - if (domainname == NULL) - domainname = _nl_current_default_domain; - - /* OS/2 specific: backward compatibility with older libintl versions */ -#ifdef LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT - if (category == LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT) - category = LC_MESSAGES; -#endif - -#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC - msgid_len = strlen (msgid1) + 1; - - /* Try to find the translation among those which we found at - some time. */ - search = (struct known_translation_t *) - alloca (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid) + msgid_len); - memcpy (search->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len); - search->domainname = (char *) domainname; - search->category = category; - - foundp = (struct known_translation_t **) tfind (search, &root, transcmp); - freea (search); - if (foundp != NULL && (*foundp)->counter == _nl_msg_cat_cntr) - { - /* Now deal with plural. */ - if (plural) - retval = plural_lookup ((*foundp)->domain, n, (*foundp)->translation, - (*foundp)->translation_length); - else - retval = (char *) (*foundp)->translation; - - __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); - return retval; - } -#endif - - /* Preserve the `errno' value. */ - saved_errno = errno; - - /* See whether this is a SUID binary or not. */ - DETERMINE_SECURE; - - /* First find matching binding. */ - for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next) - { - int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname); - if (compare == 0) - /* We found it! */ - break; - if (compare < 0) - { - /* It is not in the list. */ - binding = NULL; - break; - } - } - - if (binding == NULL) - dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname); - else if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (binding->dirname)) - dirname = binding->dirname; - else - { - /* We have a relative path. Make it absolute now. */ - size_t dirname_len = strlen (binding->dirname) + 1; - size_t path_max; - char *ret; - - path_max = (unsigned int) PATH_MAX; - path_max += 2; /* The getcwd docs say to do this. */ - - for (;;) - { - dirname = (char *) alloca (path_max + dirname_len); - ADD_BLOCK (block_list, dirname); - - __set_errno (0); - ret = getcwd (dirname, path_max); - if (ret != NULL || errno != ERANGE) - break; - - path_max += path_max / 2; - path_max += PATH_INCR; - } - - if (ret == NULL) - /* We cannot get the current working directory. Don't signal an - error but simply return the default string. */ - goto return_untranslated; - - stpcpy (stpcpy (strchr (dirname, '\0'), "/"), binding->dirname); - } - - /* Now determine the symbolic name of CATEGORY and its value. */ - categoryname = category_to_name (category); - categoryvalue = guess_category_value (category, categoryname); - - domainname_len = strlen (domainname); - xdomainname = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryname) - + domainname_len + 5); - ADD_BLOCK (block_list, xdomainname); - - stpcpy (mempcpy (stpcpy (stpcpy (xdomainname, categoryname), "/"), - domainname, domainname_len), - ".mo"); - - /* Creating working area. */ - single_locale = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryvalue) + 1); - ADD_BLOCK (block_list, single_locale); - - - /* Search for the given string. This is a loop because we perhaps - got an ordered list of languages to consider for the translation. */ - while (1) - { - /* Make CATEGORYVALUE point to the next element of the list. */ - while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] == ':') - ++categoryvalue; - if (categoryvalue[0] == '\0') - { - /* The whole contents of CATEGORYVALUE has been searched but - no valid entry has been found. We solve this situation - by implicitly appending a "C" entry, i.e. no translation - will take place. */ - single_locale[0] = 'C'; - single_locale[1] = '\0'; - } - else - { - char *cp = single_locale; - while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] != ':') - *cp++ = *categoryvalue++; - *cp = '\0'; - - /* When this is a SUID binary we must not allow accessing files - outside the dedicated directories. */ - if (ENABLE_SECURE && IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (single_locale)) - /* Ingore this entry. */ - continue; - } - - /* If the current locale value is C (or POSIX) we don't load a - domain. Return the MSGID. */ - if (strcmp (single_locale, "C") == 0 - || strcmp (single_locale, "POSIX") == 0) - break; - - /* Find structure describing the message catalog matching the - DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY. */ - domain = _nl_find_domain (dirname, single_locale, xdomainname, binding); - - if (domain != NULL) - { - retval = _nl_find_msg (domain, binding, msgid1, &retlen); - - if (retval == NULL) - { - int cnt; - - for (cnt = 0; domain->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt) - { - retval = _nl_find_msg (domain->successor[cnt], binding, - msgid1, &retlen); - - if (retval != NULL) - { - domain = domain->successor[cnt]; - break; - } - } - } - - if (retval != NULL) - { - /* Found the translation of MSGID1 in domain DOMAIN: - starting at RETVAL, RETLEN bytes. */ - FREE_BLOCKS (block_list); -#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC - if (foundp == NULL) - { - /* Create a new entry and add it to the search tree. */ - struct known_translation_t *newp; - - newp = (struct known_translation_t *) - malloc (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid) - + msgid_len + domainname_len + 1); - if (newp != NULL) - { - newp->domainname = - mempcpy (newp->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len); - memcpy (newp->domainname, domainname, domainname_len + 1); - newp->category = category; - newp->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr; - newp->domain = domain; - newp->translation = retval; - newp->translation_length = retlen; - - /* Insert the entry in the search tree. */ - foundp = (struct known_translation_t **) - tsearch (newp, &root, transcmp); - if (foundp == NULL - || __builtin_expect (*foundp != newp, 0)) - /* The insert failed. */ - free (newp); - } - } - else - { - /* We can update the existing entry. */ - (*foundp)->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr; - (*foundp)->domain = domain; - (*foundp)->translation = retval; - (*foundp)->translation_length = retlen; - } -#endif - __set_errno (saved_errno); - - /* Now deal with plural. */ - if (plural) - retval = plural_lookup (domain, n, retval, retlen); - - __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); - return retval; - } - } - } - - return_untranslated: - /* Return the untranslated MSGID. */ - FREE_BLOCKS (block_list); - __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); -#ifndef _LIBC - if (!ENABLE_SECURE) - { - extern void _nl_log_untranslated PARAMS ((const char *logfilename, - const char *domainname, - const char *msgid1, - const char *msgid2, - int plural)); - const char *logfilename = getenv ("GETTEXT_LOG_UNTRANSLATED"); - - if (logfilename != NULL && logfilename[0] != '\0') - _nl_log_untranslated (logfilename, domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural); - } -#endif - __set_errno (saved_errno); - return (plural == 0 - ? (char *) msgid1 - /* Use the Germanic plural rule. */ - : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2); -} - - -char * -internal_function -_nl_find_msg (domain_file, domainbinding, msgid, lengthp) - struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file; - struct binding *domainbinding; - const char *msgid; - size_t *lengthp; -{ - struct loaded_domain *domain; - nls_uint32 nstrings; - size_t act; - char *result; - size_t resultlen; - - if (domain_file->decided == 0) - _nl_load_domain (domain_file, domainbinding); - - if (domain_file->data == NULL) - return NULL; - - domain = (struct loaded_domain *) domain_file->data; - - nstrings = domain->nstrings; - - /* Locate the MSGID and its translation. */ - if (domain->hash_tab != NULL) - { - /* Use the hashing table. */ - nls_uint32 len = strlen (msgid); - nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid); - nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size; - nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2)); - - while (1) - { - nls_uint32 nstr = - W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[idx]); - - if (nstr == 0) - /* Hash table entry is empty. */ - return NULL; - - nstr--; - - /* Compare msgid with the original string at index nstr. - We compare the lengths with >=, not ==, because plural entries - are represented by strings with an embedded NUL. */ - if (nstr < nstrings - ? W (domain->must_swap, domain->orig_tab[nstr].length) >= len - && (strcmp (msgid, - domain->data + W (domain->must_swap, - domain->orig_tab[nstr].offset)) - == 0) - : domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].length > len - && (strcmp (msgid, - domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].pointer) - == 0)) - { - act = nstr; - goto found; - } - - if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr) - idx -= domain->hash_size - incr; - else - idx += incr; - } - /* NOTREACHED */ - } - else - { - /* Try the default method: binary search in the sorted array of - messages. */ - size_t top, bottom; - - bottom = 0; - top = nstrings; - while (bottom < top) - { - int cmp_val; - - act = (bottom + top) / 2; - cmp_val = strcmp (msgid, (domain->data - + W (domain->must_swap, - domain->orig_tab[act].offset))); - if (cmp_val < 0) - top = act; - else if (cmp_val > 0) - bottom = act + 1; - else - goto found; - } - /* No translation was found. */ - return NULL; - } - - found: - /* The translation was found at index ACT. If we have to convert the - string to use a different character set, this is the time. */ - if (act < nstrings) - { - result = (char *) - (domain->data + W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].offset)); - resultlen = W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].length) + 1; - } - else - { - result = (char *) domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].pointer; - resultlen = domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].length; - } - -#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV - if (domain->codeset_cntr - != (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0)) - { - /* The domain's codeset has changed through bind_textdomain_codeset() - since the message catalog was initialized or last accessed. We - have to reinitialize the converter. */ - _nl_free_domain_conv (domain); - _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding); - } - - if ( -# ifdef _LIBC - domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1 -# else -# if HAVE_ICONV - domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1 -# endif -# endif - ) - { - /* We are supposed to do a conversion. First allocate an - appropriate table with the same structure as the table - of translations in the file, where we can put the pointers - to the converted strings in. - There is a slight complication with plural entries. They - are represented by consecutive NUL terminated strings. We - handle this case by converting RESULTLEN bytes, including - NULs. */ - - if (domain->conv_tab == NULL - && ((domain->conv_tab = - (char **) calloc (nstrings + domain->n_sysdep_strings, - sizeof (char *))) - == NULL)) - /* Mark that we didn't succeed allocating a table. */ - domain->conv_tab = (char **) -1; - - if (__builtin_expect (domain->conv_tab == (char **) -1, 0)) - /* Nothing we can do, no more memory. */ - goto converted; - - if (domain->conv_tab[act] == NULL) - { - /* We haven't used this string so far, so it is not - translated yet. Do this now. */ - /* We use a bit more efficient memory handling. - We allocate always larger blocks which get used over - time. This is faster than many small allocations. */ - __libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock) -# define INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE 4080 - static unsigned char *freemem; - static size_t freemem_size; - - const unsigned char *inbuf; - unsigned char *outbuf; - int malloc_count; -# ifndef _LIBC - transmem_block_t *transmem_list = NULL; -# endif - - __libc_lock_lock (lock); - - inbuf = (const unsigned char *) result; - outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t); - - malloc_count = 0; - while (1) - { - transmem_block_t *newmem; -# ifdef _LIBC - size_t non_reversible; - int res; - - if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t)) - goto resize_freemem; - - res = __gconv (domain->conv, - &inbuf, inbuf + resultlen, - &outbuf, - outbuf + freemem_size - sizeof (size_t), - &non_reversible); - - if (res == __GCONV_OK || res == __GCONV_EMPTY_INPUT) - break; - - if (res != __GCONV_FULL_OUTPUT) - { - __libc_lock_unlock (lock); - goto converted; - } - - inbuf = result; -# else -# if HAVE_ICONV - const char *inptr = (const char *) inbuf; - size_t inleft = resultlen; - char *outptr = (char *) outbuf; - size_t outleft; - - if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t)) - goto resize_freemem; - - outleft = freemem_size - sizeof (size_t); - if (iconv (domain->conv, - (ICONV_CONST char **) &inptr, &inleft, - &outptr, &outleft) - != (size_t) (-1)) - { - outbuf = (unsigned char *) outptr; - break; - } - if (errno != E2BIG) - { - __libc_lock_unlock (lock); - goto converted; - } -# endif -# endif - - resize_freemem: - /* We must allocate a new buffer or resize the old one. */ - if (malloc_count > 0) - { - ++malloc_count; - freemem_size = malloc_count * INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE; - newmem = (transmem_block_t *) realloc (transmem_list, - freemem_size); -# ifdef _LIBC - if (newmem != NULL) - transmem_list = transmem_list->next; - else - { - struct transmem_list *old = transmem_list; - - transmem_list = transmem_list->next; - free (old); - } -# endif - } - else - { - malloc_count = 1; - freemem_size = INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE; - newmem = (transmem_block_t *) malloc (freemem_size); - } - if (__builtin_expect (newmem == NULL, 0)) - { - freemem = NULL; - freemem_size = 0; - __libc_lock_unlock (lock); - goto converted; - } - -# ifdef _LIBC - /* Add the block to the list of blocks we have to free - at some point. */ - newmem->next = transmem_list; - transmem_list = newmem; - - freemem = newmem->data; - freemem_size -= offsetof (struct transmem_list, data); -# else - transmem_list = newmem; - freemem = newmem; -# endif - - outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t); - } - - /* We have now in our buffer a converted string. Put this - into the table of conversions. */ - *(size_t *) freemem = outbuf - freemem - sizeof (size_t); - domain->conv_tab[act] = (char *) freemem; - /* Shrink freemem, but keep it aligned. */ - freemem_size -= outbuf - freemem; - freemem = outbuf; - freemem += freemem_size & (alignof (size_t) - 1); - freemem_size = freemem_size & ~ (alignof (size_t) - 1); - - __libc_lock_unlock (lock); - } - - /* Now domain->conv_tab[act] contains the translation of all - the plural variants. */ - result = domain->conv_tab[act] + sizeof (size_t); - resultlen = *(size_t *) domain->conv_tab[act]; - } - - converted: - /* The result string is converted. */ - -#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */ - - *lengthp = resultlen; - return result; -} - - -/* Look up a plural variant. */ -static char * -internal_function -plural_lookup (domain, n, translation, translation_len) - struct loaded_l10nfile *domain; - unsigned long int n; - const char *translation; - size_t translation_len; -{ - struct loaded_domain *domaindata = (struct loaded_domain *) domain->data; - unsigned long int index; - const char *p; - - index = plural_eval (domaindata->plural, n); - if (index >= domaindata->nplurals) - /* This should never happen. It means the plural expression and the - given maximum value do not match. */ - index = 0; - - /* Skip INDEX strings at TRANSLATION. */ - p = translation; - while (index-- > 0) - { -#ifdef _LIBC - p = __rawmemchr (p, '\0'); -#else - p = strchr (p, '\0'); -#endif - /* And skip over the NUL byte. */ - p++; - - if (p >= translation + translation_len) - /* This should never happen. It means the plural expression - evaluated to a value larger than the number of variants - available for MSGID1. */ - return (char *) translation; - } - return (char *) p; -} - -#ifndef _LIBC -/* Return string representation of locale CATEGORY. */ -static const char * -internal_function -category_to_name (category) - int category; -{ - const char *retval; - - switch (category) - { -#ifdef LC_COLLATE - case LC_COLLATE: - retval = "LC_COLLATE"; - break; -#endif -#ifdef LC_CTYPE - case LC_CTYPE: - retval = "LC_CTYPE"; - break; -#endif -#ifdef LC_MONETARY - case LC_MONETARY: - retval = "LC_MONETARY"; - break; -#endif -#ifdef LC_NUMERIC - case LC_NUMERIC: - retval = "LC_NUMERIC"; - break; -#endif -#ifdef LC_TIME - case LC_TIME: - retval = "LC_TIME"; - break; -#endif -#ifdef LC_MESSAGES - case LC_MESSAGES: - retval = "LC_MESSAGES"; - break; -#endif -#ifdef LC_RESPONSE - case LC_RESPONSE: - retval = "LC_RESPONSE"; - break; -#endif -#ifdef LC_ALL - case LC_ALL: - /* This might not make sense but is perhaps better than any other - value. */ - retval = "LC_ALL"; - break; -#endif - default: - /* If you have a better idea for a default value let me know. */ - retval = "LC_XXX"; - } - - return retval; -} -#endif - -/* Guess value of current locale from value of the environment variables. */ -static const char * -internal_function -guess_category_value (category, categoryname) - int category; - const char *categoryname; -{ - const char *language; - const char *retval; - - /* The highest priority value is the `LANGUAGE' environment - variable. But we don't use the value if the currently selected - locale is the C locale. This is a GNU extension. */ - language = getenv ("LANGUAGE"); - if (language != NULL && language[0] == '\0') - language = NULL; - - /* We have to proceed with the POSIX methods of looking to `LC_ALL', - `LC_xxx', and `LANG'. On some systems this can be done by the - `setlocale' function itself. */ -#ifdef _LIBC - retval = __current_locale_name (category); -#else - retval = _nl_locale_name (category, categoryname); -#endif - - /* Ignore LANGUAGE if the locale is set to "C" because - 1. "C" locale usually uses the ASCII encoding, and most international - messages use non-ASCII characters. These characters get displayed - as question marks (if using glibc's iconv()) or as invalid 8-bit - characters (because other iconv()s refuse to convert most non-ASCII - characters to ASCII). In any case, the output is ugly. - 2. The precise output of some programs in the "C" locale is specified - by POSIX and should not depend on environment variables like - "LANGUAGE". We allow such programs to use gettext(). */ - return language != NULL && strcmp (retval, "C") != 0 ? language : retval; -} - -/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ - -/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library. So we - avoid the non-standard function stpcpy. In GNU C Library this - function is available, though. Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY - to be defined. */ -#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY -static char * -stpcpy (dest, src) - char *dest; - const char *src; -{ - while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0') - /* Do nothing. */ ; - return dest - 1; -} -#endif - -#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_MEMPCPY -static void * -mempcpy (dest, src, n) - void *dest; - const void *src; - size_t n; -{ - return (void *) ((char *) memcpy (dest, src, n) + n); -} -#endif - - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* If we want to free all resources we have to do some work at - program's end. */ -libc_freeres_fn (free_mem) -{ - void *old; - - while (_nl_domain_bindings != NULL) - { - struct binding *oldp = _nl_domain_bindings; - _nl_domain_bindings = _nl_domain_bindings->next; - if (oldp->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) - /* Yes, this is a pointer comparison. */ - free (oldp->dirname); - free (oldp->codeset); - free (oldp); - } - - if (_nl_current_default_domain != _nl_default_default_domain) - /* Yes, again a pointer comparison. */ - free ((char *) _nl_current_default_domain); - - /* Remove the search tree with the known translations. */ - __tdestroy (root, free); - root = NULL; - - while (transmem_list != NULL) - { - old = transmem_list; - transmem_list = transmem_list->next; - free (old); - } -} -#endif
--- a/src/intl/dcngettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,60 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of the dcngettext(3) function. - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include "gettextP.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext -# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext -#else -# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext -# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY - locale. */ -char * -DCNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - unsigned long int n; - int category; -{ - return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, 1, n, category); -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ -weak_alias (__dcngettext, dcngettext); -#endif
--- a/src/intl/dgettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,59 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of the dgettext(3) function. - Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <locale.h> - -#include "gettextP.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define DGETTEXT __dgettext -# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext) -#else -# define DGETTEXT libintl_dgettext -# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current - LC_MESSAGES locale. */ -char * -DGETTEXT (domainname, msgid) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid; -{ - return DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, LC_MESSAGES); -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ -weak_alias (__dgettext, dgettext); -#endif
--- a/src/intl/dngettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,61 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of the dngettext(3) function. - Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <locale.h> - -#include "gettextP.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define DNGETTEXT __dngettext -# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext -#else -# define DNGETTEXT libintl_dngettext -# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current - LC_MESSAGES locale and skip message according to the plural form. */ -char * -DNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - unsigned long int n; -{ - return DCNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES); -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ -weak_alias (__dngettext, dngettext); -#endif
--- a/src/intl/eval-plural.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,114 +0,0 @@ -/* Plural expression evaluation. - Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef STATIC -#define STATIC static -#endif - -/* Evaluate the plural expression and return an index value. */ -STATIC unsigned long int plural_eval PARAMS ((struct expression *pexp, - unsigned long int n)) - internal_function; - -STATIC -unsigned long int -internal_function -plural_eval (pexp, n) - struct expression *pexp; - unsigned long int n; -{ - switch (pexp->nargs) - { - case 0: - switch (pexp->operation) - { - case var: - return n; - case num: - return pexp->val.num; - default: - break; - } - /* NOTREACHED */ - break; - case 1: - { - /* pexp->operation must be lnot. */ - unsigned long int arg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n); - return ! arg; - } - case 2: - { - unsigned long int leftarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n); - if (pexp->operation == lor) - return leftarg || plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n); - else if (pexp->operation == land) - return leftarg && plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n); - else - { - unsigned long int rightarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n); - - switch (pexp->operation) - { - case mult: - return leftarg * rightarg; - case divide: -#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE - if (rightarg == 0) - raise (SIGFPE); -#endif - return leftarg / rightarg; - case module: -#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE - if (rightarg == 0) - raise (SIGFPE); -#endif - return leftarg % rightarg; - case plus: - return leftarg + rightarg; - case minus: - return leftarg - rightarg; - case less_than: - return leftarg < rightarg; - case greater_than: - return leftarg > rightarg; - case less_or_equal: - return leftarg <= rightarg; - case greater_or_equal: - return leftarg >= rightarg; - case equal: - return leftarg == rightarg; - case not_equal: - return leftarg != rightarg; - default: - break; - } - } - /* NOTREACHED */ - break; - } - case 3: - { - /* pexp->operation must be qmop. */ - unsigned long int boolarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n); - return plural_eval (pexp->val.args[boolarg ? 1 : 2], n); - } - } - /* NOTREACHED */ - return 0; -}
--- a/src/intl/explodename.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,192 +0,0 @@ -/* Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> -#include <sys/types.h> - -#include "loadinfo.h" - -/* On some strange systems still no definition of NULL is found. Sigh! */ -#ifndef NULL -# if defined __STDC__ && __STDC__ -# define NULL ((void *) 0) -# else -# define NULL 0 -# endif -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -char * -_nl_find_language (name) - const char *name; -{ - while (name[0] != '\0' && name[0] != '_' && name[0] != '@' - && name[0] != '+' && name[0] != ',') - ++name; - - return (char *) name; -} - - -int -_nl_explode_name (name, language, modifier, territory, codeset, - normalized_codeset, special, sponsor, revision) - char *name; - const char **language; - const char **modifier; - const char **territory; - const char **codeset; - const char **normalized_codeset; - const char **special; - const char **sponsor; - const char **revision; -{ - enum { undecided, xpg, cen } syntax; - char *cp; - int mask; - - *modifier = NULL; - *territory = NULL; - *codeset = NULL; - *normalized_codeset = NULL; - *special = NULL; - *sponsor = NULL; - *revision = NULL; - - /* Now we determine the single parts of the locale name. First - look for the language. Termination symbols are `_' and `@' if - we use XPG4 style, and `_', `+', and `,' if we use CEN syntax. */ - mask = 0; - syntax = undecided; - *language = cp = name; - cp = _nl_find_language (*language); - - if (*language == cp) - /* This does not make sense: language has to be specified. Use - this entry as it is without exploding. Perhaps it is an alias. */ - cp = strchr (*language, '\0'); - else if (cp[0] == '_') - { - /* Next is the territory. */ - cp[0] = '\0'; - *territory = ++cp; - - while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '.' && cp[0] != '@' - && cp[0] != '+' && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_') - ++cp; - - mask |= TERRITORY; - - if (cp[0] == '.') - { - /* Next is the codeset. */ - syntax = xpg; - cp[0] = '\0'; - *codeset = ++cp; - - while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '@') - ++cp; - - mask |= XPG_CODESET; - - if (*codeset != cp && (*codeset)[0] != '\0') - { - *normalized_codeset = _nl_normalize_codeset (*codeset, - cp - *codeset); - if (strcmp (*codeset, *normalized_codeset) == 0) - free ((char *) *normalized_codeset); - else - mask |= XPG_NORM_CODESET; - } - } - } - - if (cp[0] == '@' || (syntax != xpg && cp[0] == '+')) - { - /* Next is the modifier. */ - syntax = cp[0] == '@' ? xpg : cen; - cp[0] = '\0'; - *modifier = ++cp; - - while (syntax == cen && cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '+' - && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_') - ++cp; - - mask |= XPG_MODIFIER | CEN_AUDIENCE; - } - - if (syntax != xpg && (cp[0] == '+' || cp[0] == ',' || cp[0] == '_')) - { - syntax = cen; - - if (cp[0] == '+') - { - /* Next is special application (CEN syntax). */ - cp[0] = '\0'; - *special = ++cp; - - while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != ',' && cp[0] != '_') - ++cp; - - mask |= CEN_SPECIAL; - } - - if (cp[0] == ',') - { - /* Next is sponsor (CEN syntax). */ - cp[0] = '\0'; - *sponsor = ++cp; - - while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '_') - ++cp; - - mask |= CEN_SPONSOR; - } - - if (cp[0] == '_') - { - /* Next is revision (CEN syntax). */ - cp[0] = '\0'; - *revision = ++cp; - - mask |= CEN_REVISION; - } - } - - /* For CEN syntax values it might be important to have the - separator character in the file name, not for XPG syntax. */ - if (syntax == xpg) - { - if (*territory != NULL && (*territory)[0] == '\0') - mask &= ~TERRITORY; - - if (*codeset != NULL && (*codeset)[0] == '\0') - mask &= ~XPG_CODESET; - - if (*modifier != NULL && (*modifier)[0] == '\0') - mask &= ~XPG_MODIFIER; - } - - return mask; -}
--- a/src/intl/finddomain.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,195 +0,0 @@ -/* Handle list of needed message catalogs - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stdio.h> -#include <sys/types.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC -# include <unistd.h> -#endif - -#include "gettextP.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ -/* List of already loaded domains. */ -static struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_loaded_domains; - - -/* Return a data structure describing the message catalog described by - the DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY parameters with respect to the currently - established bindings. */ -struct loaded_l10nfile * -internal_function -_nl_find_domain (dirname, locale, domainname, domainbinding) - const char *dirname; - char *locale; - const char *domainname; - struct binding *domainbinding; -{ - struct loaded_l10nfile *retval; - const char *language; - const char *modifier; - const char *territory; - const char *codeset; - const char *normalized_codeset; - const char *special; - const char *sponsor; - const char *revision; - const char *alias_value; - int mask; - - /* LOCALE can consist of up to four recognized parts for the XPG syntax: - - language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier] - - and six parts for the CEN syntax: - - language[_territory][+audience][+special][,[sponsor][_revision]] - - Beside the first part all of them are allowed to be missing. If - the full specified locale is not found, the less specific one are - looked for. The various parts will be stripped off according to - the following order: - (1) revision - (2) sponsor - (3) special - (4) codeset - (5) normalized codeset - (6) territory - (7) audience/modifier - */ - - /* If we have already tested for this locale entry there has to - be one data set in the list of loaded domains. */ - retval = _nl_make_l10nflist (&_nl_loaded_domains, dirname, - strlen (dirname) + 1, 0, locale, NULL, NULL, - NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, domainname, 0); - if (retval != NULL) - { - /* We know something about this locale. */ - int cnt; - - if (retval->decided == 0) - _nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding); - - if (retval->data != NULL) - return retval; - - for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt) - { - if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0) - _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding); - - if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL) - break; - } - return cnt >= 0 ? retval : NULL; - /* NOTREACHED */ - } - - /* See whether the locale value is an alias. If yes its value - *overwrites* the alias name. No test for the original value is - done. */ - alias_value = _nl_expand_alias (locale); - if (alias_value != NULL) - { -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP - locale = strdup (alias_value); - if (locale == NULL) - return NULL; -#else - size_t len = strlen (alias_value) + 1; - locale = (char *) malloc (len); - if (locale == NULL) - return NULL; - - memcpy (locale, alias_value, len); -#endif - } - - /* Now we determine the single parts of the locale name. First - look for the language. Termination symbols are `_' and `@' if - we use XPG4 style, and `_', `+', and `,' if we use CEN syntax. */ - mask = _nl_explode_name (locale, &language, &modifier, &territory, - &codeset, &normalized_codeset, &special, - &sponsor, &revision); - - /* Create all possible locale entries which might be interested in - generalization. */ - retval = _nl_make_l10nflist (&_nl_loaded_domains, dirname, - strlen (dirname) + 1, mask, language, territory, - codeset, normalized_codeset, modifier, special, - sponsor, revision, domainname, 1); - if (retval == NULL) - /* This means we are out of core. */ - return NULL; - - if (retval->decided == 0) - _nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding); - if (retval->data == NULL) - { - int cnt; - for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt) - { - if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0) - _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding); - if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL) - break; - } - } - - /* The room for an alias was dynamically allocated. Free it now. */ - if (alias_value != NULL) - free (locale); - - /* The space for normalized_codeset is dynamically allocated. Free it. */ - if (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) - free ((void *) normalized_codeset); - - return retval; -} - - -#ifdef _LIBC -libc_freeres_fn (free_mem) -{ - struct loaded_l10nfile *runp = _nl_loaded_domains; - - while (runp != NULL) - { - struct loaded_l10nfile *here = runp; - if (runp->data != NULL) - _nl_unload_domain ((struct loaded_domain *) runp->data); - runp = runp->next; - free ((char *) here->filename); - free (here); - } -} -#endif
--- a/src/intl/gettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,64 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of gettext(3) function. - Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#ifdef _LIBC -# define __need_NULL -# include <stddef.h> -#else -# include <stdlib.h> /* Just for NULL. */ -#endif - -#include "gettextP.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define GETTEXT __gettext -# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext) -#else -# define GETTEXT libintl_gettext -# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current - LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default - text). */ -char * -GETTEXT (msgid) - const char *msgid; -{ - return DCGETTEXT (NULL, msgid, LC_MESSAGES); -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ -weak_alias (__gettext, gettext); -#endif
--- a/src/intl/gettextP.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,224 +0,0 @@ -/* Header describing internals of libintl library. - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef _GETTEXTP_H -#define _GETTEXTP_H - -#include <stddef.h> /* Get size_t. */ - -#ifdef _LIBC -# include "../iconv/gconv_int.h" -#else -# if HAVE_ICONV -# include <iconv.h> -# endif -#endif - -#include "loadinfo.h" - -#include "gmo.h" /* Get nls_uint32. */ - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -#ifndef PARAMS -# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES -# define PARAMS(args) args -# else -# define PARAMS(args) () -# endif -#endif - -#ifndef internal_function -# define internal_function -#endif - -#ifndef attribute_hidden -# define attribute_hidden -#endif - -/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is - almost always true or almost always false. */ -#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT -# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr) -#endif - -#ifndef W -# define W(flag, data) ((flag) ? SWAP (data) : (data)) -#endif - - -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <byteswap.h> -# define SWAP(i) bswap_32 (i) -#else -static inline nls_uint32 -SWAP (i) - nls_uint32 i; -{ - return (i << 24) | ((i & 0xff00) << 8) | ((i >> 8) & 0xff00) | (i >> 24); -} -#endif - - -/* In-memory representation of system dependent string. */ -struct sysdep_string_desc -{ - /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL. */ - size_t length; - /* Pointer to addressed string. */ - const char *pointer; -}; - -/* The representation of an opened message catalog. */ -struct loaded_domain -{ - /* Pointer to memory containing the .mo file. */ - const char *data; - /* 1 if the memory is mmap()ed, 0 if the memory is malloc()ed. */ - int use_mmap; - /* Size of mmap()ed memory. */ - size_t mmap_size; - /* 1 if the .mo file uses a different endianness than this machine. */ - int must_swap; - /* Pointer to additional malloc()ed memory. */ - void *malloced; - - /* Number of static strings pairs. */ - nls_uint32 nstrings; - /* Pointer to descriptors of original strings in the file. */ - const struct string_desc *orig_tab; - /* Pointer to descriptors of translated strings in the file. */ - const struct string_desc *trans_tab; - - /* Number of system dependent strings pairs. */ - nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings; - /* Pointer to descriptors of original sysdep strings. */ - const struct sysdep_string_desc *orig_sysdep_tab; - /* Pointer to descriptors of translated sysdep strings. */ - const struct sysdep_string_desc *trans_sysdep_tab; - - /* Size of hash table. */ - nls_uint32 hash_size; - /* Pointer to hash table. */ - const nls_uint32 *hash_tab; - /* 1 if the hash table uses a different endianness than this machine. */ - int must_swap_hash_tab; - - int codeset_cntr; -#ifdef _LIBC - __gconv_t conv; -#else -# if HAVE_ICONV - iconv_t conv; -# endif -#endif - char **conv_tab; - - struct expression *plural; - unsigned long int nplurals; -}; - -/* We want to allocate a string at the end of the struct. But ISO C - doesn't allow zero sized arrays. */ -#ifdef __GNUC__ -# define ZERO 0 -#else -# define ZERO 1 -#endif - -/* A set of settings bound to a message domain. Used to store settings - from bindtextdomain() and bind_textdomain_codeset(). */ -struct binding -{ - struct binding *next; - char *dirname; - int codeset_cntr; /* Incremented each time codeset changes. */ - char *codeset; - char domainname[ZERO]; -}; - -/* A counter which is incremented each time some previous translations - become invalid. - This variable is part of the external ABI of the GNU libintl. */ -extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr; - -#ifndef _LIBC -const char *_nl_locale_name PARAMS ((int category, const char *categoryname)); -#endif - -struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_find_domain PARAMS ((const char *__dirname, - char *__locale, - const char *__domainname, - struct binding *__domainbinding)) - internal_function; -void _nl_load_domain PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain, - struct binding *__domainbinding)) - internal_function; -void _nl_unload_domain PARAMS ((struct loaded_domain *__domain)) - internal_function; -const char *_nl_init_domain_conv PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain_file, - struct loaded_domain *__domain, - struct binding *__domainbinding)) - internal_function; -void _nl_free_domain_conv PARAMS ((struct loaded_domain *__domain)) - internal_function; - -char *_nl_find_msg PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file, - struct binding *domainbinding, - const char *msgid, size_t *lengthp)) - internal_function; - -#ifdef _LIBC -extern char *__gettext PARAMS ((const char *__msgid)); -extern char *__dgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid)); -extern char *__dcgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid, int __category)); -extern char *__ngettext PARAMS ((const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n)); -extern char *__dngettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int n)); -extern char *__dcngettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n, int __category)); -extern char *__dcigettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - int __plural, unsigned long int __n, - int __category)); -extern char *__textdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname)); -extern char *__bindtextdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__dirname)); -extern char *__bind_textdomain_codeset PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__codeset)); -#else -/* Declare the exported libintl_* functions, in a way that allows us to - call them under their real name. */ -# define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# include "libgnuintl.h" -extern char *libintl_dcigettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, - const char *__msgid2, - int __plural, unsigned long int __n, - int __category)); -#endif - -/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ - -#endif /* gettextP.h */
--- a/src/intl/gmo.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,148 +0,0 @@ -/* Description of GNU message catalog format: general file layout. - Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef _GETTEXT_H -#define _GETTEXT_H 1 - -#include <limits.h> - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* The magic number of the GNU message catalog format. */ -#define _MAGIC 0x950412de -#define _MAGIC_SWAPPED 0xde120495 - -/* Revision number of the currently used .mo (binary) file format. */ -#define MO_REVISION_NUMBER 0 - -/* The following contortions are an attempt to use the C preprocessor - to determine an unsigned integral type that is 32 bits wide. An - alternative approach is to use autoconf's AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro, but - as of version autoconf-2.13, the AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro doesn't work - when cross-compiling. */ - -#if __STDC__ -# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 4294967295U -#else -# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 0xFFFFFFFF -#endif - -/* If UINT_MAX isn't defined, assume it's a 32-bit type. - This should be valid for all systems GNU cares about because - that doesn't include 16-bit systems, and only modern systems - (that certainly have <limits.h>) have 64+-bit integral types. */ - -#ifndef UINT_MAX -# define UINT_MAX UINT_MAX_32_BITS -#endif - -#if UINT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS -typedef unsigned nls_uint32; -#else -# if USHRT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS -typedef unsigned short nls_uint32; -# else -# if ULONG_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS -typedef unsigned long nls_uint32; -# else - /* The following line is intended to throw an error. Using #error is - not portable enough. */ - "Cannot determine unsigned 32-bit data type." -# endif -# endif -#endif - - -/* Header for binary .mo file format. */ -struct mo_file_header -{ - /* The magic number. */ - nls_uint32 magic; - /* The revision number of the file format. */ - nls_uint32 revision; - - /* The following are only used in .mo files with major revision 0. */ - - /* The number of strings pairs. */ - nls_uint32 nstrings; - /* Offset of table with start offsets of original strings. */ - nls_uint32 orig_tab_offset; - /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated strings. */ - nls_uint32 trans_tab_offset; - /* Size of hash table. */ - nls_uint32 hash_tab_size; - /* Offset of first hash table entry. */ - nls_uint32 hash_tab_offset; - - /* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1. */ - - /* The number of system dependent segments. */ - nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments; - /* Offset of table describing system dependent segments. */ - nls_uint32 sysdep_segments_offset; - /* The number of system dependent strings pairs. */ - nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings; - /* Offset of table with start offsets of original sysdep strings. */ - nls_uint32 orig_sysdep_tab_offset; - /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated sysdep strings. */ - nls_uint32 trans_sysdep_tab_offset; -}; - -/* Descriptor for static string contained in the binary .mo file. */ -struct string_desc -{ - /* Length of addressed string, not including the trailing NUL. */ - nls_uint32 length; - /* Offset of string in file. */ - nls_uint32 offset; -}; - -/* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1. */ - -/* Descriptor for system dependent string segment. */ -struct sysdep_segment -{ - /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL. */ - nls_uint32 length; - /* Offset of string in file. */ - nls_uint32 offset; -}; - -/* Descriptor for system dependent string. */ -struct sysdep_string -{ - /* Offset of static string segments in file. */ - nls_uint32 offset; - /* Alternating sequence of static and system dependent segments. - The last segment is a static segment, including the trailing NUL. */ - struct segment_pair - { - /* Size of static segment. */ - nls_uint32 segsize; - /* Reference to system dependent string segment, or ~0 at the end. */ - nls_uint32 sysdepref; - } segments[1]; -}; - -/* Marker for the end of the segments[] array. This has the value 0xFFFFFFFF, - regardless whether 'int' is 16 bit, 32 bit, or 64 bit. */ -#define SEGMENTS_END ((nls_uint32) ~0) - -/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ - -#endif /* gettext.h */
--- a/src/intl/hash-string.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,59 +0,0 @@ -/* Description of GNU message catalog format: string hashing function. - Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 1998, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -#ifndef PARAMS -# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES -# define PARAMS(Args) Args -# else -# define PARAMS(Args) () -# endif -#endif - -/* We assume to have `unsigned long int' value with at least 32 bits. */ -#define HASHWORDBITS 32 - - -/* Defines the so called `hashpjw' function by P.J. Weinberger - [see Aho/Sethi/Ullman, COMPILERS: Principles, Techniques and Tools, - 1986, 1987 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Inc.] */ -static unsigned long int hash_string PARAMS ((const char *__str_param)); - -static inline unsigned long int -hash_string (str_param) - const char *str_param; -{ - unsigned long int hval, g; - const char *str = str_param; - - /* Compute the hash value for the given string. */ - hval = 0; - while (*str != '\0') - { - hval <<= 4; - hval += (unsigned long int) *str++; - g = hval & ((unsigned long int) 0xf << (HASHWORDBITS - 4)); - if (g != 0) - { - hval ^= g >> (HASHWORDBITS - 8); - hval ^= g; - } - } - return hval; -}
--- a/src/intl/intl-compat.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,151 +0,0 @@ -/* intl-compat.c - Stub functions to call gettext functions from GNU gettext - Library. - Copyright (C) 1995, 2000-2003 Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include "gettextP.h" - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* This file redirects the gettext functions (without prefix) to those - defined in the included GNU libintl library (with "libintl_" prefix). - It is compiled into libintl in order to make the AM_GNU_GETTEXT test - of gettext <= 0.11.2 work with the libintl library >= 0.11.3 which - has the redirections primarily in the <libintl.h> include file. - It is also compiled into libgnuintl so that libgnuintl.so can be used - as LD_PRELOADable library on glibc systems, to provide the extra - features that the functions in the libc don't have (namely, logging). */ - - -#undef gettext -#undef dgettext -#undef dcgettext -#undef ngettext -#undef dngettext -#undef dcngettext -#undef textdomain -#undef bindtextdomain -#undef bind_textdomain_codeset - - -/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions. Note that because - the functions are only defined for binary backward compatibility, we - don't need to use __declspec(dllimport) in any case. */ -#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL -# define DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport) -#else -# define DLL_EXPORTED -#endif - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -gettext (msgid) - const char *msgid; -{ - return libintl_gettext (msgid); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -dgettext (domainname, msgid) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid; -{ - return libintl_dgettext (domainname, msgid); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid; - int category; -{ - return libintl_dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -ngettext (msgid1, msgid2, n) - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - unsigned long int n; -{ - return libintl_ngettext (msgid1, msgid2, n); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -dngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - unsigned long int n; -{ - return libintl_dngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -dcngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category) - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - unsigned long int n; - int category; -{ - return libintl_dcngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -textdomain (domainname) - const char *domainname; -{ - return libintl_textdomain (domainname); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname) - const char *domainname; - const char *dirname; -{ - return libintl_bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname); -} - - -DLL_EXPORTED -char * -bind_textdomain_codeset (domainname, codeset) - const char *domainname; - const char *codeset; -{ - return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (domainname, codeset); -}
--- a/src/intl/l10nflist.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,453 +0,0 @@ -/* Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for stpcpy(). - This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include - <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ -#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE -# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <string.h> - -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_ARGZ_H -# include <argz.h> -#endif -#include <ctype.h> -#include <sys/types.h> -#include <stdlib.h> - -#include "loadinfo.h" - -/* On some strange systems still no definition of NULL is found. Sigh! */ -#ifndef NULL -# if defined __STDC__ && __STDC__ -# define NULL ((void *) 0) -# else -# define NULL 0 -# endif -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard - because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object - file and the name space must not be polluted. */ -# ifndef stpcpy -# define stpcpy(dest, src) __stpcpy(dest, src) -# endif -#else -# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY -static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src)); -# endif -#endif - -/* Pathname support. - ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character. - IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) tests whether P is an absolute path. If it is not, - it may be concatenated to a directory pathname. - */ -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ - /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') -# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \ - ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \ - && (P)[1] == ':') -# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P)) -#else - /* Unix */ -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/') -# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0]) -#endif - -/* Define function which are usually not available. */ - -#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT -/* Returns the number of strings in ARGZ. */ -static size_t argz_count__ PARAMS ((const char *argz, size_t len)); - -static size_t -argz_count__ (argz, len) - const char *argz; - size_t len; -{ - size_t count = 0; - while (len > 0) - { - size_t part_len = strlen (argz); - argz += part_len + 1; - len -= part_len + 1; - count++; - } - return count; -} -# undef __argz_count -# define __argz_count(argz, len) argz_count__ (argz, len) -#else -# ifdef _LIBC -# define __argz_count(argz, len) INTUSE(__argz_count) (argz, len) -# endif -#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT */ - -#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY -/* Make '\0' separated arg vector ARGZ printable by converting all the '\0's - except the last into the character SEP. */ -static void argz_stringify__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t len, int sep)); - -static void -argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep) - char *argz; - size_t len; - int sep; -{ - while (len > 0) - { - size_t part_len = strlen (argz); - argz += part_len; - len -= part_len + 1; - if (len > 0) - *argz++ = sep; - } -} -# undef __argz_stringify -# define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep) -#else -# ifdef _LIBC -# define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) \ - INTUSE(__argz_stringify) (argz, len, sep) -# endif -#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY */ - -#if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_NEXT -static char *argz_next__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t argz_len, - const char *entry)); - -static char * -argz_next__ (argz, argz_len, entry) - char *argz; - size_t argz_len; - const char *entry; -{ - if (entry) - { - if (entry < argz + argz_len) - entry = strchr (entry, '\0') + 1; - - return entry >= argz + argz_len ? NULL : (char *) entry; - } - else - if (argz_len > 0) - return argz; - else - return 0; -} -# undef __argz_next -# define __argz_next(argz, len, entry) argz_next__ (argz, len, entry) -#endif /* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_NEXT */ - - -/* Return number of bits set in X. */ -static int pop PARAMS ((int x)); - -static inline int -pop (x) - int x; -{ - /* We assume that no more than 16 bits are used. */ - x = ((x & ~0x5555) >> 1) + (x & 0x5555); - x = ((x & ~0x3333) >> 2) + (x & 0x3333); - x = ((x >> 4) + x) & 0x0f0f; - x = ((x >> 8) + x) & 0xff; - - return x; -} - - -struct loaded_l10nfile * -_nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len, mask, language, - territory, codeset, normalized_codeset, modifier, special, - sponsor, revision, filename, do_allocate) - struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list; - const char *dirlist; - size_t dirlist_len; - int mask; - const char *language; - const char *territory; - const char *codeset; - const char *normalized_codeset; - const char *modifier; - const char *special; - const char *sponsor; - const char *revision; - const char *filename; - int do_allocate; -{ - char *abs_filename; - struct loaded_l10nfile **lastp; - struct loaded_l10nfile *retval; - char *cp; - size_t dirlist_count; - size_t entries; - int cnt; - - /* If LANGUAGE contains an absolute directory specification, we ignore - DIRLIST. */ - if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (language)) - dirlist_len = 0; - - /* Allocate room for the full file name. */ - abs_filename = (char *) malloc (dirlist_len - + strlen (language) - + ((mask & TERRITORY) != 0 - ? strlen (territory) + 1 : 0) - + ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0 - ? strlen (codeset) + 1 : 0) - + ((mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0 - ? strlen (normalized_codeset) + 1 : 0) - + (((mask & XPG_MODIFIER) != 0 - || (mask & CEN_AUDIENCE) != 0) - ? strlen (modifier) + 1 : 0) - + ((mask & CEN_SPECIAL) != 0 - ? strlen (special) + 1 : 0) - + (((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0 - || (mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0) - ? (1 + ((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0 - ? strlen (sponsor) : 0) - + ((mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0 - ? strlen (revision) + 1 : 0)) : 0) - + 1 + strlen (filename) + 1); - - if (abs_filename == NULL) - return NULL; - - /* Construct file name. */ - cp = abs_filename; - if (dirlist_len > 0) - { - memcpy (cp, dirlist, dirlist_len); - __argz_stringify (cp, dirlist_len, PATH_SEPARATOR); - cp += dirlist_len; - cp[-1] = '/'; - } - - cp = stpcpy (cp, language); - - if ((mask & TERRITORY) != 0) - { - *cp++ = '_'; - cp = stpcpy (cp, territory); - } - if ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0) - { - *cp++ = '.'; - cp = stpcpy (cp, codeset); - } - if ((mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0) - { - *cp++ = '.'; - cp = stpcpy (cp, normalized_codeset); - } - if ((mask & (XPG_MODIFIER | CEN_AUDIENCE)) != 0) - { - /* This component can be part of both syntaces but has different - leading characters. For CEN we use `+', else `@'. */ - *cp++ = (mask & CEN_AUDIENCE) != 0 ? '+' : '@'; - cp = stpcpy (cp, modifier); - } - if ((mask & CEN_SPECIAL) != 0) - { - *cp++ = '+'; - cp = stpcpy (cp, special); - } - if ((mask & (CEN_SPONSOR | CEN_REVISION)) != 0) - { - *cp++ = ','; - if ((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0) - cp = stpcpy (cp, sponsor); - if ((mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0) - { - *cp++ = '_'; - cp = stpcpy (cp, revision); - } - } - - *cp++ = '/'; - stpcpy (cp, filename); - - /* Look in list of already loaded domains whether it is already - available. */ - lastp = l10nfile_list; - for (retval = *l10nfile_list; retval != NULL; retval = retval->next) - if (retval->filename != NULL) - { - int compare = strcmp (retval->filename, abs_filename); - if (compare == 0) - /* We found it! */ - break; - if (compare < 0) - { - /* It's not in the list. */ - retval = NULL; - break; - } - - lastp = &retval->next; - } - - if (retval != NULL || do_allocate == 0) - { - free (abs_filename); - return retval; - } - - dirlist_count = (dirlist_len > 0 ? __argz_count (dirlist, dirlist_len) : 1); - - /* Allocate a new loaded_l10nfile. */ - retval = - (struct loaded_l10nfile *) - malloc (sizeof (*retval) - + (((dirlist_count << pop (mask)) + (dirlist_count > 1 ? 1 : 0)) - * sizeof (struct loaded_l10nfile *))); - if (retval == NULL) - return NULL; - - retval->filename = abs_filename; - - /* We set retval->data to NULL here; it is filled in later. - Setting retval->decided to 1 here means that retval does not - correspond to a real file (dirlist_count > 1) or is not worth - looking up (if an unnormalized codeset was specified). */ - retval->decided = (dirlist_count > 1 - || ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0 - && (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0)); - retval->data = NULL; - - retval->next = *lastp; - *lastp = retval; - - entries = 0; - /* Recurse to fill the inheritance list of RETVAL. - If the DIRLIST is a real list (i.e. DIRLIST_COUNT > 1), the RETVAL - entry does not correspond to a real file; retval->filename contains - colons. In this case we loop across all elements of DIRLIST and - across all bit patterns dominated by MASK. - If the DIRLIST is a single directory or entirely redundant (i.e. - DIRLIST_COUNT == 1), we loop across all bit patterns dominated by - MASK, excluding MASK itself. - In either case, we loop down from MASK to 0. This has the effect - that the extra bits in the locale name are dropped in this order: - first the modifier, then the territory, then the codeset, then the - normalized_codeset. */ - for (cnt = dirlist_count > 1 ? mask : mask - 1; cnt >= 0; --cnt) - if ((cnt & ~mask) == 0 - && ((cnt & CEN_SPECIFIC) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_SPECIFIC) == 0) - && ((cnt & XPG_CODESET) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_NORM_CODESET) == 0)) - { - if (dirlist_count > 1) - { - /* Iterate over all elements of the DIRLIST. */ - char *dir = NULL; - - while ((dir = __argz_next ((char *) dirlist, dirlist_len, dir)) - != NULL) - retval->successor[entries++] - = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dir, strlen (dir) + 1, - cnt, language, territory, codeset, - normalized_codeset, modifier, special, - sponsor, revision, filename, 1); - } - else - retval->successor[entries++] - = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len, - cnt, language, territory, codeset, - normalized_codeset, modifier, special, - sponsor, revision, filename, 1); - } - retval->successor[entries] = NULL; - - return retval; -} - -/* Normalize codeset name. There is no standard for the codeset - names. Normalization allows the user to use any of the common - names. The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be - freed by the caller. */ -const char * -_nl_normalize_codeset (codeset, name_len) - const char *codeset; - size_t name_len; -{ - int len = 0; - int only_digit = 1; - char *retval; - char *wp; - size_t cnt; - - for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt) - if (isalnum ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) - { - ++len; - - if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) - only_digit = 0; - } - - retval = (char *) malloc ((only_digit ? 3 : 0) + len + 1); - - if (retval != NULL) - { - if (only_digit) - wp = stpcpy (retval, "iso"); - else - wp = retval; - - for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt) - if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) - *wp++ = tolower ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]); - else if (isdigit ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt])) - *wp++ = codeset[cnt]; - - *wp = '\0'; - } - - return (const char *) retval; -} - - -/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */ - -/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library. So we - avoid the non-standard function stpcpy. In GNU C Library this - function is available, though. Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY - to be defined. */ -#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY -static char * -stpcpy (dest, src) - char *dest; - const char *src; -{ - while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0') - /* Do nothing. */ ; - return dest - 1; -} -#endif
--- a/src/intl/libgnuintl.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,309 +0,0 @@ -/* Message catalogs for internationalization. - Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef _LIBINTL_H -#define _LIBINTL_H 1 - -#include <locale.h> - -/* The LC_MESSAGES locale category is the category used by the functions - gettext() and dgettext(). It is specified in POSIX, but not in ANSI C. - On systems that don't define it, use an arbitrary value instead. - On Solaris, <locale.h> defines __LOCALE_H (or _LOCALE_H in Solaris 2.5) - then includes <libintl.h> (i.e. this file!) and then only defines - LC_MESSAGES. To avoid a redefinition warning, don't define LC_MESSAGES - in this case. */ -#if !defined LC_MESSAGES && !(defined __LOCALE_H || (defined _LOCALE_H && defined __sun)) -# define LC_MESSAGES 1729 -#endif - -/* We define an additional symbol to signal that we use the GNU - implementation of gettext. */ -#define __USE_GNU_GETTEXT 1 - -/* Provide information about the supported file formats. Returns the - maximum minor revision number supported for a given major revision. */ -#define __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(major) \ - ((major) == 0 ? 1 : -1) - -/* Resolve a platform specific conflict on DJGPP. GNU gettext takes - precedence over _conio_gettext. */ -#ifdef __DJGPP__ -# undef gettext -#endif - -/* Use _INTL_PARAMS, not PARAMS, in order to avoid clashes with identifiers - used by programs. Similarly, test __PROTOTYPES, not PROTOTYPES. */ -#ifndef _INTL_PARAMS -# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES -# define _INTL_PARAMS(args) args -# else -# define _INTL_PARAMS(args) () -# endif -#endif - -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" { -#endif - - -/* We redirect the functions to those prefixed with "libintl_". This is - necessary, because some systems define gettext/textdomain/... in the C - library (namely, Solaris 2.4 and newer, and GNU libc 2.0 and newer). - If we used the unprefixed names, there would be cases where the - definition in the C library would override the one in the libintl.so - shared library. Recall that on ELF systems, the symbols are looked - up in the following order: - 1. in the executable, - 2. in the shared libraries specified on the link command line, in order, - 3. in the dependencies of the shared libraries specified on the link - command line, - 4. in the dlopen()ed shared libraries, in the order in which they were - dlopen()ed. - The definition in the C library would override the one in libintl.so if - either - * -lc is given on the link command line and -lintl isn't, or - * -lc is given on the link command line before -lintl, or - * libintl.so is a dependency of a dlopen()ed shared library but not - linked to the executable at link time. - Since Solaris gettext() behaves differently than GNU gettext(), this - would be unacceptable. - - The redirection happens by default through macros in C, so that &gettext - is independent of the compilation unit, but through inline functions in - C++, in order not to interfere with the name mangling of class fields or - class methods called 'gettext'. */ - -/* The user can define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE or _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS. - If he doesn't, we choose the method. A third possible method is - _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM, supported only by GCC. */ -#if !(defined _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE || defined _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS) -# if __GNUC__ >= 2 && !defined __APPLE_CC__ && (defined __STDC__ || defined __cplusplus) -# define _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM -# else -# ifdef __cplusplus -# define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -# else -# define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# endif -# endif -#endif -/* Auxiliary macros. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM -# define _INTL_ASM(cname) __asm__ (_INTL_ASMNAME (__USER_LABEL_PREFIX__, #cname)) -# define _INTL_ASMNAME(prefix,cnamestring) _INTL_STRINGIFY (prefix) cnamestring -# define _INTL_STRINGIFY(prefix) #prefix -#else -# define _INTL_ASM(cname) -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current - LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default - text). */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_gettext (const char *__msgid); -static inline char *gettext (const char *__msgid) -{ - return libintl_gettext (__msgid); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define gettext libintl_gettext -#endif -extern char *gettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__msgid)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_gettext); -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current - LC_MESSAGES locale. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid); -static inline char *dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid) -{ - return libintl_dgettext (__domainname, __msgid); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define dgettext libintl_dgettext -#endif -extern char *dgettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_dgettext); -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY - locale. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid, - int __category); -static inline char *dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid, - int __category) -{ - return libintl_dcgettext (__domainname, __msgid, __category); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define dcgettext libintl_dcgettext -#endif -extern char *dcgettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid, - int __category)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcgettext); -#endif - - -/* Similar to `gettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the - number N. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n); -static inline char *ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n) -{ - return libintl_ngettext (__msgid1, __msgid2, __n); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define ngettext libintl_ngettext -#endif -extern char *ngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__msgid1, - const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_ngettext); -#endif - -/* Similar to `dgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the - number N. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1, - const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n); -static inline char *dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1, - const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n) -{ - return libintl_dngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define dngettext libintl_dngettext -#endif -extern char *dngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, - const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_dngettext); -#endif - -/* Similar to `dcgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the - number N. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_dcngettext (const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n, int __category); -static inline char *dcngettext (const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n, int __category) -{ - return libintl_dcngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n, __category); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define dcngettext libintl_dcngettext -#endif -extern char *dcngettext _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__msgid1, - const char *__msgid2, - unsigned long int __n, - int __category)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcngettext); -#endif - - -/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME. - If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default. - If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages". */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_textdomain (const char *__domainname); -static inline char *textdomain (const char *__domainname) -{ - return libintl_textdomain (__domainname); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define textdomain libintl_textdomain -#endif -extern char *textdomain _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_textdomain); -#endif - -/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found - in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname, - const char *__dirname); -static inline char *bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname, - const char *__dirname) -{ - return libintl_bindtextdomain (__domainname, __dirname); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define bindtextdomain libintl_bindtextdomain -#endif -extern char *bindtextdomain _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__dirname)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_bindtextdomain); -#endif - -/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the - DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned. */ -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE -extern char *libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname, - const char *__codeset); -static inline char *bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname, - const char *__codeset) -{ - return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (__domainname, __codeset); -} -#else -#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS -# define bind_textdomain_codeset libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset -#endif -extern char *bind_textdomain_codeset _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, - const char *__codeset)) - _INTL_ASM (libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset); -#endif - - -/* Support for relocatable packages. */ - -/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package. - Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix - by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both - prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" - instead of "/"). */ -#define libintl_set_relocation_prefix libintl_set_relocation_prefix -extern void - libintl_set_relocation_prefix _INTL_PARAMS ((const char *orig_prefix, - const char *curr_prefix)); - - -#ifdef __cplusplus -} -#endif - -#endif /* libintl.h */
--- a/src/intl/loadinfo.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,156 +0,0 @@ -/* Copyright (C) 1996-1999, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - This file is part of the GNU C Library. - Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef _LOADINFO_H -#define _LOADINFO_H 1 - -/* Declarations of locale dependent catalog lookup functions. - Implemented in - - localealias.c Possibly replace a locale name by another. - explodename.c Split a locale name into its various fields. - l10nflist.c Generate a list of filenames of possible message catalogs. - finddomain.c Find and open the relevant message catalogs. - - The main function _nl_find_domain() in finddomain.c is declared - in gettextP.h. - */ - -#ifndef PARAMS -# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES -# define PARAMS(args) args -# else -# define PARAMS(args) () -# endif -#endif - -#ifndef internal_function -# define internal_function -#endif - -/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is - almost always true or almost always false. */ -#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT -# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr) -#endif - -/* Separator in PATH like lists of pathnames. */ -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ - /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ -# define PATH_SEPARATOR ';' -#else - /* Unix */ -# define PATH_SEPARATOR ':' -#endif - -/* Encoding of locale name parts. */ -#define CEN_REVISION 1 -#define CEN_SPONSOR 2 -#define CEN_SPECIAL 4 -#define XPG_NORM_CODESET 8 -#define XPG_CODESET 16 -#define TERRITORY 32 -#define CEN_AUDIENCE 64 -#define XPG_MODIFIER 128 - -#define CEN_SPECIFIC (CEN_REVISION|CEN_SPONSOR|CEN_SPECIAL|CEN_AUDIENCE) -#define XPG_SPECIFIC (XPG_CODESET|XPG_NORM_CODESET|XPG_MODIFIER) - - -struct loaded_l10nfile -{ - const char *filename; - int decided; - - const void *data; - - struct loaded_l10nfile *next; - struct loaded_l10nfile *successor[1]; -}; - - -/* Normalize codeset name. There is no standard for the codeset - names. Normalization allows the user to use any of the common - names. The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be - freed by the caller. */ -extern const char *_nl_normalize_codeset PARAMS ((const char *codeset, - size_t name_len)); - -/* Lookup a locale dependent file. - *L10NFILE_LIST denotes a pool of lookup results of locale dependent - files of the same kind, sorted in decreasing order of ->filename. - DIRLIST and DIRLIST_LEN are an argz list of directories in which to - look, containing at least one directory (i.e. DIRLIST_LEN > 0). - MASK, LANGUAGE, TERRITORY, CODESET, NORMALIZED_CODESET, MODIFIER, - SPECIAL, SPONSOR, REVISION are the pieces of the locale name, as - produced by _nl_explode_name(). FILENAME is the filename suffix. - The return value is the lookup result, either found in *L10NFILE_LIST, - or - if DO_ALLOCATE is nonzero - freshly allocated, or possibly NULL. - If the return value is non-NULL, it is added to *L10NFILE_LIST, and - its ->next field denotes the chaining inside *L10NFILE_LIST, and - furthermore its ->successor[] field contains a list of other lookup - results from which this lookup result inherits. */ -extern struct loaded_l10nfile * -_nl_make_l10nflist PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list, - const char *dirlist, size_t dirlist_len, int mask, - const char *language, const char *territory, - const char *codeset, - const char *normalized_codeset, - const char *modifier, const char *special, - const char *sponsor, const char *revision, - const char *filename, int do_allocate)); - -/* Lookup the real locale name for a locale alias NAME, or NULL if - NAME is not a locale alias (but possibly a real locale name). - The return value is statically allocated and must not be freed. */ -extern const char *_nl_expand_alias PARAMS ((const char *name)); - -/* Split a locale name NAME into its pieces: language, modifier, - territory, codeset, special, sponsor, revision. - NAME gets destructively modified: NUL bytes are inserted here and - there. *LANGUAGE gets assigned NAME. Each of *MODIFIER, *TERRITORY, - *CODESET, *SPECIAL, *SPONSOR, *REVISION gets assigned either a - pointer into the old NAME string, or NULL. *NORMALIZED_CODESET - gets assigned the expanded *CODESET, if it is different from *CODESET; - this one is dynamically allocated and has to be freed by the caller. - The return value is a bitmask, where each bit corresponds to one - filled-in value: - XPG_MODIFIER, CEN_AUDIENCE for *MODIFIER, - TERRITORY for *TERRITORY, - XPG_CODESET for *CODESET, - XPG_NORM_CODESET for *NORMALIZED_CODESET, - CEN_SPECIAL for *SPECIAL, - CEN_SPONSOR for *SPONSOR, - CEN_REVISION for *REVISION. - */ -extern int _nl_explode_name PARAMS ((char *name, const char **language, - const char **modifier, - const char **territory, - const char **codeset, - const char **normalized_codeset, - const char **special, - const char **sponsor, - const char **revision)); - -/* Split a locale name NAME into a leading language part and all the - rest. Return a pointer to the first character after the language, - i.e. to the first byte of the rest. */ -extern char *_nl_find_language PARAMS ((const char *name)); - -#endif /* loadinfo.h */
--- a/src/intl/loadmsgcat.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,1322 +0,0 @@ -/* Load needed message catalogs. - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy(). - This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include - <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ -#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE -# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <ctype.h> -#include <errno.h> -#include <fcntl.h> -#include <sys/types.h> -#include <sys/stat.h> - -#ifdef __GNUC__ -# undef alloca -# define alloca __builtin_alloca -# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1 -#else -# ifdef _MSC_VER -# include <malloc.h> -# define alloca _alloca -# else -# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC -# include <alloca.h> -# else -# ifdef _AIX - #pragma alloca -# else -# ifndef alloca -char *alloca (); -# endif -# endif -# endif -# endif -#endif - -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC -# include <unistd.h> -#endif - -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <langinfo.h> -# include <locale.h> -#endif - -#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \ - || (defined _LIBC && defined _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES) -# include <sys/mman.h> -# undef HAVE_MMAP -# define HAVE_MMAP 1 -#else -# undef HAVE_MMAP -#endif - -#if defined HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX || defined _LIBC -# include <stdint.h> -#endif -#if defined HAVE_INTTYPES_H || defined _LIBC -# include <inttypes.h> -#endif - -#include "gmo.h" -#include "gettextP.h" -#include "hash-string.h" -#include "plural-exp.h" - -#ifdef _LIBC -# include "../locale/localeinfo.h" -#endif - -/* Provide fallback values for macros that ought to be defined in <inttypes.h>. - Note that our fallback values need not be literal strings, because we don't - use them with preprocessor string concatenation. */ -#if !defined PRId8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRId8 -# define PRId8 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIi8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIi8 -# define PRIi8 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIo8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIo8 -# define PRIo8 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIu8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIu8 -# define PRIu8 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIx8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIx8 -# define PRIx8 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIX8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIX8 -# define PRIX8 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRId16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRId16 -# define PRId16 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIi16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIi16 -# define PRIi16 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIo16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIo16 -# define PRIo16 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIu16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIu16 -# define PRIu16 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIx16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIx16 -# define PRIx16 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIX16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIX16 -# define PRIX16 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRId32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRId32 -# define PRId32 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIi32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIi32 -# define PRIi32 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIo32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIo32 -# define PRIo32 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIu32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIu32 -# define PRIu32 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIx32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIx32 -# define PRIx32 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIX32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIX32 -# define PRIX32 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRId64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRId64 -# define PRId64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "ld" : "lld") -#endif -#if !defined PRIi64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIi64 -# define PRIi64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "li" : "lli") -#endif -#if !defined PRIo64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIo64 -# define PRIo64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lo" : "llo") -#endif -#if !defined PRIu64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIu64 -# define PRIu64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lu" : "llu") -#endif -#if !defined PRIx64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIx64 -# define PRIx64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lx" : "llx") -#endif -#if !defined PRIX64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIX64 -# define PRIX64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lX" : "llX") -#endif -#if !defined PRIdLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdLEAST8 -# define PRIdLEAST8 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIiLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiLEAST8 -# define PRIiLEAST8 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIoLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoLEAST8 -# define PRIoLEAST8 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIuLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuLEAST8 -# define PRIuLEAST8 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIxLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxLEAST8 -# define PRIxLEAST8 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIXLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXLEAST8 -# define PRIXLEAST8 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRIdLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdLEAST16 -# define PRIdLEAST16 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIiLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiLEAST16 -# define PRIiLEAST16 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIoLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoLEAST16 -# define PRIoLEAST16 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIuLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuLEAST16 -# define PRIuLEAST16 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIxLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxLEAST16 -# define PRIxLEAST16 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIXLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXLEAST16 -# define PRIXLEAST16 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRIdLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdLEAST32 -# define PRIdLEAST32 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIiLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiLEAST32 -# define PRIiLEAST32 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIoLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoLEAST32 -# define PRIoLEAST32 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIuLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuLEAST32 -# define PRIuLEAST32 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIxLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxLEAST32 -# define PRIxLEAST32 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIXLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXLEAST32 -# define PRIXLEAST32 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRIdLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdLEAST64 -# define PRIdLEAST64 PRId64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIiLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiLEAST64 -# define PRIiLEAST64 PRIi64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIoLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoLEAST64 -# define PRIoLEAST64 PRIo64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIuLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuLEAST64 -# define PRIuLEAST64 PRIu64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIxLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxLEAST64 -# define PRIxLEAST64 PRIx64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIXLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXLEAST64 -# define PRIXLEAST64 PRIX64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIdFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdFAST8 -# define PRIdFAST8 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIiFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiFAST8 -# define PRIiFAST8 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIoFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoFAST8 -# define PRIoFAST8 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIuFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuFAST8 -# define PRIuFAST8 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIxFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxFAST8 -# define PRIxFAST8 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIXFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXFAST8 -# define PRIXFAST8 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRIdFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdFAST16 -# define PRIdFAST16 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIiFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiFAST16 -# define PRIiFAST16 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIoFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoFAST16 -# define PRIoFAST16 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIuFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuFAST16 -# define PRIuFAST16 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIxFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxFAST16 -# define PRIxFAST16 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIXFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXFAST16 -# define PRIXFAST16 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRIdFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdFAST32 -# define PRIdFAST32 "d" -#endif -#if !defined PRIiFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiFAST32 -# define PRIiFAST32 "i" -#endif -#if !defined PRIoFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoFAST32 -# define PRIoFAST32 "o" -#endif -#if !defined PRIuFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuFAST32 -# define PRIuFAST32 "u" -#endif -#if !defined PRIxFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxFAST32 -# define PRIxFAST32 "x" -#endif -#if !defined PRIXFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXFAST32 -# define PRIXFAST32 "X" -#endif -#if !defined PRIdFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdFAST64 -# define PRIdFAST64 PRId64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIiFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiFAST64 -# define PRIiFAST64 PRIi64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIoFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoFAST64 -# define PRIoFAST64 PRIo64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIuFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuFAST64 -# define PRIuFAST64 PRIu64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIxFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxFAST64 -# define PRIxFAST64 PRIx64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIXFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXFAST64 -# define PRIXFAST64 PRIX64 -#endif -#if !defined PRIdMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdMAX -# define PRIdMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : "lld") -#endif -#if !defined PRIiMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiMAX -# define PRIiMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : "lli") -#endif -#if !defined PRIoMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoMAX -# define PRIoMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : "llo") -#endif -#if !defined PRIuMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuMAX -# define PRIuMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : "llu") -#endif -#if !defined PRIxMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxMAX -# define PRIxMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : "llx") -#endif -#if !defined PRIXMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXMAX -# define PRIXMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : "llX") -#endif -#if !defined PRIdPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIdPTR -# define PRIdPTR \ - (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : \ - sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "d" : \ - "lld") -#endif -#if !defined PRIiPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIiPTR -# define PRIiPTR \ - (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : \ - sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "i" : \ - "lli") -#endif -#if !defined PRIoPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIoPTR -# define PRIoPTR \ - (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : \ - sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "o" : \ - "llo") -#endif -#if !defined PRIuPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIuPTR -# define PRIuPTR \ - (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : \ - sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "u" : \ - "llu") -#endif -#if !defined PRIxPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIxPTR -# define PRIxPTR \ - (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : \ - sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "x" : \ - "llx") -#endif -#if !defined PRIXPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN -# undef PRIXPTR -# define PRIXPTR \ - (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : \ - sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "X" : \ - "llX") -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Rename the non ISO C functions. This is required by the standard - because some ISO C functions will require linking with this object - file and the name space must not be polluted. */ -# define open __open -# define close __close -# define read __read -# define mmap __mmap -# define munmap __munmap -#endif - -/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add - some additional code emulating it. */ -#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA -# define freea(p) /* nothing */ -#else -# define alloca(n) malloc (n) -# define freea(p) free (p) -#endif - -/* For systems that distinguish between text and binary I/O. - O_BINARY is usually declared in <fcntl.h>. */ -#if !defined O_BINARY && defined _O_BINARY - /* For MSC-compatible compilers. */ -# define O_BINARY _O_BINARY -# define O_TEXT _O_TEXT -#endif -#ifdef __BEOS__ - /* BeOS 5 has O_BINARY and O_TEXT, but they have no effect. */ -# undef O_BINARY -# undef O_TEXT -#endif -/* On reasonable systems, binary I/O is the default. */ -#ifndef O_BINARY -# define O_BINARY 0 -#endif - - -/* Prototypes for local functions. Needed to ensure compiler checking of - function argument counts despite of K&R C function definition syntax. */ -static const char *get_sysdep_segment_value PARAMS ((const char *name)); - - -/* We need a sign, whether a new catalog was loaded, which can be associated - with all translations. This is important if the translations are - cached by one of GCC's features. */ -int _nl_msg_cat_cntr; - - -/* Expand a system dependent string segment. Return NULL if unsupported. */ -static const char * -get_sysdep_segment_value (name) - const char *name; -{ - /* Test for an ISO C 99 section 7.8.1 format string directive. - Syntax: - P R I { d | i | o | u | x | X } - { { | LEAST | FAST } { 8 | 16 | 32 | 64 } | MAX | PTR } */ - /* We don't use a table of 14 times 6 'const char *' strings here, because - data relocations cost startup time. */ - if (name[0] == 'P' && name[1] == 'R' && name[2] == 'I') - { - if (name[3] == 'd' || name[3] == 'i' || name[3] == 'o' || name[3] == 'u' - || name[3] == 'x' || name[3] == 'X') - { - if (name[4] == '8' && name[5] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRId8; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIi8; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIo8; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIu8; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIx8; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIX8; - abort (); - } - if (name[4] == '1' && name[5] == '6' && name[6] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRId16; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIi16; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIo16; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIu16; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIx16; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIX16; - abort (); - } - if (name[4] == '3' && name[5] == '2' && name[6] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRId32; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIi32; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIo32; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIu32; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIx32; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIX32; - abort (); - } - if (name[4] == '6' && name[5] == '4' && name[6] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRId64; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIi64; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIo64; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIu64; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIx64; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIX64; - abort (); - } - if (name[4] == 'L' && name[5] == 'E' && name[6] == 'A' - && name[7] == 'S' && name[8] == 'T') - { - if (name[9] == '8' && name[10] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdLEAST8; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiLEAST8; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoLEAST8; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuLEAST8; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxLEAST8; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXLEAST8; - abort (); - } - if (name[9] == '1' && name[10] == '6' && name[11] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdLEAST16; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiLEAST16; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoLEAST16; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuLEAST16; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxLEAST16; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXLEAST16; - abort (); - } - if (name[9] == '3' && name[10] == '2' && name[11] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdLEAST32; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiLEAST32; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoLEAST32; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuLEAST32; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxLEAST32; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXLEAST32; - abort (); - } - if (name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '4' && name[11] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdLEAST64; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiLEAST64; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoLEAST64; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuLEAST64; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxLEAST64; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXLEAST64; - abort (); - } - } - if (name[4] == 'F' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'S' - && name[7] == 'T') - { - if (name[8] == '8' && name[9] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdFAST8; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiFAST8; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoFAST8; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuFAST8; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxFAST8; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXFAST8; - abort (); - } - if (name[8] == '1' && name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdFAST16; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiFAST16; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoFAST16; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuFAST16; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxFAST16; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXFAST16; - abort (); - } - if (name[8] == '3' && name[9] == '2' && name[10] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdFAST32; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiFAST32; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoFAST32; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuFAST32; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxFAST32; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXFAST32; - abort (); - } - if (name[8] == '6' && name[9] == '4' && name[10] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdFAST64; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiFAST64; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoFAST64; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuFAST64; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxFAST64; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXFAST64; - abort (); - } - } - if (name[4] == 'M' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'X' - && name[7] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdMAX; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiMAX; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoMAX; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuMAX; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxMAX; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXMAX; - abort (); - } - if (name[4] == 'P' && name[5] == 'T' && name[6] == 'R' - && name[7] == '\0') - { - if (name[3] == 'd') - return PRIdPTR; - if (name[3] == 'i') - return PRIiPTR; - if (name[3] == 'o') - return PRIoPTR; - if (name[3] == 'u') - return PRIuPTR; - if (name[3] == 'x') - return PRIxPTR; - if (name[3] == 'X') - return PRIXPTR; - abort (); - } - } - } - /* Other system dependent strings are not valid. */ - return NULL; -} - -/* Initialize the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog. - Return the header entry. */ -const char * -internal_function -_nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding) - struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file; - struct loaded_domain *domain; - struct binding *domainbinding; -{ - /* Find out about the character set the file is encoded with. - This can be found (in textual form) in the entry "". If this - entry does not exist or if this does not contain the `charset=' - information, we will assume the charset matches the one the - current locale and we don't have to perform any conversion. */ - char *nullentry; - size_t nullentrylen; - - /* Preinitialize fields, to avoid recursion during _nl_find_msg. */ - domain->codeset_cntr = - (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0); -#ifdef _LIBC - domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1; -#else -# if HAVE_ICONV - domain->conv = (iconv_t) -1; -# endif -#endif - domain->conv_tab = NULL; - - /* Get the header entry. */ - nullentry = _nl_find_msg (domain_file, domainbinding, "", &nullentrylen); - - if (nullentry != NULL) - { -#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV - const char *charsetstr; - - charsetstr = strstr (nullentry, "charset="); - if (charsetstr != NULL) - { - size_t len; - char *charset; - const char *outcharset; - - charsetstr += strlen ("charset="); - len = strcspn (charsetstr, " \t\n"); - - charset = (char *) alloca (len + 1); -# if defined _LIBC || HAVE_MEMPCPY - *((char *) mempcpy (charset, charsetstr, len)) = '\0'; -# else - memcpy (charset, charsetstr, len); - charset[len] = '\0'; -# endif - - /* The output charset should normally be determined by the - locale. But sometimes the locale is not used or not correctly - set up, so we provide a possibility for the user to override - this. Moreover, the value specified through - bind_textdomain_codeset overrides both. */ - if (domainbinding != NULL && domainbinding->codeset != NULL) - outcharset = domainbinding->codeset; - else - { - outcharset = getenv ("OUTPUT_CHARSET"); - if (outcharset == NULL || outcharset[0] == '\0') - { -# ifdef _LIBC - outcharset = _NL_CURRENT (LC_CTYPE, CODESET); -# else -# if HAVE_ICONV - extern const char *locale_charset PARAMS ((void)); - outcharset = locale_charset (); -# endif -# endif - } - } - -# ifdef _LIBC - /* We always want to use transliteration. */ - outcharset = norm_add_slashes (outcharset, "TRANSLIT"); - charset = norm_add_slashes (charset, NULL); - if (__gconv_open (outcharset, charset, &domain->conv, - GCONV_AVOID_NOCONV) - != __GCONV_OK) - domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1; -# else -# if HAVE_ICONV - /* When using GNU libc >= 2.2 or GNU libiconv >= 1.5, - we want to use transliteration. */ -# if (__GLIBC__ == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ >= 2) || __GLIBC__ > 2 \ - || _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0105 - if (strchr (outcharset, '/') == NULL) - { - char *tmp; - - len = strlen (outcharset); - tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 10 + 1); - memcpy (tmp, outcharset, len); - memcpy (tmp + len, "//TRANSLIT", 10 + 1); - outcharset = tmp; - - domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset); - - freea (outcharset); - } - else -# endif - domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset); -# endif -# endif - - freea (charset); - } -#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */ - } - - return nullentry; -} - -/* Frees the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog. */ -void -internal_function -_nl_free_domain_conv (domain) - struct loaded_domain *domain; -{ - if (domain->conv_tab != NULL && domain->conv_tab != (char **) -1) - free (domain->conv_tab); - -#ifdef _LIBC - if (domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1) - __gconv_close (domain->conv); -#else -# if HAVE_ICONV - if (domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1) - iconv_close (domain->conv); -# endif -#endif -} - -/* Load the message catalogs specified by FILENAME. If it is no valid - message catalog do nothing. */ -void -internal_function -_nl_load_domain (domain_file, domainbinding) - struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file; - struct binding *domainbinding; -{ - int fd; - size_t size; -#ifdef _LIBC - struct stat64 st; -#else - struct stat st; -#endif - struct mo_file_header *data = (struct mo_file_header *) -1; - int use_mmap = 0; - struct loaded_domain *domain; - int revision; - const char *nullentry; - - domain_file->decided = 1; - domain_file->data = NULL; - - /* Note that it would be useless to store domainbinding in domain_file - because domainbinding might be == NULL now but != NULL later (after - a call to bind_textdomain_codeset). */ - - /* If the record does not represent a valid locale the FILENAME - might be NULL. This can happen when according to the given - specification the locale file name is different for XPG and CEN - syntax. */ - if (domain_file->filename == NULL) - return; - - /* Try to open the addressed file. */ - fd = open (domain_file->filename, O_RDONLY | O_BINARY); - if (fd == -1) - return; - - /* We must know about the size of the file. */ - if ( -#ifdef _LIBC - __builtin_expect (fstat64 (fd, &st) != 0, 0) -#else - __builtin_expect (fstat (fd, &st) != 0, 0) -#endif - || __builtin_expect ((size = (size_t) st.st_size) != st.st_size, 0) - || __builtin_expect (size < sizeof (struct mo_file_header), 0)) - { - /* Something went wrong. */ - close (fd); - return; - } - -#ifdef HAVE_MMAP - /* Now we are ready to load the file. If mmap() is available we try - this first. If not available or it failed we try to load it. */ - data = (struct mo_file_header *) mmap (NULL, size, PROT_READ, - MAP_PRIVATE, fd, 0); - - if (__builtin_expect (data != (struct mo_file_header *) -1, 1)) - { - /* mmap() call was successful. */ - close (fd); - use_mmap = 1; - } -#endif - - /* If the data is not yet available (i.e. mmap'ed) we try to load - it manually. */ - if (data == (struct mo_file_header *) -1) - { - size_t to_read; - char *read_ptr; - - data = (struct mo_file_header *) malloc (size); - if (data == NULL) - return; - - to_read = size; - read_ptr = (char *) data; - do - { - long int nb = (long int) read (fd, read_ptr, to_read); - if (nb <= 0) - { -#ifdef EINTR - if (nb == -1 && errno == EINTR) - continue; -#endif - close (fd); - return; - } - read_ptr += nb; - to_read -= nb; - } - while (to_read > 0); - - close (fd); - } - - /* Using the magic number we can test whether it really is a message - catalog file. */ - if (__builtin_expect (data->magic != _MAGIC && data->magic != _MAGIC_SWAPPED, - 0)) - { - /* The magic number is wrong: not a message catalog file. */ -#ifdef HAVE_MMAP - if (use_mmap) - munmap ((caddr_t) data, size); - else -#endif - free (data); - return; - } - - domain = (struct loaded_domain *) malloc (sizeof (struct loaded_domain)); - if (domain == NULL) - return; - domain_file->data = domain; - - domain->data = (char *) data; - domain->use_mmap = use_mmap; - domain->mmap_size = size; - domain->must_swap = data->magic != _MAGIC; - domain->malloced = NULL; - - /* Fill in the information about the available tables. */ - revision = W (domain->must_swap, data->revision); - /* We support only the major revision 0. */ - switch (revision >> 16) - { - case 0: - domain->nstrings = W (domain->must_swap, data->nstrings); - domain->orig_tab = (const struct string_desc *) - ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_tab_offset)); - domain->trans_tab = (const struct string_desc *) - ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_tab_offset)); - domain->hash_size = W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_size); - domain->hash_tab = - (domain->hash_size > 2 - ? (const nls_uint32 *) - ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_offset)) - : NULL); - domain->must_swap_hash_tab = domain->must_swap; - - /* Now dispatch on the minor revision. */ - switch (revision & 0xffff) - { - case 0: - domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0; - domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL; - domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL; - break; - case 1: - default: - { - nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings; - - if (domain->hash_tab == NULL) - /* This is invalid. These minor revisions need a hash table. */ - goto invalid; - - n_sysdep_strings = - W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_strings); - if (n_sysdep_strings > 0) - { - nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments; - const struct sysdep_segment *sysdep_segments; - const char **sysdep_segment_values; - const nls_uint32 *orig_sysdep_tab; - const nls_uint32 *trans_sysdep_tab; - size_t memneed; - char *mem; - struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_orig_sysdep_tab; - struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_trans_sysdep_tab; - nls_uint32 *inmem_hash_tab; - unsigned int i; - - /* Get the values of the system dependent segments. */ - n_sysdep_segments = - W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_segments); - sysdep_segments = (const struct sysdep_segment *) - ((char *) data - + W (domain->must_swap, data->sysdep_segments_offset)); - sysdep_segment_values = - alloca (n_sysdep_segments * sizeof (const char *)); - for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_segments; i++) - { - const char *name = - (char *) data - + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].offset); - nls_uint32 namelen = - W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].length); - - if (!(namelen > 0 && name[namelen - 1] == '\0')) - { - freea (sysdep_segment_values); - goto invalid; - } - - sysdep_segment_values[i] = get_sysdep_segment_value (name); - } - - orig_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *) - ((char *) data - + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_sysdep_tab_offset)); - trans_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *) - ((char *) data - + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_sysdep_tab_offset)); - - /* Compute the amount of additional memory needed for the - system dependent strings and the augmented hash table. */ - memneed = 2 * n_sysdep_strings - * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc) - + domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32); - for (i = 0; i < 2 * n_sysdep_strings; i++) - { - const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string = - (const struct sysdep_string *) - ((char *) data - + W (domain->must_swap, - i < n_sysdep_strings - ? orig_sysdep_tab[i] - : trans_sysdep_tab[i - n_sysdep_strings])); - size_t need = 0; - const struct segment_pair *p = sysdep_string->segments; - - if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref) != SEGMENTS_END) - for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++) - { - nls_uint32 sysdepref; - - need += W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize); - - sysdepref = W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref); - if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END) - break; - - if (sysdepref >= n_sysdep_segments) - { - /* Invalid. */ - freea (sysdep_segment_values); - goto invalid; - } - - need += strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]); - } - - memneed += need; - } - - /* Allocate additional memory. */ - mem = (char *) malloc (memneed); - if (mem == NULL) - goto invalid; - - domain->malloced = mem; - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem; - mem += n_sysdep_strings * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc); - inmem_trans_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem; - mem += n_sysdep_strings * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc); - inmem_hash_tab = (nls_uint32 *) mem; - mem += domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32); - - /* Compute the system dependent strings. */ - for (i = 0; i < 2 * n_sysdep_strings; i++) - { - const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string = - (const struct sysdep_string *) - ((char *) data - + W (domain->must_swap, - i < n_sysdep_strings - ? orig_sysdep_tab[i] - : trans_sysdep_tab[i - n_sysdep_strings])); - const char *static_segments = - (char *) data - + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_string->offset); - const struct segment_pair *p = sysdep_string->segments; - - /* Concatenate the segments, and fill - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i] (for i < n_sysdep_strings) and - inmem_trans_sysdep_tab[i-n_sysdep_strings] (for - i >= n_sysdep_strings). */ - - if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref) == SEGMENTS_END) - { - /* Only one static segment. */ - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].length = - W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize); - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer = static_segments; - } - else - { - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer = mem; - - for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++) - { - nls_uint32 segsize = - W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize); - nls_uint32 sysdepref = - W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref); - size_t n; - - if (segsize > 0) - { - memcpy (mem, static_segments, segsize); - mem += segsize; - static_segments += segsize; - } - - if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END) - break; - - n = strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]); - memcpy (mem, sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref], n); - mem += n; - } - - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].length = - mem - inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer; - } - } - - /* Compute the augmented hash table. */ - for (i = 0; i < domain->hash_size; i++) - inmem_hash_tab[i] = - W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[i]); - for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_strings; i++) - { - const char *msgid = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer; - nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid); - nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size; - nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2)); - - for (;;) - { - if (inmem_hash_tab[idx] == 0) - { - /* Hash table entry is empty. Use it. */ - inmem_hash_tab[idx] = 1 + domain->nstrings + i; - break; - } - - if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr) - idx -= domain->hash_size - incr; - else - idx += incr; - } - } - - freea (sysdep_segment_values); - - domain->n_sysdep_strings = n_sysdep_strings; - domain->orig_sysdep_tab = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab; - domain->trans_sysdep_tab = inmem_trans_sysdep_tab; - - domain->hash_tab = inmem_hash_tab; - domain->must_swap_hash_tab = 0; - } - else - { - domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0; - domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL; - domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL; - } - } - break; - } - break; - default: - /* This is an invalid revision. */ - invalid: - /* This is an invalid .mo file. */ - if (domain->malloced) - free (domain->malloced); -#ifdef HAVE_MMAP - if (use_mmap) - munmap ((caddr_t) data, size); - else -#endif - free (data); - free (domain); - domain_file->data = NULL; - return; - } - - /* Now initialize the character set converter from the character set - the file is encoded with (found in the header entry) to the domain's - specified character set or the locale's character set. */ - nullentry = _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding); - - /* Also look for a plural specification. */ - EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (nullentry, &domain->plural, &domain->nplurals); -} - - -#ifdef _LIBC -void -internal_function -_nl_unload_domain (domain) - struct loaded_domain *domain; -{ - if (domain->plural != &__gettext_germanic_plural) - __gettext_free_exp (domain->plural); - - _nl_free_domain_conv (domain); - - if (domain->malloced) - free (domain->malloced); - -# ifdef _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES - if (domain->use_mmap) - munmap ((caddr_t) domain->data, domain->mmap_size); - else -# endif /* _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES */ - free ((void *) domain->data); - - free (domain); -} -#endif
--- a/src/intl/localcharset.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,398 +0,0 @@ -/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding. - - Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -/* Specification. */ -#include "localcharset.h" - -#if HAVE_STDDEF_H -# include <stddef.h> -#endif - -#include <stdio.h> -#if HAVE_STRING_H -# include <string.h> -#else -# include <strings.h> -#endif -#if HAVE_STDLIB_H -# include <stdlib.h> -#endif - -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ -# undef WIN32 /* avoid warning on mingw32 */ -# define WIN32 -#endif - -#if defined __EMX__ -/* Assume EMX program runs on OS/2, even if compiled under DOS. */ -# define OS2 -#endif - -#if !defined WIN32 -# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET -# include <langinfo.h> -# else -# if HAVE_SETLOCALE -# include <locale.h> -# endif -# endif -#elif defined WIN32 -# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -# include <windows.h> -#endif -#if defined OS2 -# define INCL_DOS -# include <os2.h> -#endif - -#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE -# include "relocatable.h" -#else -# define relocate(pathname) (pathname) -#endif - -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ - /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') -#endif - -#ifndef DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR -# define DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR '/' -#endif - -#ifndef ISSLASH -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR) -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_GETC_UNLOCKED -# undef getc -# define getc getc_unlocked -#endif - -/* The following static variable is declared 'volatile' to avoid a - possible multithread problem in the function get_charset_aliases. If we - are running in a threaded environment, and if two threads initialize - 'charset_aliases' simultaneously, both will produce the same value, - and everything will be ok if the two assignments to 'charset_aliases' - are atomic. But I don't know what will happen if the two assignments mix. */ -#if __STDC__ != 1 -# define volatile /* empty */ -#endif -/* Pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file, if it has already been - read, else NULL. Its format is: - ALIAS_1 '\0' CANONICAL_1 '\0' ... ALIAS_n '\0' CANONICAL_n '\0' '\0' */ -static const char * volatile charset_aliases; - -/* Return a pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file. */ -static const char * -get_charset_aliases () -{ - const char *cp; - - cp = charset_aliases; - if (cp == NULL) - { -#if !(defined VMS || defined WIN32) - FILE *fp; - const char *dir = relocate (LIBDIR); - const char *base = "charset.alias"; - char *file_name; - - /* Concatenate dir and base into freshly allocated file_name. */ - { - size_t dir_len = strlen (dir); - size_t base_len = strlen (base); - int add_slash = (dir_len > 0 && !ISSLASH (dir[dir_len - 1])); - file_name = (char *) malloc (dir_len + add_slash + base_len + 1); - if (file_name != NULL) - { - memcpy (file_name, dir, dir_len); - if (add_slash) - file_name[dir_len] = DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR; - memcpy (file_name + dir_len + add_slash, base, base_len + 1); - } - } - - if (file_name == NULL || (fp = fopen (file_name, "r")) == NULL) - /* Out of memory or file not found, treat it as empty. */ - cp = ""; - else - { - /* Parse the file's contents. */ - int c; - char buf1[50+1]; - char buf2[50+1]; - char *res_ptr = NULL; - size_t res_size = 0; - size_t l1, l2; - - for (;;) - { - c = getc (fp); - if (c == EOF) - break; - if (c == '\n' || c == ' ' || c == '\t') - continue; - if (c == '#') - { - /* Skip comment, to end of line. */ - do - c = getc (fp); - while (!(c == EOF || c == '\n')); - if (c == EOF) - break; - continue; - } - ungetc (c, fp); - if (fscanf (fp, "%50s %50s", buf1, buf2) < 2) - break; - l1 = strlen (buf1); - l2 = strlen (buf2); - if (res_size == 0) - { - res_size = l1 + 1 + l2 + 1; - res_ptr = (char *) malloc (res_size + 1); - } - else - { - res_size += l1 + 1 + l2 + 1; - res_ptr = (char *) realloc (res_ptr, res_size + 1); - } - if (res_ptr == NULL) - { - /* Out of memory. */ - res_size = 0; - break; - } - strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1) - (l1 + 1), buf1); - strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1), buf2); - } - fclose (fp); - if (res_size == 0) - cp = ""; - else - { - *(res_ptr + res_size) = '\0'; - cp = res_ptr; - } - } - - if (file_name != NULL) - free (file_name); - -#else - -# if defined VMS - /* To avoid the troubles of an extra file charset.alias_vms in the - sources of many GNU packages, simply inline the aliases here. */ - /* The list of encodings is taken from the OpenVMS 7.3-1 documentation - "Compaq C Run-Time Library Reference Manual for OpenVMS systems" - section 10.7 "Handling Different Character Sets". */ - cp = "ISO8859-1" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0" - "ISO8859-2" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0" - "ISO8859-5" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0" - "ISO8859-7" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0" - "ISO8859-8" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0" - "ISO8859-9" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0" - /* Japanese */ - "eucJP" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0" - "SJIS" "\0" "SHIFT_JIS" "\0" - "DECKANJI" "\0" "DEC-KANJI" "\0" - "SDECKANJI" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0" - /* Chinese */ - "eucTW" "\0" "EUC-TW" "\0" - "DECHANYU" "\0" "DEC-HANYU" "\0" - "DECHANZI" "\0" "GB2312" "\0" - /* Korean */ - "DECKOREAN" "\0" "EUC-KR" "\0"; -# endif - -# if defined WIN32 - /* To avoid the troubles of installing a separate file in the same - directory as the DLL and of retrieving the DLL's directory at - runtime, simply inline the aliases here. */ - - cp = "CP936" "\0" "GBK" "\0" - "CP1361" "\0" "JOHAB" "\0" - "CP20127" "\0" "ASCII" "\0" - "CP20866" "\0" "KOI8-R" "\0" - "CP21866" "\0" "KOI8-RU" "\0" - "CP28591" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0" - "CP28592" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0" - "CP28593" "\0" "ISO-8859-3" "\0" - "CP28594" "\0" "ISO-8859-4" "\0" - "CP28595" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0" - "CP28596" "\0" "ISO-8859-6" "\0" - "CP28597" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0" - "CP28598" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0" - "CP28599" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0" - "CP28605" "\0" "ISO-8859-15" "\0"; -# endif -#endif - - charset_aliases = cp; - } - - return cp; -} - -/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it - into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset. - The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated. - If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical - name. */ - -#ifdef STATIC -STATIC -#endif -const char * -locale_charset () -{ - const char *codeset; - const char *aliases; - -#if !(defined WIN32 || defined OS2) - -# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET - - /* Most systems support nl_langinfo (CODESET) nowadays. */ - codeset = nl_langinfo (CODESET); - -# else - - /* On old systems which lack it, use setlocale or getenv. */ - const char *locale = NULL; - - /* But most old systems don't have a complete set of locales. Some - (like SunOS 4 or DJGPP) have only the C locale. Therefore we don't - use setlocale here; it would return "C" when it doesn't support the - locale name the user has set. */ -# if HAVE_SETLOCALE && 0 - locale = setlocale (LC_CTYPE, NULL); -# endif - if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') - { - locale = getenv ("LC_ALL"); - if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') - { - locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE"); - if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') - locale = getenv ("LANG"); - } - } - - /* On some old systems, one used to set locale = "iso8859_1". On others, - you set it to "language_COUNTRY.charset". In any case, we resolve it - through the charset.alias file. */ - codeset = locale; - -# endif - -#elif defined WIN32 - - static char buf[2 + 10 + 1]; - - /* Woe32 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number. */ - sprintf (buf, "CP%u", GetACP ()); - codeset = buf; - -#elif defined OS2 - - const char *locale; - static char buf[2 + 10 + 1]; - ULONG cp[3]; - ULONG cplen; - - /* Allow user to override the codeset, as set in the operating system, - with standard language environment variables. */ - locale = getenv ("LC_ALL"); - if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') - { - locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE"); - if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0') - locale = getenv ("LANG"); - } - if (locale != NULL && locale[0] != '\0') - { - /* If the locale name contains an encoding after the dot, return it. */ - const char *dot = strchr (locale, '.'); - - if (dot != NULL) - { - const char *modifier; - - dot++; - /* Look for the possible @... trailer and remove it, if any. */ - modifier = strchr (dot, '@'); - if (modifier == NULL) - return dot; - if (modifier - dot < sizeof (buf)) - { - memcpy (buf, dot, modifier - dot); - buf [modifier - dot] = '\0'; - return buf; - } - } - - /* Resolve through the charset.alias file. */ - codeset = locale; - } - else - { - /* OS/2 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number. */ - if (DosQueryCp (sizeof (cp), cp, &cplen)) - codeset = ""; - else - { - sprintf (buf, "CP%u", cp[0]); - codeset = buf; - } - } - -#endif - - if (codeset == NULL) - /* The canonical name cannot be determined. */ - codeset = ""; - - /* Resolve alias. */ - for (aliases = get_charset_aliases (); - *aliases != '\0'; - aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1, aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1) - if (strcmp (codeset, aliases) == 0 - || (aliases[0] == '*' && aliases[1] == '\0')) - { - codeset = aliases + strlen (aliases) + 1; - break; - } - - /* Don't return an empty string. GNU libc and GNU libiconv interpret - the empty string as denoting "the locale's character encoding", - thus GNU libiconv would call this function a second time. */ - if (codeset[0] == '\0') - codeset = "ASCII"; - - return codeset; -}
--- a/src/intl/localcharset.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,42 +0,0 @@ -/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding. - Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - This file is part of the GNU CHARSET Library. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef _LOCALCHARSET_H -#define _LOCALCHARSET_H - - -#ifdef __cplusplus -extern "C" { -#endif - - -/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it - into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset. - The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated. - If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical - name. */ -extern const char * locale_charset (void); - - -#ifdef __cplusplus -} -#endif - - -#endif /* _LOCALCHARSET_H */
--- a/src/intl/locale.alias Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,78 +0,0 @@ -# Locale name alias data base. -# Copyright (C) 1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -# -# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it -# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published -# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) -# any later version. -# -# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, -# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of -# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU -# Library General Public License for more details. -# -# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public -# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software -# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, -# USA. - -# The format of this file is the same as for the corresponding file of -# the X Window System, which normally can be found in -# /usr/lib/X11/locale/locale.alias -# A single line contains two fields: an alias and a substitution value. -# All entries are case independent. - -# Note: This file is far from being complete. If you have a value for -# your own site which you think might be useful for others too, share -# it with the rest of us. Send it using the `glibcbug' script to -# bugs@gnu.org. - -# Packages using this file: - -bokmal no_NO.ISO-8859-1 -bokmål no_NO.ISO-8859-1 -catalan ca_ES.ISO-8859-1 -croatian hr_HR.ISO-8859-2 -czech cs_CZ.ISO-8859-2 -danish da_DK.ISO-8859-1 -dansk da_DK.ISO-8859-1 -deutsch de_DE.ISO-8859-1 -dutch nl_NL.ISO-8859-1 -eesti et_EE.ISO-8859-1 -estonian et_EE.ISO-8859-1 -finnish fi_FI.ISO-8859-1 -français fr_FR.ISO-8859-1 -french fr_FR.ISO-8859-1 -galego gl_ES.ISO-8859-1 -galician gl_ES.ISO-8859-1 -german de_DE.ISO-8859-1 -greek el_GR.ISO-8859-7 -hebrew he_IL.ISO-8859-8 -hrvatski hr_HR.ISO-8859-2 -hungarian hu_HU.ISO-8859-2 -icelandic is_IS.ISO-8859-1 -italian it_IT.ISO-8859-1 -japanese ja_JP.eucJP -japanese.euc ja_JP.eucJP -ja_JP ja_JP.eucJP -ja_JP.ujis ja_JP.eucJP -japanese.sjis ja_JP.SJIS -korean ko_KR.eucKR -korean.euc ko_KR.eucKR -ko_KR ko_KR.eucKR -lithuanian lt_LT.ISO-8859-13 -nb_NO no_NO.ISO-8859-1 -nb_NO.ISO-8859-1 no_NO.ISO-8859-1 -norwegian no_NO.ISO-8859-1 -nynorsk nn_NO.ISO-8859-1 -polish pl_PL.ISO-8859-2 -portuguese pt_PT.ISO-8859-1 -romanian ro_RO.ISO-8859-2 -russian ru_RU.ISO-8859-5 -slovak sk_SK.ISO-8859-2 -slovene sl_SI.ISO-8859-2 -slovenian sl_SI.ISO-8859-2 -spanish es_ES.ISO-8859-1 -swedish sv_SE.ISO-8859-1 -thai th_TH.TIS-620 -turkish tr_TR.ISO-8859-9
--- a/src/intl/localealias.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,419 +0,0 @@ -/* Handle aliases for locale names. - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy(). - This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include - <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ -#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE -# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <ctype.h> -#include <stdio.h> -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE___FSETLOCKING -# include <stdio_ext.h> -#endif -#include <sys/types.h> - -#ifdef __GNUC__ -# undef alloca -# define alloca __builtin_alloca -# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1 -#else -# ifdef _MSC_VER -# include <malloc.h> -# define alloca _alloca -# else -# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC -# include <alloca.h> -# else -# ifdef _AIX - #pragma alloca -# else -# ifndef alloca -char *alloca (); -# endif -# endif -# endif -# endif -#endif - -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#include "gettextP.h" - -#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE -# include "relocatable.h" -#else -# define relocate(pathname) (pathname) -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Rename the non ANSI C functions. This is required by the standard - because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object - file and the name space must not be polluted. */ -# define strcasecmp __strcasecmp - -# ifndef mempcpy -# define mempcpy __mempcpy -# endif -# define HAVE_MEMPCPY 1 -# define HAVE___FSETLOCKING 1 - -/* We need locking here since we can be called from different places. */ -# include <bits/libc-lock.h> - -__libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock); -#endif - -#ifndef internal_function -# define internal_function -#endif - -/* Some optimizations for glibc. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define FEOF(fp) feof_unlocked (fp) -# define FGETS(buf, n, fp) fgets_unlocked (buf, n, fp) -#else -# define FEOF(fp) feof (fp) -# define FGETS(buf, n, fp) fgets (buf, n, fp) -#endif - -/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add - some additional code emulating it. */ -#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA -# define freea(p) /* nothing */ -#else -# define alloca(n) malloc (n) -# define freea(p) free (p) -#endif - -#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || defined HAVE_FGETS_UNLOCKED -# undef fgets -# define fgets(buf, len, s) fgets_unlocked (buf, len, s) -#endif -#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || defined HAVE_FEOF_UNLOCKED -# undef feof -# define feof(s) feof_unlocked (s) -#endif - - -struct alias_map -{ - const char *alias; - const char *value; -}; - - -#ifndef _LIBC -# define libc_freeres_ptr(decl) decl -#endif - -libc_freeres_ptr (static char *string_space); -static size_t string_space_act; -static size_t string_space_max; -libc_freeres_ptr (static struct alias_map *map); -static size_t nmap; -static size_t maxmap; - - -/* Prototypes for local functions. */ -static size_t read_alias_file PARAMS ((const char *fname, int fname_len)) - internal_function; -static int extend_alias_table PARAMS ((void)); -static int alias_compare PARAMS ((const struct alias_map *map1, - const struct alias_map *map2)); - - -const char * -_nl_expand_alias (name) - const char *name; -{ - static const char *locale_alias_path; - struct alias_map *retval; - const char *result = NULL; - size_t added; - -#ifdef _LIBC - __libc_lock_lock (lock); -#endif - - if (locale_alias_path == NULL) - locale_alias_path = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH; - - do - { - struct alias_map item; - - item.alias = name; - - if (nmap > 0) - retval = (struct alias_map *) bsearch (&item, map, nmap, - sizeof (struct alias_map), - (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *, - const void *)) - ) alias_compare); - else - retval = NULL; - - /* We really found an alias. Return the value. */ - if (retval != NULL) - { - result = retval->value; - break; - } - - /* Perhaps we can find another alias file. */ - added = 0; - while (added == 0 && locale_alias_path[0] != '\0') - { - const char *start; - - while (locale_alias_path[0] == PATH_SEPARATOR) - ++locale_alias_path; - start = locale_alias_path; - - while (locale_alias_path[0] != '\0' - && locale_alias_path[0] != PATH_SEPARATOR) - ++locale_alias_path; - - if (start < locale_alias_path) - added = read_alias_file (start, locale_alias_path - start); - } - } - while (added != 0); - -#ifdef _LIBC - __libc_lock_unlock (lock); -#endif - - return result; -} - - -static size_t -internal_function -read_alias_file (fname, fname_len) - const char *fname; - int fname_len; -{ - FILE *fp; - char *full_fname; - size_t added; - static const char aliasfile[] = "/locale.alias"; - - full_fname = (char *) alloca (fname_len + sizeof aliasfile); -#ifdef HAVE_MEMPCPY - mempcpy (mempcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len), - aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile); -#else - memcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len); - memcpy (&full_fname[fname_len], aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile); -#endif - - fp = fopen (relocate (full_fname), "r"); - freea (full_fname); - if (fp == NULL) - return 0; - -#ifdef HAVE___FSETLOCKING - /* No threads present. */ - __fsetlocking (fp, FSETLOCKING_BYCALLER); -#endif - - added = 0; - while (!FEOF (fp)) - { - /* It is a reasonable approach to use a fix buffer here because - a) we are only interested in the first two fields - b) these fields must be usable as file names and so must not - be that long - We avoid a multi-kilobyte buffer here since this would use up - stack space which we might not have if the program ran out of - memory. */ - char buf[400]; - char *alias; - char *value; - char *cp; - - if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL) - /* EOF reached. */ - break; - - cp = buf; - /* Ignore leading white space. */ - while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) - ++cp; - - /* A leading '#' signals a comment line. */ - if (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '#') - { - alias = cp++; - while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) - ++cp; - /* Terminate alias name. */ - if (cp[0] != '\0') - *cp++ = '\0'; - - /* Now look for the beginning of the value. */ - while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) - ++cp; - - if (cp[0] != '\0') - { - size_t alias_len; - size_t value_len; - - value = cp++; - while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0])) - ++cp; - /* Terminate value. */ - if (cp[0] == '\n') - { - /* This has to be done to make the following test - for the end of line possible. We are looking for - the terminating '\n' which do not overwrite here. */ - *cp++ = '\0'; - *cp = '\n'; - } - else if (cp[0] != '\0') - *cp++ = '\0'; - - if (nmap >= maxmap) - if (__builtin_expect (extend_alias_table (), 0)) - return added; - - alias_len = strlen (alias) + 1; - value_len = strlen (value) + 1; - - if (string_space_act + alias_len + value_len > string_space_max) - { - /* Increase size of memory pool. */ - size_t new_size = (string_space_max - + (alias_len + value_len > 1024 - ? alias_len + value_len : 1024)); - char *new_pool = (char *) realloc (string_space, new_size); - if (new_pool == NULL) - return added; - - if (__builtin_expect (string_space != new_pool, 0)) - { - size_t i; - - for (i = 0; i < nmap; i++) - { - map[i].alias += new_pool - string_space; - map[i].value += new_pool - string_space; - } - } - - string_space = new_pool; - string_space_max = new_size; - } - - map[nmap].alias = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act], - alias, alias_len); - string_space_act += alias_len; - - map[nmap].value = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act], - value, value_len); - string_space_act += value_len; - - ++nmap; - ++added; - } - } - - /* Possibly not the whole line fits into the buffer. Ignore - the rest of the line. */ - while (strchr (buf, '\n') == NULL) - if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL) - /* Make sure the inner loop will be left. The outer loop - will exit at the `feof' test. */ - break; - } - - /* Should we test for ferror()? I think we have to silently ignore - errors. --drepper */ - fclose (fp); - - if (added > 0) - qsort (map, nmap, sizeof (struct alias_map), - (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *, const void *))) alias_compare); - - return added; -} - - -static int -extend_alias_table () -{ - size_t new_size; - struct alias_map *new_map; - - new_size = maxmap == 0 ? 100 : 2 * maxmap; - new_map = (struct alias_map *) realloc (map, (new_size - * sizeof (struct alias_map))); - if (new_map == NULL) - /* Simply don't extend: we don't have any more core. */ - return -1; - - map = new_map; - maxmap = new_size; - return 0; -} - - -static int -alias_compare (map1, map2) - const struct alias_map *map1; - const struct alias_map *map2; -{ -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRCASECMP - return strcasecmp (map1->alias, map2->alias); -#else - const unsigned char *p1 = (const unsigned char *) map1->alias; - const unsigned char *p2 = (const unsigned char *) map2->alias; - unsigned char c1, c2; - - if (p1 == p2) - return 0; - - do - { - /* I know this seems to be odd but the tolower() function in - some systems libc cannot handle nonalpha characters. */ - c1 = isupper (*p1) ? tolower (*p1) : *p1; - c2 = isupper (*p2) ? tolower (*p2) : *p2; - if (c1 == '\0') - break; - ++p1; - ++p2; - } - while (c1 == c2); - - return c1 - c2; -#endif -}
--- a/src/intl/localename.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,772 +0,0 @@ -/* Determine the current selected locale. - Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995. */ -/* Win32 code written by Tor Lillqvist <tml@iki.fi>. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <locale.h> - -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ -# undef WIN32 /* avoid warning on mingw32 */ -# define WIN32 -#endif - -#ifdef WIN32 -# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -# include <windows.h> -/* Mingw headers don't have latest language and sublanguage codes. */ -# ifndef LANG_AFRIKAANS -# define LANG_AFRIKAANS 0x36 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_ALBANIAN -# define LANG_ALBANIAN 0x1c -# endif -# ifndef LANG_ARABIC -# define LANG_ARABIC 0x01 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_ARMENIAN -# define LANG_ARMENIAN 0x2b -# endif -# ifndef LANG_ASSAMESE -# define LANG_ASSAMESE 0x4d -# endif -# ifndef LANG_AZERI -# define LANG_AZERI 0x2c -# endif -# ifndef LANG_BASQUE -# define LANG_BASQUE 0x2d -# endif -# ifndef LANG_BELARUSIAN -# define LANG_BELARUSIAN 0x23 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_BENGALI -# define LANG_BENGALI 0x45 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_CATALAN -# define LANG_CATALAN 0x03 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_DIVEHI -# define LANG_DIVEHI 0x65 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_ESTONIAN -# define LANG_ESTONIAN 0x25 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_FAEROESE -# define LANG_FAEROESE 0x38 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_FARSI -# define LANG_FARSI 0x29 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_GALICIAN -# define LANG_GALICIAN 0x56 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_GEORGIAN -# define LANG_GEORGIAN 0x37 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_GUJARATI -# define LANG_GUJARATI 0x47 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_HEBREW -# define LANG_HEBREW 0x0d -# endif -# ifndef LANG_HINDI -# define LANG_HINDI 0x39 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_INDONESIAN -# define LANG_INDONESIAN 0x21 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_KANNADA -# define LANG_KANNADA 0x4b -# endif -# ifndef LANG_KASHMIRI -# define LANG_KASHMIRI 0x60 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_KAZAK -# define LANG_KAZAK 0x3f -# endif -# ifndef LANG_KONKANI -# define LANG_KONKANI 0x57 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_KYRGYZ -# define LANG_KYRGYZ 0x40 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_LATVIAN -# define LANG_LATVIAN 0x26 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_LITHUANIAN -# define LANG_LITHUANIAN 0x27 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_MACEDONIAN -# define LANG_MACEDONIAN 0x2f -# endif -# ifndef LANG_MALAY -# define LANG_MALAY 0x3e -# endif -# ifndef LANG_MALAYALAM -# define LANG_MALAYALAM 0x4c -# endif -# ifndef LANG_MANIPURI -# define LANG_MANIPURI 0x58 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_MARATHI -# define LANG_MARATHI 0x4e -# endif -# ifndef LANG_MONGOLIAN -# define LANG_MONGOLIAN 0x50 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_NEPALI -# define LANG_NEPALI 0x61 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_ORIYA -# define LANG_ORIYA 0x48 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_PUNJABI -# define LANG_PUNJABI 0x46 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_SANSKRIT -# define LANG_SANSKRIT 0x4f -# endif -# ifndef LANG_SERBIAN -# define LANG_SERBIAN 0x1a -# endif -# ifndef LANG_SINDHI -# define LANG_SINDHI 0x59 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_SLOVAK -# define LANG_SLOVAK 0x1b -# endif -# ifndef LANG_SORBIAN -# define LANG_SORBIAN 0x2e -# endif -# ifndef LANG_SWAHILI -# define LANG_SWAHILI 0x41 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_SYRIAC -# define LANG_SYRIAC 0x5a -# endif -# ifndef LANG_TAMIL -# define LANG_TAMIL 0x49 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_TATAR -# define LANG_TATAR 0x44 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_TELUGU -# define LANG_TELUGU 0x4a -# endif -# ifndef LANG_THAI -# define LANG_THAI 0x1e -# endif -# ifndef LANG_UKRAINIAN -# define LANG_UKRAINIAN 0x22 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_URDU -# define LANG_URDU 0x20 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_UZBEK -# define LANG_UZBEK 0x43 -# endif -# ifndef LANG_VIETNAMESE -# define LANG_VIETNAMESE 0x2a -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA 0x01 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT 0x03 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA 0x04 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA 0x05 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO 0x06 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA 0x07 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN 0x08 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN 0x09 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA 0x0a -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN 0x0b -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON 0x0c -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT 0x0d -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE 0x0e -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN 0x0f -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR -# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR 0x10 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN -# define SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN 0x01 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC -# define SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU -# define SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU 0x05 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA -# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA 0x07 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA -# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA 0x08 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN -# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN 0x09 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE -# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE 0x0a -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD -# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD 0x0b -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE -# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE 0x0c -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES -# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES 0x0d -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG -# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG 0x05 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO -# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO 0x06 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG -# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG 0x04 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN -# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN 0x05 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA -# define SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA -# define SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA 0x01 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM -# define SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA -# define SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN -# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC -# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC 0x03 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA 0x04 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA 0x05 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA 0x06 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC 0x07 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA 0x08 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA 0x09 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU 0x0a -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA 0x0b -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR 0x0c -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE 0x0d -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY 0x0e -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY 0x0f -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA 0x10 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR 0x11 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS 0x12 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA 0x13 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO -# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO 0x14 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND -# define SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN -# define SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN 0x01 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA -# define SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA 0x02 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN -# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN 0x01 -# endif -# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC -# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC 0x02 -# endif -#endif - -/* XPG3 defines the result of 'setlocale (category, NULL)' as: - "Directs 'setlocale()' to query 'category' and return the current - setting of 'local'." - However it does not specify the exact format. Neither do SUSV2 and - ISO C 99. So we can use this feature only on selected systems (e.g. - those using GNU C Library). */ -#if defined _LIBC || (defined __GNU_LIBRARY__ && __GNU_LIBRARY__ >= 2) -# define HAVE_LOCALE_NULL -#endif - -/* Determine the current locale's name, and canonicalize it into XPG syntax - language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier] - The codeset part in the result is not reliable; the locale_charset() - should be used for codeset information instead. - The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated. */ - -const char * -_nl_locale_name (category, categoryname) - int category; - const char *categoryname; -{ - const char *retval; - -#ifndef WIN32 - - /* Use the POSIX methods of looking to 'LC_ALL', 'LC_xxx', and 'LANG'. - On some systems this can be done by the 'setlocale' function itself. */ -# if defined HAVE_SETLOCALE && defined HAVE_LC_MESSAGES && defined HAVE_LOCALE_NULL - retval = setlocale (category, NULL); -# else - /* Setting of LC_ALL overwrites all other. */ - retval = getenv ("LC_ALL"); - if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0') - { - /* Next comes the name of the desired category. */ - retval = getenv (categoryname); - if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0') - { - /* Last possibility is the LANG environment variable. */ - retval = getenv ("LANG"); - if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0') - /* We use C as the default domain. POSIX says this is - implementation defined. */ - retval = "C"; - } - } -# endif - - return retval; - -#else /* WIN32 */ - - /* Return an XPG style locale name language[_territory][@modifier]. - Don't even bother determining the codeset; it's not useful in this - context, because message catalogs are not specific to a single - codeset. */ - - LCID lcid; - LANGID langid; - int primary, sub; - - /* Let the user override the system settings through environment - variables, as on POSIX systems. */ - retval = getenv ("LC_ALL"); - if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0') - return retval; - retval = getenv (categoryname); - if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0') - return retval; - retval = getenv ("LANG"); - if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0') - return retval; - - /* Use native Win32 API locale ID. */ - lcid = GetThreadLocale (); - - /* Strip off the sorting rules, keep only the language part. */ - langid = LANGIDFROMLCID (lcid); - - /* Split into language and territory part. */ - primary = PRIMARYLANGID (langid); - sub = SUBLANGID (langid); - - /* Dispatch on language. - See also http://www.unicode.org/unicode/onlinedat/languages.html . - For details about languages, see http://www.ethnologue.com/ . */ - switch (primary) - { - case LANG_AFRIKAANS: return "af_ZA"; - case LANG_ALBANIAN: return "sq_AL"; - case 0x5e: /* AMHARIC */ return "am_ET"; - case LANG_ARABIC: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA: return "ar_SA"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ: return "ar_IQ"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT: return "ar_EG"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA: return "ar_LY"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA: return "ar_DZ"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO: return "ar_MA"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA: return "ar_TN"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN: return "ar_OM"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN: return "ar_YE"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA: return "ar_SY"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN: return "ar_JO"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON: return "ar_LB"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT: return "ar_KW"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE: return "ar_AE"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN: return "ar_BH"; - case SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR: return "ar_QA"; - } - return "ar"; - case LANG_ARMENIAN: return "hy_AM"; - case LANG_ASSAMESE: return "as_IN"; - case LANG_AZERI: - switch (sub) - { - /* FIXME: Adjust this when Azerbaijani locales appear on Unix. */ - case SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN: return "az_AZ@latin"; - case SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC: return "az_AZ@cyrillic"; - } - return "az"; - case LANG_BASQUE: - return "eu"; /* Ambiguous: could be "eu_ES" or "eu_FR". */ - case LANG_BELARUSIAN: return "be_BY"; - case LANG_BENGALI: return "bn_IN"; - case LANG_BULGARIAN: return "bg_BG"; - case 0x55: /* BURMESE */ return "my_MM"; - case 0x53: /* CAMBODIAN */ return "km_KH"; - case LANG_CATALAN: return "ca_ES"; - case 0x5c: /* CHEROKEE */ return "chr_US"; - case LANG_CHINESE: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_CHINESE_TRADITIONAL: return "zh_TW"; - case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SIMPLIFIED: return "zh_CN"; - case SUBLANG_CHINESE_HONGKONG: return "zh_HK"; - case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SINGAPORE: return "zh_SG"; - case SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU: return "zh_MO"; - } - return "zh"; - case LANG_CROATIAN: /* LANG_CROATIAN == LANG_SERBIAN - * What used to be called Serbo-Croatian - * should really now be two separate - * languages because of political reasons. - * (Says tml, who knows nothing about Serbian - * or Croatian.) - * (I can feel those flames coming already.) - */ - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "hr_HR"; - case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN: return "sr_YU"; - case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC: return "sr_YU@cyrillic"; - } - return "hr"; - case LANG_CZECH: return "cs_CZ"; - case LANG_DANISH: return "da_DK"; - case LANG_DIVEHI: return "div_MV"; - case LANG_DUTCH: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_DUTCH: return "nl_NL"; - case SUBLANG_DUTCH_BELGIAN: /* FLEMISH, VLAAMS */ return "nl_BE"; - } - return "nl"; - case 0x66: /* EDO */ return "bin_NG"; - case LANG_ENGLISH: - switch (sub) - { - /* SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. Heh. I thought - * English was the language spoken in England. - * Oh well. - */ - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US: return "en_US"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_UK: return "en_GB"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_AUS: return "en_AU"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CAN: return "en_CA"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_NZ: return "en_NZ"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_EIRE: return "en_IE"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA: return "en_ZA"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA: return "en_JM"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN: return "en_GD"; /* Grenada? */ - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE: return "en_BZ"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD: return "en_TT"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE: return "en_ZW"; - case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES: return "en_PH"; - } - return "en"; - case LANG_ESTONIAN: return "et_EE"; - case LANG_FAEROESE: return "fo_FO"; - case LANG_FARSI: return "fa_IR"; - case LANG_FINNISH: return "fi_FI"; - case LANG_FRENCH: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_FRENCH: return "fr_FR"; - case SUBLANG_FRENCH_BELGIAN: /* WALLOON */ return "fr_BE"; - case SUBLANG_FRENCH_CANADIAN: return "fr_CA"; - case SUBLANG_FRENCH_SWISS: return "fr_CH"; - case SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG: return "fr_LU"; - case SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO: return "fr_MC"; - } - return "fr"; - case 0x62: /* FRISIAN */ return "fy_NL"; - case 0x67: /* FULFULDE */ return "ful_NG"; - case 0x3c: /* GAELIC */ - switch (sub) - { - case 0x01: /* SCOTTISH */ return "gd_GB"; - case 0x02: /* IRISH */ return "ga_IE"; - } - return "C"; - case LANG_GALICIAN: return "gl_ES"; - case LANG_GEORGIAN: return "ka_GE"; - case LANG_GERMAN: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_GERMAN: return "de_DE"; - case SUBLANG_GERMAN_SWISS: return "de_CH"; - case SUBLANG_GERMAN_AUSTRIAN: return "de_AT"; - case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG: return "de_LU"; - case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN: return "de_LI"; - } - return "de"; - case LANG_GREEK: return "el_GR"; - case 0x74: /* GUARANI */ return "gn_PY"; - case LANG_GUJARATI: return "gu_IN"; - case 0x68: /* HAUSA */ return "ha_NG"; - case 0x75: /* HAWAIIAN */ - /* FIXME: Do they mean Hawaiian ("haw_US", 1000 speakers) - or Hawaii Creole English ("cpe_US", 600000 speakers)? */ - return "cpe_US"; - case LANG_HEBREW: return "he_IL"; - case LANG_HINDI: return "hi_IN"; - case LANG_HUNGARIAN: return "hu_HU"; - case 0x69: /* IBIBIO */ return "nic_NG"; - case LANG_ICELANDIC: return "is_IS"; - case 0x70: /* IGBO */ return "ibo_NG"; - case LANG_INDONESIAN: return "id_ID"; - case 0x5d: /* INUKTITUT */ return "iu_CA"; - case LANG_ITALIAN: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_ITALIAN: return "it_IT"; - case SUBLANG_ITALIAN_SWISS: return "it_CH"; - } - return "it"; - case LANG_JAPANESE: return "ja_JP"; - case LANG_KANNADA: return "kn_IN"; - case 0x71: /* KANURI */ return "kau_NG"; - case LANG_KASHMIRI: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ks_PK"; - case SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA: return "ks_IN"; - } - return "ks"; - case LANG_KAZAK: return "kk_KZ"; - case LANG_KONKANI: - /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */ - return "kok_IN"; - case LANG_KOREAN: return "ko_KR"; - case LANG_KYRGYZ: return "ky_KG"; - case 0x54: /* LAO */ return "lo_LA"; - case 0x76: /* LATIN */ return "la_VA"; - case LANG_LATVIAN: return "lv_LV"; - case LANG_LITHUANIAN: return "lt_LT"; - case LANG_MACEDONIAN: return "mk_MK"; - case LANG_MALAY: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA: return "ms_MY"; - case SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM: return "ms_BN"; - } - return "ms"; - case LANG_MALAYALAM: return "ml_IN"; - case 0x3a: /* MALTESE */ return "mt_MT"; - case LANG_MANIPURI: - /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */ - return "mni_IN"; - case LANG_MARATHI: return "mr_IN"; - case LANG_MONGOLIAN: - return "mn"; /* Ambiguous: could be "mn_CN" or "mn_MN". */ - case LANG_NEPALI: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ne_NP"; - case SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA: return "ne_IN"; - } - return "ne"; - case LANG_NORWEGIAN: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_BOKMAL: return "no_NO"; - case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_NYNORSK: return "nn_NO"; - } - return "no"; - case LANG_ORIYA: return "or_IN"; - case 0x72: /* OROMO */ return "om_ET"; - case 0x79: /* PAPIAMENTU */ return "pap_AN"; - case 0x63: /* PASHTO */ - return "ps"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ps_PK" or "ps_AF". */ - case LANG_POLISH: return "pl_PL"; - case LANG_PORTUGUESE: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE: return "pt_PT"; - /* Hmm. SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. - Same phenomenon as SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. */ - case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN: return "pt_BR"; - } - return "pt"; - case LANG_PUNJABI: return "pa_IN"; - case 0x17: /* RHAETO-ROMANCE */ return "rm_CH"; - case LANG_ROMANIAN: return "ro_RO"; - case LANG_RUSSIAN: - return "ru"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ru_RU" or "ru_UA". */ - case 0x3b: /* SAMI */ return "se_NO"; - case LANG_SANSKRIT: return "sa_IN"; - case LANG_SINDHI: return "sd"; - case 0x5b: /* SINHALESE */ return "si_LK"; - case LANG_SLOVAK: return "sk_SK"; - case LANG_SLOVENIAN: return "sl_SI"; - case 0x77: /* SOMALI */ return "so_SO"; - case LANG_SORBIAN: - /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix. */ - return "wen_DE"; - case LANG_SPANISH: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_SPANISH: return "es_ES"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MEXICAN: return "es_MX"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MODERN: - return "es_ES@modern"; /* not seen on Unix */ - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA: return "es_GT"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA: return "es_CR"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA: return "es_PA"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC: return "es_DO"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA: return "es_VE"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA: return "es_CO"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU: return "es_PE"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA: return "es_AR"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR: return "es_EC"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE: return "es_CL"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY: return "es_UY"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY: return "es_PY"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA: return "es_BO"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR: return "es_SV"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS: return "es_HN"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA: return "es_NI"; - case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO: return "es_PR"; - } - return "es"; - case 0x30: /* SUTU */ return "bnt_TZ"; - case LANG_SWAHILI: return "sw_KE"; - case LANG_SWEDISH: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "sv_SE"; - case SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND: return "sv_FI"; - } - return "sv"; - case LANG_SYRIAC: return "syr_TR"; /* An extinct language. */ - case 0x64: /* TAGALOG */ return "tl_PH"; - case 0x28: /* TAJIK */ return "tg_TJ"; - case 0x5f: /* TAMAZIGHT */ return "ber_MA"; - case LANG_TAMIL: - return "ta"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ta_IN" or "ta_LK" or "ta_SG". */ - case LANG_TATAR: return "tt_RU"; - case LANG_TELUGU: return "te_IN"; - case LANG_THAI: return "th_TH"; - case 0x51: /* TIBETAN */ return "bo_CN"; - case 0x73: /* TIGRINYA */ return "ti_ET"; - case 0x31: /* TSONGA */ return "ts_ZA"; - case LANG_TURKISH: return "tr_TR"; - case 0x42: /* TURKMEN */ return "tk_TM"; - case LANG_UKRAINIAN: return "uk_UA"; - case LANG_URDU: - switch (sub) - { - case SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN: return "ur_PK"; - case SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA: return "ur_IN"; - } - return "ur"; - case LANG_UZBEK: - switch (sub) - { - /* FIXME: Adjust this when Uzbek locales appear on Unix. */ - case SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN: return "uz_UZ@latin"; - case SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC: return "uz_UZ@cyrillic"; - } - return "uz"; - case 0x33: /* VENDA */ return "ven_ZA"; - case LANG_VIETNAMESE: return "vi_VN"; - case 0x52: /* WELSH */ return "cy_GB"; - case 0x34: /* XHOSA */ return "xh_ZA"; - case 0x78: /* YI */ return "sit_CN"; - case 0x3d: /* YIDDISH */ return "yi_IL"; - case 0x6a: /* YORUBA */ return "yo_NG"; - case 0x35: /* ZULU */ return "zu_ZA"; - default: return "C"; - } - -#endif -}
--- a/src/intl/log.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,104 +0,0 @@ -/* Log file output. - Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stdio.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -/* Print an ASCII string with quotes and escape sequences where needed. */ -static void -print_escaped (stream, str) - FILE *stream; - const char *str; -{ - putc ('"', stream); - for (; *str != '\0'; str++) - if (*str == '\n') - { - fputs ("\\n\"", stream); - if (str[1] == '\0') - return; - fputs ("\n\"", stream); - } - else - { - if (*str == '"' || *str == '\\') - putc ('\\', stream); - putc (*str, stream); - } - putc ('"', stream); -} - -/* Add to the log file an entry denoting a failed translation. */ -void -_nl_log_untranslated (logfilename, domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural) - const char *logfilename; - const char *domainname; - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - int plural; -{ - static char *last_logfilename = NULL; - static FILE *last_logfile = NULL; - FILE *logfile; - - /* Can we reuse the last opened logfile? */ - if (last_logfilename == NULL || strcmp (logfilename, last_logfilename) != 0) - { - /* Close the last used logfile. */ - if (last_logfilename != NULL) - { - if (last_logfile != NULL) - { - fclose (last_logfile); - last_logfile = NULL; - } - free (last_logfilename); - last_logfilename = NULL; - } - /* Open the logfile. */ - last_logfilename = (char *) malloc (strlen (logfilename) + 1); - if (last_logfilename == NULL) - return; - strcpy (last_logfilename, logfilename); - last_logfile = fopen (logfilename, "a"); - if (last_logfile == NULL) - return; - } - logfile = last_logfile; - - fprintf (logfile, "domain "); - print_escaped (logfile, domainname); - fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid "); - print_escaped (logfile, msgid1); - if (plural) - { - fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid_plural "); - print_escaped (logfile, msgid2); - fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr[0] \"\"\n"); - } - else - fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr \"\"\n"); - putc ('\n', logfile); -}
--- a/src/intl/ngettext.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,68 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of ngettext(3) function. - Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#ifdef _LIBC -# define __need_NULL -# include <stddef.h> -#else -# include <stdlib.h> /* Just for NULL. */ -#endif - -#include "gettextP.h" -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif - -#include <locale.h> - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define NGETTEXT __ngettext -# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext -#else -# define NGETTEXT libintl_ngettext -# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext -#endif - -/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current - LC_MESSAGES locale. If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default - text). */ -char * -NGETTEXT (msgid1, msgid2, n) - const char *msgid1; - const char *msgid2; - unsigned long int n; -{ - return DCNGETTEXT (NULL, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES); -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ -weak_alias (__ngettext, ngettext); -#endif
--- a/src/intl/os2compat.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,98 +0,0 @@ -/* OS/2 compatibility functions. - Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#define OS2_AWARE -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -#include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> -#include <sys/param.h> - -/* A version of getenv() that works from DLLs */ -extern unsigned long DosScanEnv (const unsigned char *pszName, unsigned char **ppszValue); - -char * -_nl_getenv (const char *name) -{ - unsigned char *value; - if (DosScanEnv (name, &value)) - return NULL; - else - return value; -} - -/* A fixed size buffer. */ -char libintl_nl_default_dirname[MAXPATHLEN+1]; - -char *_nlos2_libdir = NULL; -char *_nlos2_localealiaspath = NULL; -char *_nlos2_localedir = NULL; - -static __attribute__((constructor)) void -nlos2_initialize () -{ - char *root = getenv ("UNIXROOT"); - char *gnulocaledir = getenv ("GNULOCALEDIR"); - - _nlos2_libdir = gnulocaledir; - if (!_nlos2_libdir) - { - if (root) - { - size_t sl = strlen (root); - _nlos2_libdir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LIBDIR) + 1); - memcpy (_nlos2_libdir, root, sl); - memcpy (_nlos2_libdir + sl, LIBDIR, strlen (LIBDIR) + 1); - } - else - _nlos2_libdir = LIBDIR; - } - - _nlos2_localealiaspath = gnulocaledir; - if (!_nlos2_localealiaspath) - { - if (root) - { - size_t sl = strlen (root); - _nlos2_localealiaspath = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1); - memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath, root, sl); - memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath + sl, LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH, strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1); - } - else - _nlos2_localealiaspath = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH; - } - - _nlos2_localedir = gnulocaledir; - if (!_nlos2_localedir) - { - if (root) - { - size_t sl = strlen (root); - _nlos2_localedir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1); - memcpy (_nlos2_localedir, root, sl); - memcpy (_nlos2_localedir + sl, LOCALEDIR, strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1); - } - else - _nlos2_localedir = LOCALEDIR; - } - - if (strlen (_nlos2_localedir) <= MAXPATHLEN) - strcpy (libintl_nl_default_dirname, _nlos2_localedir); -}
--- a/src/intl/os2compat.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,46 +0,0 @@ -/* OS/2 compatibility defines. - This file is intended to be included from config.h - Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* When included from os2compat.h we need all the original definitions */ -#ifndef OS2_AWARE - -#undef LIBDIR -#define LIBDIR _nlos2_libdir -extern char *_nlos2_libdir; - -#undef LOCALEDIR -#define LOCALEDIR _nlos2_localedir -extern char *_nlos2_localedir; - -#undef LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH -#define LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH _nlos2_localealiaspath -extern char *_nlos2_localealiaspath; - -#endif - -#undef HAVE_STRCASECMP -#define HAVE_STRCASECMP 1 -#define strcasecmp stricmp -#define strncasecmp strnicmp - -/* We have our own getenv() which works even if library is compiled as DLL */ -#define getenv _nl_getenv - -/* Older versions of gettext used -1 as the value of LC_MESSAGES */ -#define LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT (-1)
--- a/src/intl/osdep.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,24 +0,0 @@ -/* OS dependent parts of libintl. - Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#if defined __EMX__ -# include "os2compat.c" -#else -/* Avoid AIX compiler warning. */ -typedef int dummy; -#endif
--- a/src/intl/plural-exp.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,156 +0,0 @@ -/* Expression parsing for plural form selection. - Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <ctype.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#include "plural-exp.h" - -#if (defined __GNUC__ && !defined __APPLE_CC__) \ - || (defined __STDC_VERSION__ && __STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L) - -/* These structs are the constant expression for the germanic plural - form determination. It represents the expression "n != 1". */ -static const struct expression plvar = -{ - .nargs = 0, - .operation = var, -}; -static const struct expression plone = -{ - .nargs = 0, - .operation = num, - .val = - { - .num = 1 - } -}; -struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL = -{ - .nargs = 2, - .operation = not_equal, - .val = - { - .args = - { - [0] = (struct expression *) &plvar, - [1] = (struct expression *) &plone - } - } -}; - -# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL() - -#else - -/* For compilers without support for ISO C 99 struct/union initializers: - Initialization at run-time. */ - -static struct expression plvar; -static struct expression plone; -struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL; - -static void -init_germanic_plural () -{ - if (plone.val.num == 0) - { - plvar.nargs = 0; - plvar.operation = var; - - plone.nargs = 0; - plone.operation = num; - plone.val.num = 1; - - GERMANIC_PLURAL.nargs = 2; - GERMANIC_PLURAL.operation = not_equal; - GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[0] = &plvar; - GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[1] = &plone; - } -} - -# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL() init_germanic_plural () - -#endif - -void -internal_function -EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (nullentry, pluralp, npluralsp) - const char *nullentry; - struct expression **pluralp; - unsigned long int *npluralsp; -{ - if (nullentry != NULL) - { - const char *plural; - const char *nplurals; - - plural = strstr (nullentry, "plural="); - nplurals = strstr (nullentry, "nplurals="); - if (plural == NULL || nplurals == NULL) - goto no_plural; - else - { - char *endp; - unsigned long int n; - struct parse_args args; - - /* First get the number. */ - nplurals += 9; - while (*nplurals != '\0' && isspace ((unsigned char) *nplurals)) - ++nplurals; - if (!(*nplurals >= '0' && *nplurals <= '9')) - goto no_plural; -#if defined HAVE_STRTOUL || defined _LIBC - n = strtoul (nplurals, &endp, 10); -#else - for (endp = nplurals, n = 0; *endp >= '0' && *endp <= '9'; endp++) - n = n * 10 + (*endp - '0'); -#endif - if (nplurals == endp) - goto no_plural; - *npluralsp = n; - - /* Due to the restrictions bison imposes onto the interface of the - scanner function we have to put the input string and the result - passed up from the parser into the same structure which address - is passed down to the parser. */ - plural += 7; - args.cp = plural; - if (PLURAL_PARSE (&args) != 0) - goto no_plural; - *pluralp = args.res; - } - } - else - { - /* By default we are using the Germanic form: singular form only - for `one', the plural form otherwise. Yes, this is also what - English is using since English is a Germanic language. */ - no_plural: - INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL (); - *pluralp = &GERMANIC_PLURAL; - *npluralsp = 2; - } -}
--- a/src/intl/plural-exp.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,126 +0,0 @@ -/* Expression parsing and evaluation for plural form selection. - Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef _PLURAL_EXP_H -#define _PLURAL_EXP_H - -#ifndef PARAMS -# if __STDC__ || defined __GNUC__ || defined __SUNPRO_C || defined __cplusplus || __PROTOTYPES -# define PARAMS(args) args -# else -# define PARAMS(args) () -# endif -#endif - -#ifndef internal_function -# define internal_function -#endif - -#ifndef attribute_hidden -# define attribute_hidden -#endif - - -/* This is the representation of the expressions to determine the - plural form. */ -struct expression -{ - int nargs; /* Number of arguments. */ - enum operator - { - /* Without arguments: */ - var, /* The variable "n". */ - num, /* Decimal number. */ - /* Unary operators: */ - lnot, /* Logical NOT. */ - /* Binary operators: */ - mult, /* Multiplication. */ - divide, /* Division. */ - module, /* Modulo operation. */ - plus, /* Addition. */ - minus, /* Subtraction. */ - less_than, /* Comparison. */ - greater_than, /* Comparison. */ - less_or_equal, /* Comparison. */ - greater_or_equal, /* Comparison. */ - equal, /* Comparison for equality. */ - not_equal, /* Comparison for inequality. */ - land, /* Logical AND. */ - lor, /* Logical OR. */ - /* Ternary operators: */ - qmop /* Question mark operator. */ - } operation; - union - { - unsigned long int num; /* Number value for `num'. */ - struct expression *args[3]; /* Up to three arguments. */ - } val; -}; - -/* This is the data structure to pass information to the parser and get - the result in a thread-safe way. */ -struct parse_args -{ - const char *cp; - struct expression *res; -}; - - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. This source code is used - 1. in the GNU C Library library, - 2. in the GNU libintl library, - 3. in the GNU gettext tools. - The function names in each situation must be different, to allow for - binary incompatible changes in 'struct expression'. Furthermore, - 1. in the GNU C Library library, the names have a __ prefix, - 2.+3. in the GNU libintl library and in the GNU gettext tools, the names - must follow ANSI C and not start with __. - So we have to distinguish the three cases. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define FREE_EXPRESSION __gettext_free_exp -# define PLURAL_PARSE __gettextparse -# define GERMANIC_PLURAL __gettext_germanic_plural -# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION __gettext_extract_plural -#elif defined (IN_LIBINTL) -# define FREE_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_free_exp -# define PLURAL_PARSE libintl_gettextparse -# define GERMANIC_PLURAL libintl_gettext_germanic_plural -# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_extract_plural -#else -# define FREE_EXPRESSION free_plural_expression -# define PLURAL_PARSE parse_plural_expression -# define GERMANIC_PLURAL germanic_plural -# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION extract_plural_expression -#endif - -extern void FREE_EXPRESSION PARAMS ((struct expression *exp)) - internal_function; -extern int PLURAL_PARSE PARAMS ((void *arg)); -extern struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL attribute_hidden; -extern void EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION PARAMS ((const char *nullentry, - struct expression **pluralp, - unsigned long int *npluralsp)) - internal_function; - -#if !defined (_LIBC) && !defined (IN_LIBINTL) -extern unsigned long int plural_eval PARAMS ((struct expression *pexp, - unsigned long int n)); -#endif - -#endif /* _PLURAL_EXP_H */
--- a/src/intl/plural.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,1518 +0,0 @@ -/* A Bison parser, made from plural.y - by GNU bison 1.35. */ - -#define YYBISON 1 /* Identify Bison output. */ - -#define yyparse __gettextparse -#define yylex __gettextlex -#define yyerror __gettexterror -#define yylval __gettextlval -#define yychar __gettextchar -#define yydebug __gettextdebug -#define yynerrs __gettextnerrs -# define EQUOP2 257 -# define CMPOP2 258 -# define ADDOP2 259 -# define MULOP2 260 -# define NUMBER 261 - -#line 1 "plural.y" - -/* Expression parsing for plural form selection. - Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* The bison generated parser uses alloca. AIX 3 forces us to put this - declaration at the beginning of the file. The declaration in bison's - skeleton file comes too late. This must come before <config.h> - because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers. */ -#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__ - #pragma alloca -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stddef.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include "plural-exp.h" - -/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse, - but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE. */ -#ifndef _LIBC -# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE -#endif - -#define YYLEX_PARAM &((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp -#define YYPARSE_PARAM arg - -#line 49 "plural.y" -#ifndef YYSTYPE -typedef union { - unsigned long int num; - enum operator op; - struct expression *exp; -} yystype; -# define YYSTYPE yystype -# define YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL 1 -#endif -#line 55 "plural.y" - -/* Prototypes for local functions. */ -static struct expression *new_exp PARAMS ((int nargs, enum operator op, - struct expression * const *args)); -static inline struct expression *new_exp_0 PARAMS ((enum operator op)); -static inline struct expression *new_exp_1 PARAMS ((enum operator op, - struct expression *right)); -static struct expression *new_exp_2 PARAMS ((enum operator op, - struct expression *left, - struct expression *right)); -static inline struct expression *new_exp_3 PARAMS ((enum operator op, - struct expression *bexp, - struct expression *tbranch, - struct expression *fbranch)); -static int yylex PARAMS ((YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp)); -static void yyerror PARAMS ((const char *str)); - -/* Allocation of expressions. */ - -static struct expression * -new_exp (nargs, op, args) - int nargs; - enum operator op; - struct expression * const *args; -{ - int i; - struct expression *newp; - - /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL. */ - for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) - if (args[i] == NULL) - goto fail; - - /* Allocate a new expression. */ - newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp)); - if (newp != NULL) - { - newp->nargs = nargs; - newp->operation = op; - for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) - newp->val.args[i] = args[i]; - return newp; - } - - fail: - for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) - FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]); - - return NULL; -} - -static inline struct expression * -new_exp_0 (op) - enum operator op; -{ - return new_exp (0, op, NULL); -} - -static inline struct expression * -new_exp_1 (op, right) - enum operator op; - struct expression *right; -{ - struct expression *args[1]; - - args[0] = right; - return new_exp (1, op, args); -} - -static struct expression * -new_exp_2 (op, left, right) - enum operator op; - struct expression *left; - struct expression *right; -{ - struct expression *args[2]; - - args[0] = left; - args[1] = right; - return new_exp (2, op, args); -} - -static inline struct expression * -new_exp_3 (op, bexp, tbranch, fbranch) - enum operator op; - struct expression *bexp; - struct expression *tbranch; - struct expression *fbranch; -{ - struct expression *args[3]; - - args[0] = bexp; - args[1] = tbranch; - args[2] = fbranch; - return new_exp (3, op, args); -} - -#ifndef YYDEBUG -# define YYDEBUG 0 -#endif - - - -#define YYFINAL 27 -#define YYFLAG -32768 -#define YYNTBASE 16 - -/* YYTRANSLATE(YYLEX) -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */ -#define YYTRANSLATE(x) ((unsigned)(x) <= 261 ? yytranslate[x] : 18) - -/* YYTRANSLATE[YYLEX] -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */ -static const char yytranslate[] = -{ - 0, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 10, 2, 2, 2, 2, 5, 2, - 14, 15, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 12, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 3, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 13, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 4, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, - 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 2, 1, 6, 7, 8, - 9, 11 -}; - -#if YYDEBUG -static const short yyprhs[] = -{ - 0, 0, 2, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, 28, 32, - 35, 37, 39 -}; -static const short yyrhs[] = -{ - 17, 0, 17, 3, 17, 12, 17, 0, 17, 4, - 17, 0, 17, 5, 17, 0, 17, 6, 17, 0, - 17, 7, 17, 0, 17, 8, 17, 0, 17, 9, - 17, 0, 10, 17, 0, 13, 0, 11, 0, 14, - 17, 15, 0 -}; - -#endif - -#if YYDEBUG -/* YYRLINE[YYN] -- source line where rule number YYN was defined. */ -static const short yyrline[] = -{ - 0, 174, 182, 186, 190, 194, 198, 202, 206, 210, - 214, 218, 223 -}; -#endif - - -#if (YYDEBUG) || defined YYERROR_VERBOSE - -/* YYTNAME[TOKEN_NUM] -- String name of the token TOKEN_NUM. */ -static const char *const yytname[] = -{ - "$", "error", "$undefined.", "'?'", "'|'", "'&'", "EQUOP2", "CMPOP2", - "ADDOP2", "MULOP2", "'!'", "NUMBER", "':'", "'n'", "'('", "')'", - "start", "exp", 0 -}; -#endif - -/* YYR1[YYN] -- Symbol number of symbol that rule YYN derives. */ -static const short yyr1[] = -{ - 0, 16, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, 17, - 17, 17, 17 -}; - -/* YYR2[YYN] -- Number of symbols composing right hand side of rule YYN. */ -static const short yyr2[] = -{ - 0, 1, 5, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 3, 2, - 1, 1, 3 -}; - -/* YYDEFACT[S] -- default rule to reduce with in state S when YYTABLE - doesn't specify something else to do. Zero means the default is an - error. */ -static const short yydefact[] = -{ - 0, 0, 11, 10, 0, 1, 9, 0, 0, 0, - 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 12, 0, 3, 4, 5, - 6, 7, 8, 0, 2, 0, 0, 0 -}; - -static const short yydefgoto[] = -{ - 25, 5 -}; - -static const short yypact[] = -{ - -9, -9,-32768,-32768, -9, 34,-32768, 11, -9, -9, - -9, -9, -9, -9, -9,-32768, 24, 39, 43, 16, - 26, -3,-32768, -9, 34, 21, 53,-32768 -}; - -static const short yypgoto[] = -{ - -32768, -1 -}; - - -#define YYLAST 53 - - -static const short yytable[] = -{ - 6, 1, 2, 7, 3, 4, 14, 16, 17, 18, - 19, 20, 21, 22, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, - 14, 26, 24, 12, 13, 14, 15, 8, 9, 10, - 11, 12, 13, 14, 13, 14, 23, 8, 9, 10, - 11, 12, 13, 14, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 11, - 12, 13, 14, 27 -}; - -static const short yycheck[] = -{ - 1, 10, 11, 4, 13, 14, 9, 8, 9, 10, - 11, 12, 13, 14, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, - 9, 0, 23, 7, 8, 9, 15, 3, 4, 5, - 6, 7, 8, 9, 8, 9, 12, 3, 4, 5, - 6, 7, 8, 9, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 6, - 7, 8, 9, 0 -}; -#define YYPURE 1 - -/* -*-C-*- Note some compilers choke on comments on `#line' lines. */ -#line 3 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple" - -/* Skeleton output parser for bison, - - Copyright (C) 1984, 1989, 1990, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software - Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify - it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by - the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the - GNU General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License - along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, - Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */ - -/* As a special exception, when this file is copied by Bison into a - Bison output file, you may use that output file without restriction. - This special exception was added by the Free Software Foundation - in version 1.24 of Bison. */ - -/* This is the parser code that is written into each bison parser when - the %semantic_parser declaration is not specified in the grammar. - It was written by Richard Stallman by simplifying the hairy parser - used when %semantic_parser is specified. */ - -/* All symbols defined below should begin with yy or YY, to avoid - infringing on user name space. This should be done even for local - variables, as they might otherwise be expanded by user macros. - There are some unavoidable exceptions within include files to - define necessary library symbols; they are noted "INFRINGES ON - USER NAME SPACE" below. */ - -#if ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) - -/* The parser invokes alloca or malloc; define the necessary symbols. */ - -# if YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA -# define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca -# else -# ifndef YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA -# if defined (alloca) || defined (_ALLOCA_H) -# define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca -# else -# ifdef __GNUC__ -# define YYSTACK_ALLOC __builtin_alloca -# endif -# endif -# endif -# endif - -# ifdef YYSTACK_ALLOC - /* Pacify GCC's `empty if-body' warning. */ -# define YYSTACK_FREE(Ptr) do { /* empty */; } while (0) -# else -# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) -# include <stdlib.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */ -# define YYSIZE_T size_t -# endif -# define YYSTACK_ALLOC malloc -# define YYSTACK_FREE free -# endif -#endif /* ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */ - - -#if (! defined (yyoverflow) \ - && (! defined (__cplusplus) \ - || (YYLTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL && YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL))) - -/* A type that is properly aligned for any stack member. */ -union yyalloc -{ - short yyss; - YYSTYPE yyvs; -# if YYLSP_NEEDED - YYLTYPE yyls; -# endif -}; - -/* The size of the maximum gap between one aligned stack and the next. */ -# define YYSTACK_GAP_MAX (sizeof (union yyalloc) - 1) - -/* The size of an array large to enough to hold all stacks, each with - N elements. */ -# if YYLSP_NEEDED -# define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \ - ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE) + sizeof (YYLTYPE)) \ - + 2 * YYSTACK_GAP_MAX) -# else -# define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \ - ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE)) \ - + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX) -# endif - -/* Copy COUNT objects from FROM to TO. The source and destination do - not overlap. */ -# ifndef YYCOPY -# if 1 < __GNUC__ -# define YYCOPY(To, From, Count) \ - __builtin_memcpy (To, From, (Count) * sizeof (*(From))) -# else -# define YYCOPY(To, From, Count) \ - do \ - { \ - register YYSIZE_T yyi; \ - for (yyi = 0; yyi < (Count); yyi++) \ - (To)[yyi] = (From)[yyi]; \ - } \ - while (0) -# endif -# endif - -/* Relocate STACK from its old location to the new one. The - local variables YYSIZE and YYSTACKSIZE give the old and new number of - elements in the stack, and YYPTR gives the new location of the - stack. Advance YYPTR to a properly aligned location for the next - stack. */ -# define YYSTACK_RELOCATE(Stack) \ - do \ - { \ - YYSIZE_T yynewbytes; \ - YYCOPY (&yyptr->Stack, Stack, yysize); \ - Stack = &yyptr->Stack; \ - yynewbytes = yystacksize * sizeof (*Stack) + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX; \ - yyptr += yynewbytes / sizeof (*yyptr); \ - } \ - while (0) - -#endif - - -#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (__SIZE_TYPE__) -# define YYSIZE_T __SIZE_TYPE__ -#endif -#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (size_t) -# define YYSIZE_T size_t -#endif -#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) -# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) -# include <stddef.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */ -# define YYSIZE_T size_t -# endif -#endif -#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) -# define YYSIZE_T unsigned int -#endif - -#define yyerrok (yyerrstatus = 0) -#define yyclearin (yychar = YYEMPTY) -#define YYEMPTY -2 -#define YYEOF 0 -#define YYACCEPT goto yyacceptlab -#define YYABORT goto yyabortlab -#define YYERROR goto yyerrlab1 -/* Like YYERROR except do call yyerror. This remains here temporarily - to ease the transition to the new meaning of YYERROR, for GCC. - Once GCC version 2 has supplanted version 1, this can go. */ -#define YYFAIL goto yyerrlab -#define YYRECOVERING() (!!yyerrstatus) -#define YYBACKUP(Token, Value) \ -do \ - if (yychar == YYEMPTY && yylen == 1) \ - { \ - yychar = (Token); \ - yylval = (Value); \ - yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar); \ - YYPOPSTACK; \ - goto yybackup; \ - } \ - else \ - { \ - yyerror ("syntax error: cannot back up"); \ - YYERROR; \ - } \ -while (0) - -#define YYTERROR 1 -#define YYERRCODE 256 - - -/* YYLLOC_DEFAULT -- Compute the default location (before the actions - are run). - - When YYLLOC_DEFAULT is run, CURRENT is set the location of the - first token. By default, to implement support for ranges, extend - its range to the last symbol. */ - -#ifndef YYLLOC_DEFAULT -# define YYLLOC_DEFAULT(Current, Rhs, N) \ - Current.last_line = Rhs[N].last_line; \ - Current.last_column = Rhs[N].last_column; -#endif - - -/* YYLEX -- calling `yylex' with the right arguments. */ - -#if YYPURE -# if YYLSP_NEEDED -# ifdef YYLEX_PARAM -# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, &yylloc, YYLEX_PARAM) -# else -# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, &yylloc) -# endif -# else /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */ -# ifdef YYLEX_PARAM -# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval, YYLEX_PARAM) -# else -# define YYLEX yylex (&yylval) -# endif -# endif /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */ -#else /* !YYPURE */ -# define YYLEX yylex () -#endif /* !YYPURE */ - - -/* Enable debugging if requested. */ -#if YYDEBUG - -# ifndef YYFPRINTF -# include <stdio.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */ -# define YYFPRINTF fprintf -# endif - -# define YYDPRINTF(Args) \ -do { \ - if (yydebug) \ - YYFPRINTF Args; \ -} while (0) -/* Nonzero means print parse trace. It is left uninitialized so that - multiple parsers can coexist. */ -int yydebug; -#else /* !YYDEBUG */ -# define YYDPRINTF(Args) -#endif /* !YYDEBUG */ - -/* YYINITDEPTH -- initial size of the parser's stacks. */ -#ifndef YYINITDEPTH -# define YYINITDEPTH 200 -#endif - -/* YYMAXDEPTH -- maximum size the stacks can grow to (effective only - if the built-in stack extension method is used). - - Do not make this value too large; the results are undefined if - SIZE_MAX < YYSTACK_BYTES (YYMAXDEPTH) - evaluated with infinite-precision integer arithmetic. */ - -#if YYMAXDEPTH == 0 -# undef YYMAXDEPTH -#endif - -#ifndef YYMAXDEPTH -# define YYMAXDEPTH 10000 -#endif - -#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE - -# ifndef yystrlen -# if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H) -# define yystrlen strlen -# else -/* Return the length of YYSTR. */ -static YYSIZE_T -# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) -yystrlen (const char *yystr) -# else -yystrlen (yystr) - const char *yystr; -# endif -{ - register const char *yys = yystr; - - while (*yys++ != '\0') - continue; - - return yys - yystr - 1; -} -# endif -# endif - -# ifndef yystpcpy -# if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H) && defined (_GNU_SOURCE) -# define yystpcpy stpcpy -# else -/* Copy YYSRC to YYDEST, returning the address of the terminating '\0' in - YYDEST. */ -static char * -# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) -yystpcpy (char *yydest, const char *yysrc) -# else -yystpcpy (yydest, yysrc) - char *yydest; - const char *yysrc; -# endif -{ - register char *yyd = yydest; - register const char *yys = yysrc; - - while ((*yyd++ = *yys++) != '\0') - continue; - - return yyd - 1; -} -# endif -# endif -#endif - -#line 315 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple" - - -/* The user can define YYPARSE_PARAM as the name of an argument to be passed - into yyparse. The argument should have type void *. - It should actually point to an object. - Grammar actions can access the variable by casting it - to the proper pointer type. */ - -#ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM -# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus) -# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG void *YYPARSE_PARAM -# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL -# else -# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG YYPARSE_PARAM -# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL void *YYPARSE_PARAM; -# endif -#else /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */ -# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG -# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL -#endif /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */ - -/* Prevent warning if -Wstrict-prototypes. */ -#ifdef __GNUC__ -# ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM -int yyparse (void *); -# else -int yyparse (void); -# endif -#endif - -/* YY_DECL_VARIABLES -- depending whether we use a pure parser, - variables are global, or local to YYPARSE. */ - -#define YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES \ -/* The lookahead symbol. */ \ -int yychar; \ - \ -/* The semantic value of the lookahead symbol. */ \ -YYSTYPE yylval; \ - \ -/* Number of parse errors so far. */ \ -int yynerrs; - -#if YYLSP_NEEDED -# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES \ -YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES \ - \ -/* Location data for the lookahead symbol. */ \ -YYLTYPE yylloc; -#else -# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES \ -YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES -#endif - - -/* If nonreentrant, generate the variables here. */ - -#if !YYPURE -YY_DECL_VARIABLES -#endif /* !YYPURE */ - -int -yyparse (YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG) - YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL -{ - /* If reentrant, generate the variables here. */ -#if YYPURE - YY_DECL_VARIABLES -#endif /* !YYPURE */ - - register int yystate; - register int yyn; - int yyresult; - /* Number of tokens to shift before error messages enabled. */ - int yyerrstatus; - /* Lookahead token as an internal (translated) token number. */ - int yychar1 = 0; - - /* Three stacks and their tools: - `yyss': related to states, - `yyvs': related to semantic values, - `yyls': related to locations. - - Refer to the stacks thru separate pointers, to allow yyoverflow - to reallocate them elsewhere. */ - - /* The state stack. */ - short yyssa[YYINITDEPTH]; - short *yyss = yyssa; - register short *yyssp; - - /* The semantic value stack. */ - YYSTYPE yyvsa[YYINITDEPTH]; - YYSTYPE *yyvs = yyvsa; - register YYSTYPE *yyvsp; - -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - /* The location stack. */ - YYLTYPE yylsa[YYINITDEPTH]; - YYLTYPE *yyls = yylsa; - YYLTYPE *yylsp; -#endif - -#if YYLSP_NEEDED -# define YYPOPSTACK (yyvsp--, yyssp--, yylsp--) -#else -# define YYPOPSTACK (yyvsp--, yyssp--) -#endif - - YYSIZE_T yystacksize = YYINITDEPTH; - - - /* The variables used to return semantic value and location from the - action routines. */ - YYSTYPE yyval; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - YYLTYPE yyloc; -#endif - - /* When reducing, the number of symbols on the RHS of the reduced - rule. */ - int yylen; - - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Starting parse\n")); - - yystate = 0; - yyerrstatus = 0; - yynerrs = 0; - yychar = YYEMPTY; /* Cause a token to be read. */ - - /* Initialize stack pointers. - Waste one element of value and location stack - so that they stay on the same level as the state stack. - The wasted elements are never initialized. */ - - yyssp = yyss; - yyvsp = yyvs; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - yylsp = yyls; -#endif - goto yysetstate; - -/*------------------------------------------------------------. -| yynewstate -- Push a new state, which is found in yystate. | -`------------------------------------------------------------*/ - yynewstate: - /* In all cases, when you get here, the value and location stacks - have just been pushed. so pushing a state here evens the stacks. - */ - yyssp++; - - yysetstate: - *yyssp = yystate; - - if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1) - { - /* Get the current used size of the three stacks, in elements. */ - YYSIZE_T yysize = yyssp - yyss + 1; - -#ifdef yyoverflow - { - /* Give user a chance to reallocate the stack. Use copies of - these so that the &'s don't force the real ones into - memory. */ - YYSTYPE *yyvs1 = yyvs; - short *yyss1 = yyss; - - /* Each stack pointer address is followed by the size of the - data in use in that stack, in bytes. */ -# if YYLSP_NEEDED - YYLTYPE *yyls1 = yyls; - /* This used to be a conditional around just the two extra args, - but that might be undefined if yyoverflow is a macro. */ - yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow", - &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp), - &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp), - &yyls1, yysize * sizeof (*yylsp), - &yystacksize); - yyls = yyls1; -# else - yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow", - &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp), - &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp), - &yystacksize); -# endif - yyss = yyss1; - yyvs = yyvs1; - } -#else /* no yyoverflow */ -# ifndef YYSTACK_RELOCATE - goto yyoverflowlab; -# else - /* Extend the stack our own way. */ - if (yystacksize >= YYMAXDEPTH) - goto yyoverflowlab; - yystacksize *= 2; - if (yystacksize > YYMAXDEPTH) - yystacksize = YYMAXDEPTH; - - { - short *yyss1 = yyss; - union yyalloc *yyptr = - (union yyalloc *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (YYSTACK_BYTES (yystacksize)); - if (! yyptr) - goto yyoverflowlab; - YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyss); - YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyvs); -# if YYLSP_NEEDED - YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyls); -# endif -# undef YYSTACK_RELOCATE - if (yyss1 != yyssa) - YYSTACK_FREE (yyss1); - } -# endif -#endif /* no yyoverflow */ - - yyssp = yyss + yysize - 1; - yyvsp = yyvs + yysize - 1; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - yylsp = yyls + yysize - 1; -#endif - - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Stack size increased to %lu\n", - (unsigned long int) yystacksize)); - - if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1) - YYABORT; - } - - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Entering state %d\n", yystate)); - - goto yybackup; - - -/*-----------. -| yybackup. | -`-----------*/ -yybackup: - -/* Do appropriate processing given the current state. */ -/* Read a lookahead token if we need one and don't already have one. */ -/* yyresume: */ - - /* First try to decide what to do without reference to lookahead token. */ - - yyn = yypact[yystate]; - if (yyn == YYFLAG) - goto yydefault; - - /* Not known => get a lookahead token if don't already have one. */ - - /* yychar is either YYEMPTY or YYEOF - or a valid token in external form. */ - - if (yychar == YYEMPTY) - { - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Reading a token: ")); - yychar = YYLEX; - } - - /* Convert token to internal form (in yychar1) for indexing tables with */ - - if (yychar <= 0) /* This means end of input. */ - { - yychar1 = 0; - yychar = YYEOF; /* Don't call YYLEX any more */ - - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Now at end of input.\n")); - } - else - { - yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar); - -#if YYDEBUG - /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables - which are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set. */ - if (yydebug) - { - YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Next token is %d (%s", - yychar, yytname[yychar1]); - /* Give the individual parser a way to print the precise - meaning of a token, for further debugging info. */ -# ifdef YYPRINT - YYPRINT (stderr, yychar, yylval); -# endif - YYFPRINTF (stderr, ")\n"); - } -#endif - } - - yyn += yychar1; - if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != yychar1) - goto yydefault; - - yyn = yytable[yyn]; - - /* yyn is what to do for this token type in this state. - Negative => reduce, -yyn is rule number. - Positive => shift, yyn is new state. - New state is final state => don't bother to shift, - just return success. - 0, or most negative number => error. */ - - if (yyn < 0) - { - if (yyn == YYFLAG) - goto yyerrlab; - yyn = -yyn; - goto yyreduce; - } - else if (yyn == 0) - goto yyerrlab; - - if (yyn == YYFINAL) - YYACCEPT; - - /* Shift the lookahead token. */ - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting token %d (%s), ", - yychar, yytname[yychar1])); - - /* Discard the token being shifted unless it is eof. */ - if (yychar != YYEOF) - yychar = YYEMPTY; - - *++yyvsp = yylval; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - *++yylsp = yylloc; -#endif - - /* Count tokens shifted since error; after three, turn off error - status. */ - if (yyerrstatus) - yyerrstatus--; - - yystate = yyn; - goto yynewstate; - - -/*-----------------------------------------------------------. -| yydefault -- do the default action for the current state. | -`-----------------------------------------------------------*/ -yydefault: - yyn = yydefact[yystate]; - if (yyn == 0) - goto yyerrlab; - goto yyreduce; - - -/*-----------------------------. -| yyreduce -- Do a reduction. | -`-----------------------------*/ -yyreduce: - /* yyn is the number of a rule to reduce with. */ - yylen = yyr2[yyn]; - - /* If YYLEN is nonzero, implement the default value of the action: - `$$ = $1'. - - Otherwise, the following line sets YYVAL to the semantic value of - the lookahead token. This behavior is undocumented and Bison - users should not rely upon it. Assigning to YYVAL - unconditionally makes the parser a bit smaller, and it avoids a - GCC warning that YYVAL may be used uninitialized. */ - yyval = yyvsp[1-yylen]; - -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - /* Similarly for the default location. Let the user run additional - commands if for instance locations are ranges. */ - yyloc = yylsp[1-yylen]; - YYLLOC_DEFAULT (yyloc, (yylsp - yylen), yylen); -#endif - -#if YYDEBUG - /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables which - are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set. */ - if (yydebug) - { - int yyi; - - YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Reducing via rule %d (line %d), ", - yyn, yyrline[yyn]); - - /* Print the symbols being reduced, and their result. */ - for (yyi = yyprhs[yyn]; yyrhs[yyi] > 0; yyi++) - YYFPRINTF (stderr, "%s ", yytname[yyrhs[yyi]]); - YYFPRINTF (stderr, " -> %s\n", yytname[yyr1[yyn]]); - } -#endif - - switch (yyn) { - -case 1: -#line 175 "plural.y" -{ - if (yyvsp[0].exp == NULL) - YYABORT; - ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = yyvsp[0].exp; - } - break; -case 2: -#line 183 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_3 (qmop, yyvsp[-4].exp, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 3: -#line 187 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (lor, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 4: -#line 191 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (land, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 5: -#line 195 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 6: -#line 199 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 7: -#line 203 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 8: -#line 207 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 9: -#line 211 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_1 (lnot, yyvsp[0].exp); - } - break; -case 10: -#line 215 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (var); - } - break; -case 11: -#line 219 "plural.y" -{ - if ((yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL) - yyval.exp->val.num = yyvsp[0].num; - } - break; -case 12: -#line 224 "plural.y" -{ - yyval.exp = yyvsp[-1].exp; - } - break; -} - -#line 705 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple" - - - yyvsp -= yylen; - yyssp -= yylen; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - yylsp -= yylen; -#endif - -#if YYDEBUG - if (yydebug) - { - short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1; - YYFPRINTF (stderr, "state stack now"); - while (yyssp1 != yyssp) - YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1); - YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n"); - } -#endif - - *++yyvsp = yyval; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - *++yylsp = yyloc; -#endif - - /* Now `shift' the result of the reduction. Determine what state - that goes to, based on the state we popped back to and the rule - number reduced by. */ - - yyn = yyr1[yyn]; - - yystate = yypgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE] + *yyssp; - if (yystate >= 0 && yystate <= YYLAST && yycheck[yystate] == *yyssp) - yystate = yytable[yystate]; - else - yystate = yydefgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE]; - - goto yynewstate; - - -/*------------------------------------. -| yyerrlab -- here on detecting error | -`------------------------------------*/ -yyerrlab: - /* If not already recovering from an error, report this error. */ - if (!yyerrstatus) - { - ++yynerrs; - -#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE - yyn = yypact[yystate]; - - if (yyn > YYFLAG && yyn < YYLAST) - { - YYSIZE_T yysize = 0; - char *yymsg; - int yyx, yycount; - - yycount = 0; - /* Start YYX at -YYN if negative to avoid negative indexes in - YYCHECK. */ - for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0; - yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *)); yyx++) - if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx) - yysize += yystrlen (yytname[yyx]) + 15, yycount++; - yysize += yystrlen ("parse error, unexpected ") + 1; - yysize += yystrlen (yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]); - yymsg = (char *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (yysize); - if (yymsg != 0) - { - char *yyp = yystpcpy (yymsg, "parse error, unexpected "); - yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]); - - if (yycount < 5) - { - yycount = 0; - for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0; - yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *)); - yyx++) - if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx) - { - const char *yyq = ! yycount ? ", expecting " : " or "; - yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yyq); - yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[yyx]); - yycount++; - } - } - yyerror (yymsg); - YYSTACK_FREE (yymsg); - } - else - yyerror ("parse error; also virtual memory exhausted"); - } - else -#endif /* defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */ - yyerror ("parse error"); - } - goto yyerrlab1; - - -/*--------------------------------------------------. -| yyerrlab1 -- error raised explicitly by an action | -`--------------------------------------------------*/ -yyerrlab1: - if (yyerrstatus == 3) - { - /* If just tried and failed to reuse lookahead token after an - error, discard it. */ - - /* return failure if at end of input */ - if (yychar == YYEOF) - YYABORT; - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Discarding token %d (%s).\n", - yychar, yytname[yychar1])); - yychar = YYEMPTY; - } - - /* Else will try to reuse lookahead token after shifting the error - token. */ - - yyerrstatus = 3; /* Each real token shifted decrements this */ - - goto yyerrhandle; - - -/*-------------------------------------------------------------------. -| yyerrdefault -- current state does not do anything special for the | -| error token. | -`-------------------------------------------------------------------*/ -yyerrdefault: -#if 0 - /* This is wrong; only states that explicitly want error tokens - should shift them. */ - - /* If its default is to accept any token, ok. Otherwise pop it. */ - yyn = yydefact[yystate]; - if (yyn) - goto yydefault; -#endif - - -/*---------------------------------------------------------------. -| yyerrpop -- pop the current state because it cannot handle the | -| error token | -`---------------------------------------------------------------*/ -yyerrpop: - if (yyssp == yyss) - YYABORT; - yyvsp--; - yystate = *--yyssp; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - yylsp--; -#endif - -#if YYDEBUG - if (yydebug) - { - short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1; - YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Error: state stack now"); - while (yyssp1 != yyssp) - YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1); - YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n"); - } -#endif - -/*--------------. -| yyerrhandle. | -`--------------*/ -yyerrhandle: - yyn = yypact[yystate]; - if (yyn == YYFLAG) - goto yyerrdefault; - - yyn += YYTERROR; - if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != YYTERROR) - goto yyerrdefault; - - yyn = yytable[yyn]; - if (yyn < 0) - { - if (yyn == YYFLAG) - goto yyerrpop; - yyn = -yyn; - goto yyreduce; - } - else if (yyn == 0) - goto yyerrpop; - - if (yyn == YYFINAL) - YYACCEPT; - - YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting error token, ")); - - *++yyvsp = yylval; -#if YYLSP_NEEDED - *++yylsp = yylloc; -#endif - - yystate = yyn; - goto yynewstate; - - -/*-------------------------------------. -| yyacceptlab -- YYACCEPT comes here. | -`-------------------------------------*/ -yyacceptlab: - yyresult = 0; - goto yyreturn; - -/*-----------------------------------. -| yyabortlab -- YYABORT comes here. | -`-----------------------------------*/ -yyabortlab: - yyresult = 1; - goto yyreturn; - -/*---------------------------------------------. -| yyoverflowab -- parser overflow comes here. | -`---------------------------------------------*/ -yyoverflowlab: - yyerror ("parser stack overflow"); - yyresult = 2; - /* Fall through. */ - -yyreturn: -#ifndef yyoverflow - if (yyss != yyssa) - YYSTACK_FREE (yyss); -#endif - return yyresult; -} -#line 229 "plural.y" - - -void -internal_function -FREE_EXPRESSION (exp) - struct expression *exp; -{ - if (exp == NULL) - return; - - /* Handle the recursive case. */ - switch (exp->nargs) - { - case 3: - FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]); - /* FALLTHROUGH */ - case 2: - FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]); - /* FALLTHROUGH */ - case 1: - FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]); - /* FALLTHROUGH */ - default: - break; - } - - free (exp); -} - - -static int -yylex (lval, pexp) - YYSTYPE *lval; - const char **pexp; -{ - const char *exp = *pexp; - int result; - - while (1) - { - if (exp[0] == '\0') - { - *pexp = exp; - return YYEOF; - } - - if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t') - break; - - ++exp; - } - - result = *exp++; - switch (result) - { - case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': - case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': - { - unsigned long int n = result - '0'; - while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9') - { - n *= 10; - n += exp[0] - '0'; - ++exp; - } - lval->num = n; - result = NUMBER; - } - break; - - case '=': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = equal; - result = EQUOP2; - } - else - result = YYERRCODE; - break; - - case '!': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = not_equal; - result = EQUOP2; - } - break; - - case '&': - case '|': - if (exp[0] == result) - ++exp; - else - result = YYERRCODE; - break; - - case '<': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = less_or_equal; - } - else - lval->op = less_than; - result = CMPOP2; - break; - - case '>': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = greater_or_equal; - } - else - lval->op = greater_than; - result = CMPOP2; - break; - - case '*': - lval->op = mult; - result = MULOP2; - break; - - case '/': - lval->op = divide; - result = MULOP2; - break; - - case '%': - lval->op = module; - result = MULOP2; - break; - - case '+': - lval->op = plus; - result = ADDOP2; - break; - - case '-': - lval->op = minus; - result = ADDOP2; - break; - - case 'n': - case '?': - case ':': - case '(': - case ')': - /* Nothing, just return the character. */ - break; - - case ';': - case '\n': - case '\0': - /* Be safe and let the user call this function again. */ - --exp; - result = YYEOF; - break; - - default: - result = YYERRCODE; -#if YYDEBUG != 0 - --exp; -#endif - break; - } - - *pexp = exp; - - return result; -} - - -static void -yyerror (str) - const char *str; -{ - /* Do nothing. We don't print error messages here. */ -}
--- a/src/intl/plural.y Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,409 +0,0 @@ -%{ -/* Expression parsing for plural form selection. - Copyright (C) 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -/* The bison generated parser uses alloca. AIX 3 forces us to put this - declaration at the beginning of the file. The declaration in bison's - skeleton file comes too late. This must come before <config.h> - because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers. */ -#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__ - #pragma alloca -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stddef.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include "plural-exp.h" - -/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse, - but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE. */ -#ifndef _LIBC -# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE -#endif - -#define YYLEX_PARAM &((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp -#define YYPARSE_PARAM arg -%} -%pure_parser -%expect 7 - -%union { - unsigned long int num; - enum operator op; - struct expression *exp; -} - -%{ -/* Prototypes for local functions. */ -static struct expression *new_exp PARAMS ((int nargs, enum operator op, - struct expression * const *args)); -static inline struct expression *new_exp_0 PARAMS ((enum operator op)); -static inline struct expression *new_exp_1 PARAMS ((enum operator op, - struct expression *right)); -static struct expression *new_exp_2 PARAMS ((enum operator op, - struct expression *left, - struct expression *right)); -static inline struct expression *new_exp_3 PARAMS ((enum operator op, - struct expression *bexp, - struct expression *tbranch, - struct expression *fbranch)); -static int yylex PARAMS ((YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp)); -static void yyerror PARAMS ((const char *str)); - -/* Allocation of expressions. */ - -static struct expression * -new_exp (nargs, op, args) - int nargs; - enum operator op; - struct expression * const *args; -{ - int i; - struct expression *newp; - - /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL. */ - for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) - if (args[i] == NULL) - goto fail; - - /* Allocate a new expression. */ - newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp)); - if (newp != NULL) - { - newp->nargs = nargs; - newp->operation = op; - for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) - newp->val.args[i] = args[i]; - return newp; - } - - fail: - for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--) - FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]); - - return NULL; -} - -static inline struct expression * -new_exp_0 (op) - enum operator op; -{ - return new_exp (0, op, NULL); -} - -static inline struct expression * -new_exp_1 (op, right) - enum operator op; - struct expression *right; -{ - struct expression *args[1]; - - args[0] = right; - return new_exp (1, op, args); -} - -static struct expression * -new_exp_2 (op, left, right) - enum operator op; - struct expression *left; - struct expression *right; -{ - struct expression *args[2]; - - args[0] = left; - args[1] = right; - return new_exp (2, op, args); -} - -static inline struct expression * -new_exp_3 (op, bexp, tbranch, fbranch) - enum operator op; - struct expression *bexp; - struct expression *tbranch; - struct expression *fbranch; -{ - struct expression *args[3]; - - args[0] = bexp; - args[1] = tbranch; - args[2] = fbranch; - return new_exp (3, op, args); -} - -%} - -/* This declares that all operators have the same associativity and the - precedence order as in C. See [Harbison, Steele: C, A Reference Manual]. - There is no unary minus and no bitwise operators. - Operators with the same syntactic behaviour have been merged into a single - token, to save space in the array generated by bison. */ -%right '?' /* ? */ -%left '|' /* || */ -%left '&' /* && */ -%left EQUOP2 /* == != */ -%left CMPOP2 /* < > <= >= */ -%left ADDOP2 /* + - */ -%left MULOP2 /* * / % */ -%right '!' /* ! */ - -%token <op> EQUOP2 CMPOP2 ADDOP2 MULOP2 -%token <num> NUMBER -%type <exp> exp - -%% - -start: exp - { - if ($1 == NULL) - YYABORT; - ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = $1; - } - ; - -exp: exp '?' exp ':' exp - { - $$ = new_exp_3 (qmop, $1, $3, $5); - } - | exp '|' exp - { - $$ = new_exp_2 (lor, $1, $3); - } - | exp '&' exp - { - $$ = new_exp_2 (land, $1, $3); - } - | exp EQUOP2 exp - { - $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); - } - | exp CMPOP2 exp - { - $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); - } - | exp ADDOP2 exp - { - $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); - } - | exp MULOP2 exp - { - $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3); - } - | '!' exp - { - $$ = new_exp_1 (lnot, $2); - } - | 'n' - { - $$ = new_exp_0 (var); - } - | NUMBER - { - if (($$ = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL) - $$->val.num = $1; - } - | '(' exp ')' - { - $$ = $2; - } - ; - -%% - -void -internal_function -FREE_EXPRESSION (exp) - struct expression *exp; -{ - if (exp == NULL) - return; - - /* Handle the recursive case. */ - switch (exp->nargs) - { - case 3: - FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]); - /* FALLTHROUGH */ - case 2: - FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]); - /* FALLTHROUGH */ - case 1: - FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]); - /* FALLTHROUGH */ - default: - break; - } - - free (exp); -} - - -static int -yylex (lval, pexp) - YYSTYPE *lval; - const char **pexp; -{ - const char *exp = *pexp; - int result; - - while (1) - { - if (exp[0] == '\0') - { - *pexp = exp; - return YYEOF; - } - - if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t') - break; - - ++exp; - } - - result = *exp++; - switch (result) - { - case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': - case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': - { - unsigned long int n = result - '0'; - while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9') - { - n *= 10; - n += exp[0] - '0'; - ++exp; - } - lval->num = n; - result = NUMBER; - } - break; - - case '=': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = equal; - result = EQUOP2; - } - else - result = YYERRCODE; - break; - - case '!': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = not_equal; - result = EQUOP2; - } - break; - - case '&': - case '|': - if (exp[0] == result) - ++exp; - else - result = YYERRCODE; - break; - - case '<': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = less_or_equal; - } - else - lval->op = less_than; - result = CMPOP2; - break; - - case '>': - if (exp[0] == '=') - { - ++exp; - lval->op = greater_or_equal; - } - else - lval->op = greater_than; - result = CMPOP2; - break; - - case '*': - lval->op = mult; - result = MULOP2; - break; - - case '/': - lval->op = divide; - result = MULOP2; - break; - - case '%': - lval->op = module; - result = MULOP2; - break; - - case '+': - lval->op = plus; - result = ADDOP2; - break; - - case '-': - lval->op = minus; - result = ADDOP2; - break; - - case 'n': - case '?': - case ':': - case '(': - case ')': - /* Nothing, just return the character. */ - break; - - case ';': - case '\n': - case '\0': - /* Be safe and let the user call this function again. */ - --exp; - result = YYEOF; - break; - - default: - result = YYERRCODE; -#if YYDEBUG != 0 - --exp; -#endif - break; - } - - *pexp = exp; - - return result; -} - - -static void -yyerror (str) - const char *str; -{ - /* Do nothing. We don't print error messages here. */ -}
--- a/src/intl/ref-add.sin Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,31 +0,0 @@ -# Add this package to a list of references stored in a text file. -# -# Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -# -# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it -# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published -# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) -# any later version. -# -# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, -# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of -# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU -# Library General Public License for more details. -# -# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public -# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software -# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, -# USA. -# -# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>. -# -/^# Packages using this file: / { - s/# Packages using this file:// - ta - :a - s/ @PACKAGE@ / @PACKAGE@ / - tb - s/ $/ @PACKAGE@ / - :b - s/^/# Packages using this file:/ -}
--- a/src/intl/ref-del.sin Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,26 +0,0 @@ -# Remove this package from a list of references stored in a text file. -# -# Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -# -# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it -# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published -# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) -# any later version. -# -# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, -# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of -# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU -# Library General Public License for more details. -# -# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public -# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software -# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, -# USA. -# -# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>. -# -/^# Packages using this file: / { - s/# Packages using this file:// - s/ @PACKAGE@ / / - s/^/# Packages using this file:/ -}
--- a/src/intl/relocatable.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,439 +0,0 @@ -/* Provide relocatable packages. - Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - - -/* Tell glibc's <stdio.h> to provide a prototype for getline(). - This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include - <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late. */ -#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE -# define _GNU_SOURCE 1 -#endif - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include "config.h" -#endif - -/* Specification. */ -#include "relocatable.h" - -#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE - -#include <stddef.h> -#include <stdio.h> -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#ifdef NO_XMALLOC -# define xmalloc malloc -#else -# include "xmalloc.h" -#endif - -#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET -# include <libcharset.h> -#endif -#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV -# include <iconv.h> -#endif -#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS -# include <libintl.h> -#endif - -/* Faked cheap 'bool'. */ -#undef bool -#undef false -#undef true -#define bool int -#define false 0 -#define true 1 - -/* Pathname support. - ISSLASH(C) tests whether C is a directory separator character. - IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) tests whether P contains a directory specification. - */ -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ - /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */ -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\') -# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \ - ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \ - && (P)[1] == ':') -# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \ - (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P)) -# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) (HAS_DEVICE (P) ? 2 : 0) -#else - /* Unix */ -# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/') -# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL) -# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) 0 -#endif - -/* Original installation prefix. */ -static char *orig_prefix; -static size_t orig_prefix_len; -/* Current installation prefix. */ -static char *curr_prefix; -static size_t curr_prefix_len; -/* These prefixes do not end in a slash. Anything that will be concatenated - to them must start with a slash. */ - -/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of this module. - Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix - by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both - prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" - instead of "/"). */ -static void -set_this_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg, - const char *curr_prefix_arg) -{ - if (orig_prefix_arg != NULL && curr_prefix_arg != NULL - /* Optimization: if orig_prefix and curr_prefix are equal, the - relocation is a nop. */ - && strcmp (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg) != 0) - { - /* Duplicate the argument strings. */ - char *memory; - - orig_prefix_len = strlen (orig_prefix_arg); - curr_prefix_len = strlen (curr_prefix_arg); - memory = (char *) xmalloc (orig_prefix_len + 1 + curr_prefix_len + 1); -#ifdef NO_XMALLOC - if (memory != NULL) -#endif - { - memcpy (memory, orig_prefix_arg, orig_prefix_len + 1); - orig_prefix = memory; - memory += orig_prefix_len + 1; - memcpy (memory, curr_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_len + 1); - curr_prefix = memory; - return; - } - } - orig_prefix = NULL; - curr_prefix = NULL; - /* Don't worry about wasted memory here - this function is usually only - called once. */ -} - -/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package. - Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix - by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both - prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" - instead of "/"). */ -void -set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg, const char *curr_prefix_arg) -{ - set_this_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); - - /* Now notify all dependent libraries. */ -#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET - libcharset_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); -#endif -#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV && _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0109 - libiconv_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); -#endif -#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS && defined libintl_set_relocation_prefix - libintl_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg); -#endif -} - -/* Convenience function: - Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original - installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular - file, and the current pathname of this file. Returns NULL upon failure. */ -#ifdef IN_LIBRARY -#define compute_curr_prefix local_compute_curr_prefix -static -#endif -const char * -compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix, - const char *orig_installdir, - const char *curr_pathname) -{ - const char *curr_installdir; - const char *rel_installdir; - - if (curr_pathname == NULL) - return NULL; - - /* Determine the relative installation directory, relative to the prefix. - This is simply the difference between orig_installprefix and - orig_installdir. */ - if (strncmp (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir, strlen (orig_installprefix)) - != 0) - /* Shouldn't happen - nothing should be installed outside $(prefix). */ - return NULL; - rel_installdir = orig_installdir + strlen (orig_installprefix); - - /* Determine the current installation directory. */ - { - const char *p_base = curr_pathname + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_pathname); - const char *p = curr_pathname + strlen (curr_pathname); - char *q; - - while (p > p_base) - { - p--; - if (ISSLASH (*p)) - break; - } - - q = (char *) xmalloc (p - curr_pathname + 1); -#ifdef NO_XMALLOC - if (q == NULL) - return NULL; -#endif - memcpy (q, curr_pathname, p - curr_pathname); - q[p - curr_pathname] = '\0'; - curr_installdir = q; - } - - /* Compute the current installation prefix by removing the trailing - rel_installdir from it. */ - { - const char *rp = rel_installdir + strlen (rel_installdir); - const char *cp = curr_installdir + strlen (curr_installdir); - const char *cp_base = - curr_installdir + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_installdir); - - while (rp > rel_installdir && cp > cp_base) - { - bool same = false; - const char *rpi = rp; - const char *cpi = cp; - - while (rpi > rel_installdir && cpi > cp_base) - { - rpi--; - cpi--; - if (ISSLASH (*rpi) || ISSLASH (*cpi)) - { - if (ISSLASH (*rpi) && ISSLASH (*cpi)) - same = true; - break; - } -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__ - /* Win32, OS/2, DOS - case insignificant filesystem */ - if ((*rpi >= 'a' && *rpi <= 'z' ? *rpi - 'a' + 'A' : *rpi) - != (*cpi >= 'a' && *cpi <= 'z' ? *cpi - 'a' + 'A' : *cpi)) - break; -#else - if (*rpi != *cpi) - break; -#endif - } - if (!same) - break; - /* The last pathname component was the same. opi and cpi now point - to the slash before it. */ - rp = rpi; - cp = cpi; - } - - if (rp > rel_installdir) - /* Unexpected: The curr_installdir does not end with rel_installdir. */ - return NULL; - - { - size_t curr_prefix_len = cp - curr_installdir; - char *curr_prefix; - - curr_prefix = (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + 1); -#ifdef NO_XMALLOC - if (curr_prefix == NULL) - return NULL; -#endif - memcpy (curr_prefix, curr_installdir, curr_prefix_len); - curr_prefix[curr_prefix_len] = '\0'; - - return curr_prefix; - } - } -} - -#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR - -/* Full pathname of shared library, or NULL. */ -static char *shared_library_fullname; - -#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ - -/* Determine the full pathname of the shared library when it is loaded. */ - -BOOL WINAPI -DllMain (HINSTANCE module_handle, DWORD event, LPVOID reserved) -{ - (void) reserved; - - if (event == DLL_PROCESS_ATTACH) - { - /* The DLL is being loaded into an application's address range. */ - static char location[MAX_PATH]; - - if (!GetModuleFileName (module_handle, location, sizeof (location))) - /* Shouldn't happen. */ - return FALSE; - - if (!IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (location)) - /* Shouldn't happen. */ - return FALSE; - - shared_library_fullname = strdup (location); - } - - return TRUE; -} - -#else /* Unix */ - -static void -find_shared_library_fullname () -{ -#ifdef __linux__ - FILE *fp; - - /* Open the current process' maps file. It describes one VMA per line. */ - fp = fopen ("/proc/self/maps", "r"); - if (fp) - { - unsigned long address = (unsigned long) &find_shared_library_fullname; - for (;;) - { - unsigned long start, end; - int c; - - if (fscanf (fp, "%lx-%lx", &start, &end) != 2) - break; - if (address >= start && address <= end - 1) - { - /* Found it. Now see if this line contains a filename. */ - while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n' && c != '/') - continue; - if (c == '/') - { - size_t size; - int len; - - ungetc (c, fp); - shared_library_fullname = NULL; size = 0; - len = getline (&shared_library_fullname, &size, fp); - if (len >= 0) - { - /* Success: filled shared_library_fullname. */ - if (len > 0 && shared_library_fullname[len - 1] == '\n') - shared_library_fullname[len - 1] = '\0'; - } - } - break; - } - while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n') - continue; - } - fclose (fp); - } -#endif -} - -#endif /* WIN32 / Unix */ - -/* Return the full pathname of the current shared library. - Return NULL if unknown. - Guaranteed to work only on Linux and Woe32. */ -static char * -get_shared_library_fullname () -{ -#if !(defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__) - static bool tried_find_shared_library_fullname; - if (!tried_find_shared_library_fullname) - { - find_shared_library_fullname (); - tried_find_shared_library_fullname = true; - } -#endif - return shared_library_fullname; -} - -#endif /* PIC */ - -/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation - directory. */ -const char * -relocate (const char *pathname) -{ -#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR - static int initialized; - - /* Initialization code for a shared library. */ - if (!initialized) - { - /* At this point, orig_prefix and curr_prefix likely have already been - set through the main program's set_program_name_and_installdir - function. This is sufficient in the case that the library has - initially been installed in the same orig_prefix. But we can do - better, to also cover the cases that 1. it has been installed - in a different prefix before being moved to orig_prefix and (later) - to curr_prefix, 2. unlike the program, it has not moved away from - orig_prefix. */ - const char *orig_installprefix = INSTALLPREFIX; - const char *orig_installdir = INSTALLDIR; - const char *curr_prefix_better; - - curr_prefix_better = - compute_curr_prefix (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir, - get_shared_library_fullname ()); - if (curr_prefix_better == NULL) - curr_prefix_better = curr_prefix; - - set_relocation_prefix (orig_installprefix, curr_prefix_better); - - initialized = 1; - } -#endif - - /* Note: It is not necessary to perform case insensitive comparison here, - even for DOS-like filesystems, because the pathname argument was - typically created from the same Makefile variable as orig_prefix came - from. */ - if (orig_prefix != NULL && curr_prefix != NULL - && strncmp (pathname, orig_prefix, orig_prefix_len) == 0) - { - if (pathname[orig_prefix_len] == '\0') - /* pathname equals orig_prefix. */ - return curr_prefix; - if (ISSLASH (pathname[orig_prefix_len])) - { - /* pathname starts with orig_prefix. */ - const char *pathname_tail = &pathname[orig_prefix_len]; - char *result = - (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + strlen (pathname_tail) + 1); - -#ifdef NO_XMALLOC - if (result != NULL) -#endif - { - memcpy (result, curr_prefix, curr_prefix_len); - strcpy (result + curr_prefix_len, pathname_tail); - return result; - } - } - } - /* Nothing to relocate. */ - return pathname; -} - -#endif
--- a/src/intl/relocatable.h Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,67 +0,0 @@ -/* Provide relocatable packages. - Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifndef _RELOCATABLE_H -#define _RELOCATABLE_H - -/* This can be enabled through the configure --enable-relocatable option. */ -#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE - -/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions. Note that because - this is a private .h file, we don't need to use __declspec(dllimport) - in any case. */ -#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL -# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport) -#else -# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED -#endif - -/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package. - Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix - by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead. Both - prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use "" - instead of "/"). */ -extern RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED void - set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix, - const char *curr_prefix); - -/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation - directory. */ -extern const char * relocate (const char *pathname); - -/* Memory management: relocate() leaks memory, because it has to construct - a fresh pathname. If this is a problem because your program calls - relocate() frequently, think about caching the result. */ - -/* Convenience function: - Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original - installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular - file, and the current pathname of this file. Returns NULL upon failure. */ -extern const char * compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix, - const char *orig_installdir, - const char *curr_pathname); - -#else - -/* By default, we use the hardwired pathnames. */ -#define relocate(pathname) (pathname) - -#endif - -#endif /* _RELOCATABLE_H */
--- a/src/intl/textdomain.c Thu Jul 12 13:41:06 2007 +0200 +++ /dev/null Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000 @@ -1,142 +0,0 @@ -/* Implementation of the textdomain(3) function. - Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - - This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it - under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published - by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) - any later version. - - This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, - but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of - MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU - Library General Public License for more details. - - You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public - License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software - Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, - USA. */ - -#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H -# include <config.h> -#endif - -#include <stdlib.h> -#include <string.h> - -#ifdef _LIBC -# include <libintl.h> -#else -# include "libgnuintl.h" -#endif -#include "gettextP.h" - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications. */ -# include <bits/libc-lock.h> -#else -/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc. */ -# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME) -# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME) -# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME) -#endif - -/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different - names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs - using libintl.a cannot be linked statically. */ -#if !defined _LIBC -# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain -# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain -#endif - -/* @@ end of prolog @@ */ - -/* Name of the default text domain. */ -extern const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden; - -/* Default text domain in which entries for gettext(3) are to be found. */ -extern const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden; - - -/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem. They must not clash - with existing names and they should follow ANSI C. But this source - code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __ - prefix. So we have to make a difference here. */ -#ifdef _LIBC -# define TEXTDOMAIN __textdomain -# ifndef strdup -# define strdup(str) __strdup (str) -# endif -#else -# define TEXTDOMAIN libintl_textdomain -#endif - -/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation. */ -__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden) - -/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME. - If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default. - If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages". */ -char * -TEXTDOMAIN (domainname) - const char *domainname; -{ - char *new_domain; - char *old_domain; - - /* A NULL pointer requests the current setting. */ - if (domainname == NULL) - return (char *) _nl_current_default_domain; - - __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock); - - old_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain; - - /* If domain name is the null string set to default domain "messages". */ - if (domainname[0] == '\0' - || strcmp (domainname, _nl_default_default_domain) == 0) - { - _nl_current_default_domain = _nl_default_default_domain; - new_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain; - } - else if (strcmp (domainname, old_domain) == 0) - /* This can happen and people will use it to signal that some - environment variable changed. */ - new_domain = old_domain; - else - { - /* If the following malloc fails `_nl_current_default_domain' - will be NULL. This value will be returned and so signals we - are out of core. */ -#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP - new_domain = strdup (domainname); -#else - size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1; - new_domain = (char *) malloc (len); - if (new_domain != NULL) - memcpy (new_domain, domainname, len); -#endif - - if (new_domain != NULL) - _nl_current_default_domain = new_domain; - } - - /* We use this possibility to signal a change of the loaded catalogs - since this is most likely the case and there is no other easy we - to do it. Do it only when the call was successful. */ - if (new_domain != NULL) - { - ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr; - - if (old_domain != new_domain && old_domain != _nl_default_default_domain) - free (old_domain); - } - - __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock); - - return new_domain; -} - -#ifdef _LIBC -/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library. */ -weak_alias (__textdomain, textdomain); -#endif